The Netwide Assembler: NASM
                        ===========================

Chapter 1: Introduction
-----------------------

   1.1 What Is NASM?

       The Netwide Assembler, NASM, is an 80x86 assembler designed for
       portability and modularity. It supports a range of object file
       formats, including Linux and `NetBSD/FreeBSD' `a.out', `ELF',
       `COFF', Microsoft 16-bit `OBJ' and `Win32'. It will also output
       plain binary files. Its syntax is designed to be simple and easy to
       understand, similar to Intel's but less complex. It supports
       `Pentium', `P6', `MMX', `3DNow!', `SSE' and `SSE2' opcodes, and has
       macro capability.

 1.1.1 Why Yet Another Assembler?

       The Netwide Assembler grew out of an idea on `comp.lang.asm.x86' (or
       possibly `alt.lang.asm' - I forget which), which was essentially
       that there didn't seem to be a good _free_ x86-series assembler
       around, and that maybe someone ought to write one.

       (*) `a86' is good, but not free, and in particular you don't get any
           32-bit capability until you pay. It's DOS only, too.

       (*) `gas' is free, and ports over DOS and Unix, but it's not very
           good, since it's designed to be a back end to `gcc', which
           always feeds it correct code. So its error checking is minimal.
           Also, its syntax is horrible, from the point of view of anyone
           trying to actually _write_ anything in it. Plus you can't write
           16-bit code in it (properly).

       (*) `as86' is Minix- and Linux-specific, and (my version at least)
           doesn't seem to have much (or any) documentation.

       (*) `MASM' isn't very good, and it's (was) expensive, and it runs
           only under DOS.

       (*) `TASM' is better, but still strives for MASM compatibility,
           which means millions of directives and tons of red tape. And its
           syntax is essentially MASM's, with the contradictions and quirks
           that entails (although it sorts out some of those by means of
           Ideal mode). It's expensive too. And it's DOS-only.

       So here, for your coding pleasure, is NASM. At present it's still in
       prototype stage - we don't promise that it can outperform any of
       these assemblers. But please, _please_ send us bug reports, fixes,
       helpful information, and anything else you can get your hands on
       (and thanks to the many people who've done this already! You all
       know who you are), and we'll improve it out of all recognition.
       Again.

 1.1.2 Licence Conditions

       Please see the file `COPYING', supplied as part of any NASM
       distribution archive, for the licence conditions under which you may
       use NASM. NASM is now under the so-called GNU Lesser General Public
       License, LGPL.

   1.2 Contact Information

       The current version of NASM (since about 0.98.08) are maintained by
       a team of developers, accessible through the `nasm-devel' mailing
       list (see below for the link). If you want to report a bug, please
       read section 10.2 first.

       NASM has a WWW page at `http://nasm.sourceforge.net'. If it's not
       there, google for us!

       The original authors are e-mailable as `jules@dsf.org.uk' and
       `anakin@pobox.com'. The latter is no longer involved in the
       development team.

       New releases of NASM are uploaded to the official sites
       `http://nasm.sourceforge.net' and to `ftp.kernel.org' and
       `ibiblio.org'.

       Announcements are posted to `comp.lang.asm.x86', `alt.lang.asm' and
       `comp.os.linux.announce'

       If you want information about NASM beta releases, and the current
       development status, please subscribe to the `nasm-devel' email list
       by registering at `http://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm'.

   1.3 Installation

 1.3.1 Installing NASM under MS-DOS or Windows

       Once you've obtained the DOS archive for NASM, `nasmXXX.zip' (where
       `XXX' denotes the version number of NASM contained in the archive),
       unpack it into its own directory (for example `c:\nasm').

       The archive will contain four executable files: the NASM executable
       files `nasm.exe' and `nasmw.exe', and the NDISASM executable files
       `ndisasm.exe' and `ndisasmw.exe'. In each case, the file whose name
       ends in `w' is a `Win32' executable, designed to run under
       `Windows 95' or  `Windows NT' Intel, and the other one is a 16-bit
       `DOS' executable.

       The only file NASM needs to run is its own executable, so copy (at
       least) one of `nasm.exe' and `nasmw.exe' to a directory on your
       PATH, or alternatively edit `autoexec.bat' to add the `nasm'
       directory to your `PATH'. (If you're only installing the `Win32'
       version, you may wish to rename it to `nasm.exe'.)

       That's it - NASM is installed. You don't need the nasm directory to
       be present to run NASM (unless you've added it to your `PATH'), so
       you can delete it if you need to save space; however, you may want
       to keep the documentation or test programs.

       If you've downloaded the DOS source archive, `nasmXXXs.zip', the
       `nasm' directory will also contain the full NASM source code, and a
       selection of Makefiles you can (hopefully) use to rebuild your copy
       of NASM from scratch.

       Note that the source files `insnsa.c', `insnsd.c', `insnsi.h' and
       `insnsn.c' are automatically generated from the master instruction
       table `insns.dat' by a Perl script; the file `macros.c' is generated
       from `standard.mac' by another Perl script. Although the NASM source
       distribution includes these generated files, you will need to
       rebuild them (and hence, will need a Perl interpreter) if you change
       insns.dat, standard.mac or the documentation. It is possible future
       source distributions may not include these files at all. Ports of
       Perl for a variety of platforms, including DOS and Windows, are
       available from www.cpan.org.

 1.3.2 Installing NASM under Unix

       Once you've obtained the Unix source archive for NASM,
       `nasm-X.XX.tar.gz' (where `X.XX' denotes the version number of NASM
       contained in the archive), unpack it into a directory such as
       `/usr/local/src'. The archive, when unpacked, will create its own
       subdirectory `nasm-X.XX'.

       NASM is an auto-configuring package: once you've unpacked it, `cd'
       to the directory it's been unpacked into and type `./configure'.
       This shell script will find the best C compiler to use for building
       NASM and set up Makefiles accordingly.

       Once NASM has auto-configured, you can type `make' to build the
       `nasm' and `ndisasm' binaries, and then `make install' to install
       them in `/usr/local/bin' and install the man pages `nasm.1' and
       `ndisasm.1' in `/usr/local/man/man1'. Alternatively, you can give
       options such as `--prefix' to the configure script (see the file
       `INSTALL' for more details), or install the programs yourself.

       NASM also comes with a set of utilities for handling the `RDOFF'
       custom object-file format, which are in the `rdoff' subdirectory of
       the NASM archive. You can build these with `make rdf' and install
       them with `make rdf_install', if you want them.

       If NASM fails to auto-configure, you may still be able to make it
       compile by using the fall-back Unix makefile `Makefile.unx'. Copy or
       rename that file to `Makefile' and try typing `make'. There is also
       a Makefile.unx file in the `rdoff' subdirectory.

Chapter 2: Running NASM
-----------------------

   2.1 NASM Command-Line Syntax

       To assemble a file, you issue a command of the form

       nasm -f <format> <filename> [-o <output>]

       For example,

       nasm -f elf myfile.asm

       will assemble `myfile.asm' into an `ELF' object file `myfile.o'. And

       nasm -f bin myfile.asm -o myfile.com

       will assemble `myfile.asm' into a raw binary file `myfile.com'.

       To produce a listing file, with the hex codes output from NASM
       displayed on the left of the original sources, use the `-l' option
       to give a listing file name, for example:

       nasm -f coff myfile.asm -l myfile.lst

       To get further usage instructions from NASM, try typing

       nasm -h

       As `-hf', this will also list the available output file formats, and
       what they are.

       If you use Linux but aren't sure whether your system is `a.out' or
       `ELF', type

       file nasm

       (in the directory in which you put the NASM binary when you
       installed it). If it says something like

       nasm: ELF 32-bit LSB executable i386 (386 and up) Version 1

       then your system is `ELF', and you should use the option `-f elf'
       when you want NASM to produce Linux object files. If it says

       nasm: Linux/i386 demand-paged executable (QMAGIC)

       or something similar, your system is `a.out', and you should use
       `-f aout' instead (Linux `a.out' systems have long been obsolete,
       and are rare these days.)

       Like Unix compilers and assemblers, NASM is silent unless it goes
       wrong: you won't see any output at all, unless it gives error
       messages.

 2.1.1 The `-o' Option: Specifying the Output File Name

       NASM will normally choose the name of your output file for you;
       precisely how it does this is dependent on the object file format.
       For Microsoft object file formats (`obj' and `win32'), it will
       remove the `.asm' extension (or whatever extension you like to use -
       NASM doesn't care) from your source file name and substitute `.obj'.
       For Unix object file formats (`aout', `coff', `elf' and `as86') it
       will substitute `.o'. For `rdf', it will use `.rdf', and for the
       `bin' format it will simply remove the extension, so that
       `myfile.asm' produces the output file `myfile'.

       If the output file already exists, NASM will overwrite it, unless it
       has the same name as the input file, in which case it will give a
       warning and use `nasm.out' as the output file name instead.

       For situations in which this behaviour is unacceptable, NASM
       provides the `-o' command-line option, which allows you to specify
       your desired output file name. You invoke `-o' by following it with
       the name you wish for the output file, either with or without an
       intervening space. For example:

       nasm -f bin program.asm -o program.com 
       nasm -f bin driver.asm -odriver.sys

       Note that this is a small o, and is different from a capital O ,
       which is used to specify the number of optimisation passes required.
       See section 2.1.16.

 2.1.2 The `-f' Option: Specifying the Output File Format

       If you do not supply the `-f' option to NASM, it will choose an
       output file format for you itself. In the distribution versions of
       NASM, the default is always `bin'; if you've compiled your own copy
       of NASM, you can redefine `OF_DEFAULT' at compile time and choose
       what you want the default to be.

       Like `-o', the intervening space between `-f' and the output file
       format is optional; so `-f elf' and `-felf' are both valid.

       A complete list of the available output file formats can be given by
       issuing the command `nasm -hf'.

 2.1.3 The `-l' Option: Generating a Listing File

       If you supply the `-l' option to NASM, followed (with the usual
       optional space) by a file name, NASM will generate a source-listing
       file for you, in which addresses and generated code are listed on
       the left, and the actual source code, with expansions of multi-line
       macros (except those which specifically request no expansion in
       source listings: see section 4.3.9) on the right. For example:

       nasm -f elf myfile.asm -l myfile.lst

       If a list file is selected, you may turn off listing for a section
       of your source with `[list -]', and turn it back on with `[list +]',
       (the default, obviously). There is no "user form" (without the
       brackets). This can be used to list only sections of interest,
       avoiding excessively long listings.

 2.1.4 The `-M' Option: Generate Makefile Dependencies.

       This option can be used to generate makefile dependencies on stdout.
       This can be redirected to a file for further processing. For
       example:

       NASM -M myfile.asm > myfile.dep

 2.1.5 The `-F' Option: Selecting a Debug Information Format

       This option is used to select the format of the debug information
       emitted into the output file, to be used by a debugger (or _will_
       be). Use of this switch does _not_ enable output of the selected
       debug info format. Use `-g', see section 2.1.6, to enable output.

       A complete list of the available debug file formats for an output
       format can be seen by issuing the command `nasm -f <format> -y'.
       (only "borland" in "-f obj", as of 0.98.35, but "watch this space")
       See: section 2.1.20.

       This should not be confused with the "-f dbg" output format option
       which is not built into NASM by default. For information on how to
       enable it when building from the sources, see section 6.10

 2.1.6 The `-g' Option: Enabling Debug Information.

       This option can be used to generate debugging information in the
       specified format. See: section 2.1.5. Using `-g' without `-F'
       results in emitting debug info in the default format, if any, for
       the selected output format. If no debug information is currently
       implemented in the selected output format, `-g' is _silently
       ignored_.

 2.1.7 The `-X' Option: Selecting an Error Reporting Format

       This option can be used to select an error reporting format for any
       error messages that might be produced by NASM.

       Currently, two error reporting formats may be selected. They are the
       `-Xvc' option and the `-Xgnu' option. The GNU format is the default
       and looks like this:

       filename.asm:65: error: specific error message 

       where `filename.asm' is the name of the source file in which the
       error was detected, `65' is the source file line number on which the
       error was detected, `error' is the severity of the error (this could
       be `warning'), and `specific error message' is a more detailed text
       message which should help pinpoint the exact problem.

       The other format, specified by `-Xvc' is the style used by Microsoft
       Visual C++ and some other programs. It looks like this:

       filename.asm(65) : error: specific error message

       where the only difference is that the line number is in parentheses
       instead of being delimited by colons.

       See also the `Visual C++' output format, section 6.3.

 2.1.8 The `-E' Option: Send Errors to a File

       Under `MS-DOS' it can be difficult (though there are ways) to
       redirect the standard-error output of a program to a file. Since
       NASM usually produces its warning and error messages on `stderr',
       this can make it hard to capture the errors if (for example) you
       want to load them into an editor.

       NASM therefore provides the `-E' option, taking a filename argument
       which causes errors to be sent to the specified files rather than
       standard error. Therefore you can redirect the errors into a file by
       typing

       nasm -E myfile.err -f obj myfile.asm

 2.1.9 The `-s' Option: Send Errors to `stdout'

       The `-s' option redirects error messages to `stdout' rather than
       `stderr', so it can be redirected under `MS-DOS'. To assemble the
       file `myfile.asm' and pipe its output to the `more' program, you can
       type:

       nasm -s -f obj myfile.asm | more

       See also the `-E' option, section 2.1.8.

2.1.10 The `-i' Option: Include File Search Directories

       When NASM sees the `%include' or `incbin' directive in a source file
       (see section 4.6 or section 3.2.3), it will search for the given
       file not only in the current directory, but also in any directories
       specified on the command line by the use of the `-i' option.
       Therefore you can include files from a macro library, for example,
       by typing

       nasm -ic:\macrolib\ -f obj myfile.asm

       (As usual, a space between `-i' and the path name is allowed, and
       optional).

       NASM, in the interests of complete source-code portability, does not
       understand the file naming conventions of the OS it is running on;
       the string you provide as an argument to the `-i' option will be
       prepended exactly as written to the name of the include file.
       Therefore the trailing backslash in the above example is necessary.
       Under Unix, a trailing forward slash is similarly necessary.

       (You can use this to your advantage, if you're really perverse, by
       noting that the option `-ifoo' will cause `%include "bar.i"' to
       search for the file `foobar.i'...)

       If you want to define a _standard_ include search path, similar to
       `/usr/include' on Unix systems, you should place one or more `-i'
       directives in the `NASMENV' environment variable (see section
       2.1.22).

       For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can
       also be specified as `-I'.

2.1.11 The `-p' Option: Pre-Include a File

       NASM allows you to specify files to be _pre-included_ into your
       source file, by the use of the `-p' option. So running

       nasm myfile.asm -p myinc.inc

       is equivalent to running `nasm myfile.asm' and placing the directive
       `%include "myinc.inc"' at the start of the file.

       For consistency with the `-I', `-D' and `-U' options, this option
       can also be specified as `-P'.

2.1.12 The `-d' Option: Pre-Define a Macro

       Just as the `-p' option gives an alternative to placing `%include'
       directives at the start of a source file, the `-d' option gives an
       alternative to placing a `%define' directive. You could code

       nasm myfile.asm -dFOO=100

       as an alternative to placing the directive

       %define FOO 100

       at the start of the file. You can miss off the macro value, as well:
       the option `-dFOO' is equivalent to coding `%define FOO'. This form
       of the directive may be useful for selecting assembly-time options
       which are then tested using `%ifdef', for example `-dDEBUG'.

       For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can
       also be specified as `-D'.

2.1.13 The `-u' Option: Undefine a Macro

       The `-u' option undefines a macro that would otherwise have been
       pre-defined, either automatically or by a `-p' or `-d' option
       specified earlier on the command lines.

       For example, the following command line:

       nasm myfile.asm -dFOO=100 -uFOO

       would result in `FOO' _not_ being a predefined macro in the program.
       This is useful to override options specified at a different point in
       a Makefile.

       For Makefile compatibility with many C compilers, this option can
       also be specified as `-U'.

2.1.14 The `-e' Option: Preprocess Only

       NASM allows the preprocessor to be run on its own, up to a point.
       Using the `-e' option (which requires no arguments) will cause NASM
       to preprocess its input file, expand all the macro references,
       remove all the comments and preprocessor directives, and print the
       resulting file on standard output (or save it to a file, if the `-o'
       option is also used).

       This option cannot be applied to programs which require the
       preprocessor to evaluate expressions which depend on the values of
       symbols: so code such as

       %assign tablesize ($-tablestart)

       will cause an error in preprocess-only mode.

2.1.15 The `-a' Option: Don't Preprocess At All

       If NASM is being used as the back end to a compiler, it might be
       desirable to suppress preprocessing completely and assume the
       compiler has already done it, to save time and increase compilation
       speeds. The `-a' option, requiring no argument, instructs NASM to
       replace its powerful preprocessor with a stub preprocessor which
       does nothing.

2.1.16 The `-On' Option: Specifying Multipass Optimization.

       NASM defaults to being a two pass assembler. This means that if you
       have a complex source file which needs more than 2 passes to
       assemble optimally, you have to enable extra passes.

       Using the `-O' option, you can tell NASM to carry out multiple
       passes. The syntax is:

       (*) `-O0' strict two-pass assembly, JMP and Jcc are handled more
           like v0.98, except that backward JMPs are short, if possible.
           Immediate operands take their long forms if a short form is not
           specified.

       (*) `-O1' strict two-pass assembly, but forward branches are
           assembled with code guaranteed to reach; may produce larger code
           than -O0, but will produce successful assembly more often if
           branch offset sizes are not specified. Additionally, immediate
           operands which will fit in a signed byte are optimised, unless
           the long form is specified.

       (*) `-On' multi-pass optimization, minimize branch offsets; also
           will minimize signed immediate bytes, overriding size
           specification unless the `strict' keyword has been used (see
           section 3.7). The number specifies the maximum number of passes.
           The more passes, the better the code, but the slower is the
           assembly.

       Note that this is a capital O, and is different from a small o,
       which is used to specify the output format. See section 2.1.1.

2.1.17 The `-t' option: Enable TASM Compatibility Mode

       NASM includes a limited form of compatibility with Borland's `TASM'.
       When NASM's `-t' option is used, the following changes are made:

       (*) local labels may be prefixed with `@@' instead of `.'

       (*) TASM-style response files beginning with `@' may be specified on
           the command line. This is different from the `-@resp' style that
           NASM natively supports.

       (*) size override is supported within brackets. In TASM compatible
           mode, a size override inside square brackets changes the size of
           the operand, and not the address type of the operand as it does
           in NASM syntax. E.g. `mov eax,[DWORD val]' is valid syntax in
           TASM compatibility mode. Note that you lose the ability to
           override the default address type for the instruction.

       (*) `%arg' preprocessor directive is supported which is similar to
           TASM's `ARG' directive.

       (*) `%local' preprocessor directive

       (*) `%stacksize' preprocessor directive

       (*) unprefixed forms of some directives supported (`arg', `elif',
           `else', `endif', `if', `ifdef', `ifdifi', `ifndef', `include',
           `local')

       (*) more...

       For more information on the directives, see the section on TASM
       Compatiblity preprocessor directives in section 4.9.

2.1.18 The `-w' Option: Enable or Disable Assembly Warnings

       NASM can observe many conditions during the course of assembly which
       are worth mentioning to the user, but not a sufficiently severe
       error to justify NASM refusing to generate an output file. These
       conditions are reported like errors, but come up with the word
       `warning' before the message. Warnings do not prevent NASM from
       generating an output file and returning a success status to the
       operating system.

       Some conditions are even less severe than that: they are only
       sometimes worth mentioning to the user. Therefore NASM supports the
       `-w' command-line option, which enables or disables certain classes
       of assembly warning. Such warning classes are described by a name,
       for example `orphan-labels'; you can enable warnings of this class
       by the command-line option `-w+orphan-labels' and disable it by
       `-w-orphan-labels'.

       The suppressible warning classes are:

       (*) `macro-params' covers warnings about multi-line macros being
           invoked with the wrong number of parameters. This warning class
           is enabled by default; see section 4.3.1 for an example of why
           you might want to disable it.

       (*) `macro-selfref' warns if a macro references itself. This warning
           class is enabled by default.

       (*) `orphan-labels' covers warnings about source lines which contain
           no instruction but define a label without a trailing colon. NASM
           does not warn about this somewhat obscure condition by default;
           see section 3.1 for an example of why you might want it to.

       (*) `number-overflow' covers warnings about numeric constants which
           don't fit in 32 bits (for example, it's easy to type one too
           many Fs and produce `0x7ffffffff' by mistake). This warning
           class is enabled by default.

       (*) `gnu-elf-extensions' warns if 8-bit or 16-bit relocations are
           used in `-f elf' format. The GNU extensions allow this. This
           warning class is enabled by default.

       (*) In addition, warning classes may be enabled or disabled across
           sections of source code with `[warning +warning-name]' or
           `[warning -warning-name]'. No "user form" (without the brackets)
           exists.

2.1.19 The `-v' Option: Display Version Info

       Typing `NASM -v' will display the version of NASM which you are
       using, and the date on which it was compiled. This replaces the
       deprecated `-r'.

       You will need the version number if you report a bug.

2.1.20 The `-y' Option: Display Available Debug Info Formats

       Typing `nasm -f <option> -y' will display a list of the available
       debug info formats for the given output format. The default format
       is indicated by an asterisk. E.g. `nasm -f obj -y' yields
       `* borland'. (as of 0.98.35, the _only_ debug info format
       implemented).

2.1.21 The `--prefix' and `--postfix' Options.

       The `--prefix' and `--postfix' options prepend or append
       (respectively) the given argument to all `global' or `extern'
       variables. E.g. `--prefix_' will prepend the underscore to all
       global and external variables, as C sometimes (but not always) likes
       it.

2.1.22 The `NASMENV' Environment Variable

       If you define an environment variable called `NASMENV', the program
       will interpret it as a list of extra command-line options, which are
       processed before the real command line. You can use this to define
       standard search directories for include files, by putting `-i'
       options in the `NASMENV' variable.

       The value of the variable is split up at white space, so that the
       value `-s -ic:\nasmlib' will be treated as two separate options.
       However, that means that the value `-dNAME="my name"' won't do what
       you might want, because it will be split at the space and the NASM
       command-line processing will get confused by the two nonsensical
       words `-dNAME="my' and `name"'.

       To get round this, NASM provides a feature whereby, if you begin the
       `NASMENV' environment variable with some character that isn't a
       minus sign, then NASM will treat this character as the separator
       character for options. So setting the `NASMENV' variable to the
       value `!-s!-ic:\nasmlib' is equivalent to setting it to
       `-s -ic:\nasmlib', but `!-dNAME="my name"' will work.

       This environment variable was previously called `NASM'. This was
       changed with version 0.98.31.

   2.2 Quick Start for MASM Users

       If you're used to writing programs with MASM, or with TASM in MASM-
       compatible (non-Ideal) mode, or with `a86', this section attempts to
       outline the major differences between MASM's syntax and NASM's. If
       you're not already used to MASM, it's probably worth skipping this
       section.

 2.2.1 NASM Is Case-Sensitive

       One simple difference is that NASM is case-sensitive. It makes a
       difference whether you call your label `foo', `Foo' or `FOO'. If
       you're assembling to `DOS' or `OS/2' `.OBJ' files, you can invoke
       the `UPPERCASE' directive (documented in section 6.2) to ensure that
       all symbols exported to other code modules are forced to be upper
       case; but even then, _within_ a single module, NASM will distinguish
       between labels differing only in case.

 2.2.2 NASM Requires Square Brackets For Memory References

       NASM was designed with simplicity of syntax in mind. One of the
       design goals of NASM is that it should be possible, as far as is
       practical, for the user to look at a single line of NASM code and
       tell what opcode is generated by it. You can't do this in MASM: if
       you declare, for example,

       foo     equ     1 
       bar     dw      2

       then the two lines of code

               mov     ax,foo 
               mov     ax,bar

       generate completely different opcodes, despite having identical-
       looking syntaxes.

       NASM avoids this undesirable situation by having a much simpler
       syntax for memory references. The rule is simply that any access to
       the _contents_ of a memory location requires square brackets around
       the address, and any access to the _address_ of a variable doesn't.
       So an instruction of the form `mov ax,foo' will _always_ refer to a
       compile-time constant, whether it's an `EQU' or the address of a
       variable; and to access the _contents_ of the variable `bar', you
       must code `mov ax,[bar]'.

       This also means that NASM has no need for MASM's `OFFSET' keyword,
       since the MASM code `mov ax,offset bar' means exactly the same thing
       as NASM's `mov ax,bar'. If you're trying to get large amounts of
       MASM code to assemble sensibly under NASM, you can always code
       `%idefine offset' to make the preprocessor treat the `OFFSET'
       keyword as a no-op.

       This issue is even more confusing in `a86', where declaring a label
       with a trailing colon defines it to be a `label' as opposed to a
       `variable' and causes `a86' to adopt NASM-style semantics; so in
       `a86', `mov ax,var' has different behaviour depending on whether
       `var' was declared as `var: dw 0' (a label) or `var dw 0' (a word-
       size variable). NASM is very simple by comparison: _everything_ is a
       label.

       NASM, in the interests of simplicity, also does not support the
       hybrid syntaxes supported by MASM and its clones, such as
       `mov ax,table[bx]', where a memory reference is denoted by one
       portion outside square brackets and another portion inside. The
       correct syntax for the above is `mov ax,[table+bx]'. Likewise,
       `mov ax,es:[di]' is wrong and `mov ax,[es:di]' is right.

 2.2.3 NASM Doesn't Store Variable Types

       NASM, by design, chooses not to remember the types of variables you
       declare. Whereas MASM will remember, on seeing `var dw 0', that you
       declared `var' as a word-size variable, and will then be able to
       fill in the ambiguity in the size of the instruction `mov var,2',
       NASM will deliberately remember nothing about the symbol `var'
       except where it begins, and so you must explicitly code
       `mov word [var],2'.

       For this reason, NASM doesn't support the `LODS', `MOVS', `STOS',
       `SCAS', `CMPS', `INS', or `OUTS' instructions, but only supports the
       forms such as `LODSB', `MOVSW', and `SCASD', which explicitly
       specify the size of the components of the strings being manipulated.

 2.2.4 NASM Doesn't `ASSUME'

       As part of NASM's drive for simplicity, it also does not support the
       `ASSUME' directive. NASM will not keep track of what values you
       choose to put in your segment registers, and will never
       _automatically_ generate a segment override prefix.

 2.2.5 NASM Doesn't Support Memory Models

       NASM also does not have any directives to support different 16-bit
       memory models. The programmer has to keep track of which functions
       are supposed to be called with a far call and which with a near
       call, and is responsible for putting the correct form of `RET'
       instruction (`RETN' or `RETF'; NASM accepts `RET' itself as an
       alternate form for `RETN'); in addition, the programmer is
       responsible for coding CALL FAR instructions where necessary when
       calling _external_ functions, and must also keep track of which
       external variable definitions are far and which are near.

 2.2.6 Floating-Point Differences

       NASM uses different names to refer to floating-point registers from
       MASM: where MASM would call them `ST(0)', `ST(1)' and so on, and
       `a86' would call them simply `0', `1' and so on, NASM chooses to
       call them `st0', `st1' etc.

       As of version 0.96, NASM now treats the instructions with `nowait'
       forms in the same way as MASM-compatible assemblers. The
       idiosyncratic treatment employed by 0.95 and earlier was based on a
       misunderstanding by the authors.

 2.2.7 Other Differences

       For historical reasons, NASM uses the keyword `TWORD' where MASM and
       compatible assemblers use `TBYTE'.

       NASM does not declare uninitialised storage in the same way as MASM:
       where a MASM programmer might use `stack db 64 dup (?)', NASM
       requires `stack resb 64', intended to be read as `reserve 64 bytes'.
       For a limited amount of compatibility, since NASM treats `?' as a
       valid character in symbol names, you can code `? equ 0' and then
       writing `dw ?' will at least do something vaguely useful. `DUP' is
       still not a supported syntax, however.

       In addition to all of this, macros and directives work completely
       differently to MASM. See chapter 4 and chapter 5 for further
       details.

Chapter 3: The NASM Language
----------------------------

   3.1 Layout of a NASM Source Line

       Like most assemblers, each NASM source line contains (unless it is a
       macro, a preprocessor directive or an assembler directive: see
       chapter 4 and chapter 5) some combination of the four fields

       label:    instruction operands        ; comment

       As usual, most of these fields are optional; the presence or absence
       of any combination of a label, an instruction and a comment is
       allowed. Of course, the operand field is either required or
       forbidden by the presence and nature of the instruction field.

       NASM uses backslash (\) as the line continuation character; if a
       line ends with backslash, the next line is considered to be a part
       of the backslash-ended line.

       NASM places no restrictions on white space within a line: labels may
       have white space before them, or instructions may have no space
       before them, or anything. The colon after a label is also optional.
       (Note that this means that if you intend to code `lodsb' alone on a
       line, and type `lodab' by accident, then that's still a valid source
       line which does nothing but define a label. Running NASM with the
       command-line option `-w+orphan-labels' will cause it to warn you if
       you define a label alone on a line without a trailing colon.)

       Valid characters in labels are letters, numbers, `_', `$', `#', `@',
       `~', `.', and `?'. The only characters which may be used as the
       _first_ character of an identifier are letters, `.' (with special
       meaning: see section 3.9), `_' and `?'. An identifier may also be
       prefixed with a `$' to indicate that it is intended to be read as an
       identifier and not a reserved word; thus, if some other module you
       are linking with defines a symbol called `eax', you can refer to
       `$eax' in NASM code to distinguish the symbol from the register.
       Maximum length of an identifier is 4095 characters.

       The instruction field may contain any machine instruction: Pentium
       and P6 instructions, FPU instructions, MMX instructions and even
       undocumented instructions are all supported. The instruction may be
       prefixed by `LOCK', `REP', `REPE'/`REPZ' or `REPNE'/`REPNZ', in the
       usual way. Explicit address-size and operand-size prefixes `A16',
       `A32', `O16' and `O32' are provided - one example of their use is
       given in chapter 9. You can also use the name of a segment register
       as an instruction prefix: coding `es mov [bx],ax' is equivalent to
       coding `mov [es:bx],ax'. We recommend the latter syntax, since it is
       consistent with other syntactic features of the language, but for
       instructions such as `LODSB', which has no operands and yet can
       require a segment override, there is no clean syntactic way to
       proceed apart from `es lodsb'.

       An instruction is not required to use a prefix: prefixes such as
       `CS', `A32', `LOCK' or `REPE' can appear on a line by themselves,
       and NASM will just generate the prefix bytes.

       In addition to actual machine instructions, NASM also supports a
       number of pseudo-instructions, described in section 3.2.

       Instruction operands may take a number of forms: they can be
       registers, described simply by the register name (e.g. `ax', `bp',
       `ebx', `cr0': NASM does not use the `gas'-style syntax in which
       register names must be prefixed by a `%' sign), or they can be
       effective addresses (see section 3.3), constants (section 3.4) or
       expressions (section 3.5).

       For floating-point instructions, NASM accepts a wide range of
       syntaxes: you can use two-operand forms like MASM supports, or you
       can use NASM's native single-operand forms in most cases. Details of
       all forms of each supported instruction are given in appendix B. For
       example, you can code:

               fadd    st1             ; this sets st0 := st0 + st1 
               fadd    st0,st1         ; so does this 
       
               fadd    st1,st0         ; this sets st1 := st1 + st0 
               fadd    to st1          ; so does this

       Almost any floating-point instruction that references memory must
       use one of the prefixes `DWORD', `QWORD' or `TWORD' to indicate what
       size of memory operand it refers to.

   3.2 Pseudo-Instructions

       Pseudo-instructions are things which, though not real x86 machine
       instructions, are used in the instruction field anyway because
       that's the most convenient place to put them. The current pseudo-
       instructions are `DB', `DW', `DD', `DQ' and `DT', their
       uninitialised counterparts `RESB', `RESW', `RESD', `RESQ' and
       `REST', the `INCBIN' command, the `EQU' command, and the `TIMES'
       prefix.

 3.2.1 `DB' and friends: Declaring Initialised Data

       `DB', `DW', `DD', `DQ' and `DT' are used, much as in MASM, to
       declare initialised data in the output file. They can be invoked in
       a wide range of ways:

             db    0x55                ; just the byte 0x55 
             db    0x55,0x56,0x57      ; three bytes in succession 
             db    'a',0x55            ; character constants are OK 
             db    'hello',13,10,'$'   ; so are string constants 
             dw    0x1234              ; 0x34 0x12 
             dw    'a'                 ; 0x61 0x00 (it's just a number) 
             dw    'ab'                ; 0x61 0x62 (character constant) 
             dw    'abc'               ; 0x61 0x62 0x63 0x00 (string) 
             dd    0x12345678          ; 0x78 0x56 0x34 0x12 
             dd    1.234567e20         ; floating-point constant 
             dq    1.234567e20         ; double-precision float 
             dt    1.234567e20         ; extended-precision float

       `DQ' and `DT' do not accept numeric constants or string constants as
       operands.

 3.2.2 `RESB' and friends: Declaring Uninitialised Data

       `RESB', `RESW', `RESD', `RESQ' and `REST' are designed to be used in
       the BSS section of a module: they declare _uninitialised_ storage
       space. Each takes a single operand, which is the number of bytes,
       words, doublewords or whatever to reserve. As stated in section
       2.2.7, NASM does not support the MASM/TASM syntax of reserving
       uninitialised space by writing `DW ?' or similar things: this is
       what it does instead. The operand to a `RESB'-type pseudo-
       instruction is a _critical expression_: see section 3.8.

       For example:

       buffer:         resb    64              ; reserve 64 bytes 
       wordvar:        resw    1               ; reserve a word 
       realarray       resq    10              ; array of ten reals

 3.2.3 `INCBIN': Including External Binary Files

       `INCBIN' is borrowed from the old Amiga assembler DevPac: it
       includes a binary file verbatim into the output file. This can be
       handy for (for example) including graphics and sound data directly
       into a game executable file. It can be called in one of these three
       ways:

           incbin  "file.dat"             ; include the whole file 
           incbin  "file.dat",1024        ; skip the first 1024 bytes 
           incbin  "file.dat",1024,512    ; skip the first 1024, and 
                                          ; actually include at most 512

 3.2.4 `EQU': Defining Constants

       `EQU' defines a symbol to a given constant value: when `EQU' is
       used, the source line must contain a label. The action of `EQU' is
       to define the given label name to the value of its (only) operand.
       This definition is absolute, and cannot change later. So, for
       example,

       message         db      'hello, world' 
       msglen          equ     $-message

       defines `msglen' to be the constant 12. `msglen' may not then be
       redefined later. This is not a preprocessor definition either: the
       value of `msglen' is evaluated _once_, using the value of `$' (see
       section 3.5 for an explanation of `$') at the point of definition,
       rather than being evaluated wherever it is referenced and using the
       value of `$' at the point of reference. Note that the operand to an
       `EQU' is also a critical expression (section 3.8).

 3.2.5 `TIMES': Repeating Instructions or Data

       The `TIMES' prefix causes the instruction to be assembled multiple
       times. This is partly present as NASM's equivalent of the `DUP'
       syntax supported by MASM-compatible assemblers, in that you can code

       zerobuf:        times 64 db 0

       or similar things; but `TIMES' is more versatile than that. The
       argument to `TIMES' is not just a numeric constant, but a numeric
       _expression_, so you can do things like

       buffer: db      'hello, world' 
               times 64-$+buffer db ' '

       which will store exactly enough spaces to make the total length of
       `buffer' up to 64. Finally, `TIMES' can be applied to ordinary
       instructions, so you can code trivial unrolled loops in it:

               times 100 movsb

       Note that there is no effective difference between
       `times 100 resb 1' and `resb 100', except that the latter will be
       assembled about 100 times faster due to the internal structure of
       the assembler.

       The operand to `TIMES', like that of `EQU' and those of `RESB' and
       friends, is a critical expression (section 3.8).

       Note also that `TIMES' can't be applied to macros: the reason for
       this is that `TIMES' is processed after the macro phase, which
       allows the argument to `TIMES' to contain expressions such as
       `64-$+buffer' as above. To repeat more than one line of code, or a
       complex macro, use the preprocessor `%rep' directive.

   3.3 Effective Addresses

       An effective address is any operand to an instruction which
       references memory. Effective addresses, in NASM, have a very simple
       syntax: they consist of an expression evaluating to the desired
       address, enclosed in square brackets. For example:

       wordvar dw      123 
               mov     ax,[wordvar] 
               mov     ax,[wordvar+1] 
               mov     ax,[es:wordvar+bx]

       Anything not conforming to this simple system is not a valid memory
       reference in NASM, for example `es:wordvar[bx]'.

       More complicated effective addresses, such as those involving more
       than one register, work in exactly the same way:

               mov     eax,[ebx*2+ecx+offset] 
               mov     ax,[bp+di+8]

       NASM is capable of doing algebra on these effective addresses, so
       that things which don't necessarily _look_ legal are perfectly all
       right:

           mov     eax,[ebx*5]             ; assembles as [ebx*4+ebx] 
           mov     eax,[label1*2-label2]   ; ie [label1+(label1-label2)]

       Some forms of effective address have more than one assembled form;
       in most such cases NASM will generate the smallest form it can. For
       example, there are distinct assembled forms for the 32-bit effective
       addresses `[eax*2+0]' and `[eax+eax]', and NASM will generally
       generate the latter on the grounds that the former requires four
       bytes to store a zero offset.

       NASM has a hinting mechanism which will cause `[eax+ebx]' and
       `[ebx+eax]' to generate different opcodes; this is occasionally
       useful because `[esi+ebp]' and `[ebp+esi]' have different default
       segment registers.

       However, you can force NASM to generate an effective address in a
       particular form by the use of the keywords `BYTE', `WORD', `DWORD'
       and `NOSPLIT'. If you need `[eax+3]' to be assembled using a double-
       word offset field instead of the one byte NASM will normally
       generate, you can code `[dword eax+3]'. Similarly, you can force
       NASM to use a byte offset for a small value which it hasn't seen on
       the first pass (see section 3.8 for an example of such a code
       fragment) by using `[byte eax+offset]'. As special cases,
       `[byte eax]' will code `[eax+0]' with a byte offset of zero, and
       `[dword eax]' will code it with a double-word offset of zero. The
       normal form, `[eax]', will be coded with no offset field.

       The form described in the previous paragraph is also useful if you
       are trying to access data in a 32-bit segment from within 16 bit
       code. For more information on this see the section on mixed-size
       addressing (section 9.2). In particular, if you need to access data
       with a known offset that is larger than will fit in a 16-bit value,
       if you don't specify that it is a dword offset, nasm will cause the
       high word of the offset to be lost.

       Similarly, NASM will split `[eax*2]' into `[eax+eax]' because that
       allows the offset field to be absent and space to be saved; in fact,
       it will also split `[eax*2+offset]' into `[eax+eax+offset]'. You can
       combat this behaviour by the use of the `NOSPLIT' keyword:
       `[nosplit eax*2]' will force `[eax*2+0]' to be generated literally.

   3.4 Constants

       NASM understands four different types of constant: numeric,
       character, string and floating-point.

 3.4.1 Numeric Constants

       A numeric constant is simply a number. NASM allows you to specify
       numbers in a variety of number bases, in a variety of ways: you can
       suffix `H', `Q' or `O', and `B' for hex, octal and binary, or you
       can prefix `0x' for hex in the style of C, or you can prefix `$' for
       hex in the style of Borland Pascal. Note, though, that the `$'
       prefix does double duty as a prefix on identifiers (see section
       3.1), so a hex number prefixed with a `$' sign must have a digit
       after the `$' rather than a letter.

       Some examples:

               mov     ax,100          ; decimal 
               mov     ax,0a2h         ; hex 
               mov     ax,$0a2         ; hex again: the 0 is required 
               mov     ax,0xa2         ; hex yet again 
               mov     ax,777q         ; octal 
               mov     ax,777o         ; octal again 
               mov     ax,10010011b    ; binary

 3.4.2 Character Constants

       A character constant consists of up to four characters enclosed in
       either single or double quotes. The type of quote makes no
       difference to NASM, except of course that surrounding the constant
       with single quotes allows double quotes to appear within it and vice
       versa.

       A character constant with more than one character will be arranged
       with little-endian order in mind: if you code

                 mov eax,'abcd'

       then the constant generated is not `0x61626364', but `0x64636261',
       so that if you were then to store the value into memory, it would
       read `abcd' rather than `dcba'. This is also the sense of character
       constants understood by the Pentium's `CPUID' instruction (see
       section B.4.34).

 3.4.3 String Constants

       String constants are only acceptable to some pseudo-instructions,
       namely the `DB' family and `INCBIN'.

       A string constant looks like a character constant, only longer. It
       is treated as a concatenation of maximum-size character constants
       for the conditions. So the following are equivalent:

             db    'hello'               ; string constant 
             db    'h','e','l','l','o'   ; equivalent character constants

       And the following are also equivalent:

             dd    'ninechars'           ; doubleword string constant 
             dd    'nine','char','s'     ; becomes three doublewords 
             db    'ninechars',0,0,0     ; and really looks like this

       Note that when used as an operand to `db', a constant like `'ab'' is
       treated as a string constant despite being short enough to be a
       character constant, because otherwise `db 'ab'' would have the same
       effect as `db 'a'', which would be silly. Similarly, three-character
       or four-character constants are treated as strings when they are
       operands to `dw'.

 3.4.4 Floating-Point Constants

       Floating-point constants are acceptable only as arguments to `DD',
       `DQ' and `DT'. They are expressed in the traditional form: digits,
       then a period, then optionally more digits, then optionally an `E'
       followed by an exponent. The period is mandatory, so that NASM can
       distinguish between `dd 1', which declares an integer constant, and
       `dd 1.0' which declares a floating-point constant.

       Some examples:

             dd    1.2                     ; an easy one 
             dq    1.e10                   ; 10,000,000,000 
             dq    1.e+10                  ; synonymous with 1.e10 
             dq    1.e-10                  ; 0.000 000 000 1 
             dt    3.141592653589793238462 ; pi

       NASM cannot do compile-time arithmetic on floating-point constants.
       This is because NASM is designed to be portable - although it always
       generates code to run on x86 processors, the assembler itself can
       run on any system with an ANSI C compiler. Therefore, the assembler
       cannot guarantee the presence of a floating-point unit capable of
       handling the Intel number formats, and so for NASM to be able to do
       floating arithmetic it would have to include its own complete set of
       floating-point routines, which would significantly increase the size
       of the assembler for very little benefit.

   3.5 Expressions

       Expressions in NASM are similar in syntax to those in C.

       NASM does not guarantee the size of the integers used to evaluate
       expressions at compile time: since NASM can compile and run on 64-
       bit systems quite happily, don't assume that expressions are
       evaluated in 32-bit registers and so try to make deliberate use of
       integer overflow. It might not always work. The only thing NASM will
       guarantee is what's guaranteed by ANSI C: you always have _at least_
       32 bits to work in.

       NASM supports two special tokens in expressions, allowing
       calculations to involve the current assembly position: the `$' and
       `$$' tokens. `$' evaluates to the assembly position at the beginning
       of the line containing the expression; so you can code an infinite
       loop using `JMP $'. `$$' evaluates to the beginning of the current
       section; so you can tell how far into the section you are by using
       `($-$$)'.

       The arithmetic operators provided by NASM are listed here, in
       increasing order of precedence.

 3.5.1 `|': Bitwise OR Operator

       The `|' operator gives a bitwise OR, exactly as performed by the
       `OR' machine instruction. Bitwise OR is the lowest-priority
       arithmetic operator supported by NASM.

 3.5.2 `^': Bitwise XOR Operator

       `^' provides the bitwise XOR operation.

 3.5.3 `&': Bitwise AND Operator

       `&' provides the bitwise AND operation.

 3.5.4 `<<' and `>>': Bit Shift Operators

       `<<' gives a bit-shift to the left, just as it does in C. So `5<<3'
       evaluates to 5 times 8, or 40. `>>' gives a bit-shift to the right;
       in NASM, such a shift is _always_ unsigned, so that the bits shifted
       in from the left-hand end are filled with zero rather than a sign-
       extension of the previous highest bit.

 3.5.5 `+' and `-': Addition and Subtraction Operators

       The `+' and `-' operators do perfectly ordinary addition and
       subtraction.

 3.5.6 `*', `/', `//', `%' and `%%': Multiplication and Division

       `*' is the multiplication operator. `/' and `//' are both division
       operators: `/' is unsigned division and `//' is signed division.
       Similarly, `%' and `%%' provide unsigned and signed modulo operators
       respectively.

       NASM, like ANSI C, provides no guarantees about the sensible
       operation of the signed modulo operator.

       Since the `%' character is used extensively by the macro
       preprocessor, you should ensure that both the signed and unsigned
       modulo operators are followed by white space wherever they appear.

 3.5.7 Unary Operators: `+', `-', `~' and `SEG'

       The highest-priority operators in NASM's expression grammar are
       those which only apply to one argument. `-' negates its operand, `+'
       does nothing (it's provided for symmetry with `-'), `~' computes the
       one's complement of its operand, and `SEG' provides the segment
       address of its operand (explained in more detail in section 3.6).

   3.6 `SEG' and `WRT'

       When writing large 16-bit programs, which must be split into
       multiple segments, it is often necessary to be able to refer to the
       segment part of the address of a symbol. NASM supports the `SEG'
       operator to perform this function.

       The `SEG' operator returns the _preferred_ segment base of a symbol,
       defined as the segment base relative to which the offset of the
       symbol makes sense. So the code

               mov     ax,seg symbol 
               mov     es,ax 
               mov     bx,symbol

       will load `ES:BX' with a valid pointer to the symbol `symbol'.

       Things can be more complex than this: since 16-bit segments and
       groups may overlap, you might occasionally want to refer to some
       symbol using a different segment base from the preferred one. NASM
       lets you do this, by the use of the `WRT' (With Reference To)
       keyword. So you can do things like

               mov     ax,weird_seg        ; weird_seg is a segment base 
               mov     es,ax 
               mov     bx,symbol wrt weird_seg

       to load `ES:BX' with a different, but functionally equivalent,
       pointer to the symbol `symbol'.

       NASM supports far (inter-segment) calls and jumps by means of the
       syntax `call segment:offset', where `segment' and `offset' both
       represent immediate values. So to call a far procedure, you could
       code either of

               call    (seg procedure):procedure 
               call    weird_seg:(procedure wrt weird_seg)

       (The parentheses are included for clarity, to show the intended
       parsing of the above instructions. They are not necessary in
       practice.)

       NASM supports the syntax `call far procedure' as a synonym for the
       first of the above usages. `JMP' works identically to `CALL' in
       these examples.

       To declare a far pointer to a data item in a data segment, you must
       code

               dw      symbol, seg symbol

       NASM supports no convenient synonym for this, though you can always
       invent one using the macro processor.

   3.7 `STRICT': Inhibiting Optimization

       When assembling with the optimizer set to level 2 or higher (see
       section 2.1.16), NASM will use size specifiers (`BYTE', `WORD',
       `DWORD', `QWORD', or `TWORD'), but will give them the smallest
       possible size. The keyword `STRICT' can be used to inhibit
       optimization and force a particular operand to be emitted in the
       specified size. For example, with the optimizer on, and in `BITS 16'
       mode,

               push dword 33

       is encoded in three bytes `66 6A 21', whereas

               push strict dword 33

       is encoded in six bytes, with a full dword immediate operand
       `66 68 21 00 00 00'.

       With the optimizer off, the same code (six bytes) is generated
       whether the `STRICT' keyword was used or not.

   3.8 Critical Expressions

       A limitation of NASM is that it is a two-pass assembler; unlike TASM
       and others, it will always do exactly two assembly passes. Therefore
       it is unable to cope with source files that are complex enough to
       require three or more passes.

       The first pass is used to determine the size of all the assembled
       code and data, so that the second pass, when generating all the
       code, knows all the symbol addresses the code refers to. So one
       thing NASM can't handle is code whose size depends on the value of a
       symbol declared after the code in question. For example,

               times (label-$) db 0 
       label:  db      'Where am I?'

       The argument to `TIMES' in this case could equally legally evaluate
       to anything at all; NASM will reject this example because it cannot
       tell the size of the `TIMES' line when it first sees it. It will
       just as firmly reject the slightly paradoxical code

               times (label-$+1) db 0 
       label:  db      'NOW where am I?'

       in which _any_ value for the `TIMES' argument is by definition
       wrong!

       NASM rejects these examples by means of a concept called a _critical
       expression_, which is defined to be an expression whose value is
       required to be computable in the first pass, and which must
       therefore depend only on symbols defined before it. The argument to
       the `TIMES' prefix is a critical expression; for the same reason,
       the arguments to the `RESB' family of pseudo-instructions are also
       critical expressions.

       Critical expressions can crop up in other contexts as well: consider
       the following code.

                       mov     ax,symbol1 
       symbol1         equ     symbol2 
       symbol2:

       On the first pass, NASM cannot determine the value of `symbol1',
       because `symbol1' is defined to be equal to `symbol2' which NASM
       hasn't seen yet. On the second pass, therefore, when it encounters
       the line `mov ax,symbol1', it is unable to generate the code for it
       because it still doesn't know the value of `symbol1'. On the next
       line, it would see the `EQU' again and be able to determine the
       value of `symbol1', but by then it would be too late.

       NASM avoids this problem by defining the right-hand side of an `EQU'
       statement to be a critical expression, so the definition of
       `symbol1' would be rejected in the first pass.

       There is a related issue involving forward references: consider this
       code fragment.

               mov     eax,[ebx+offset] 
       offset  equ     10

       NASM, on pass one, must calculate the size of the instruction
       `mov eax,[ebx+offset]' without knowing the value of `offset'. It has
       no way of knowing that `offset' is small enough to fit into a one-
       byte offset field and that it could therefore get away with
       generating a shorter form of the effective-address encoding; for all
       it knows, in pass one, `offset' could be a symbol in the code
       segment, and it might need the full four-byte form. So it is forced
       to compute the size of the instruction to accommodate a four-byte
       address part. In pass two, having made this decision, it is now
       forced to honour it and keep the instruction large, so the code
       generated in this case is not as small as it could have been. This
       problem can be solved by defining `offset' before using it, or by
       forcing byte size in the effective address by coding
       `[byte ebx+offset]'.

       Note that use of the `-On' switch (with n>=2) makes some of the
       above no longer true (see section 2.1.16).

   3.9 Local Labels

       NASM gives special treatment to symbols beginning with a period. A
       label beginning with a single period is treated as a _local_ label,
       which means that it is associated with the previous non-local label.
       So, for example:

       label1  ; some code 
       
       .loop 
               ; some more code 
       
               jne     .loop 
               ret 
       
       label2  ; some code 
       
       .loop 
               ; some more code 
       
               jne     .loop 
               ret

       In the above code fragment, each `JNE' instruction jumps to the line
       immediately before it, because the two definitions of `.loop' are
       kept separate by virtue of each being associated with the previous
       non-local label.

       This form of local label handling is borrowed from the old Amiga
       assembler DevPac; however, NASM goes one step further, in allowing
       access to local labels from other parts of the code. This is
       achieved by means of _defining_ a local label in terms of the
       previous non-local label: the first definition of `.loop' above is
       really defining a symbol called `label1.loop', and the second
       defines a symbol called `label2.loop'. So, if you really needed to,
       you could write

       label3  ; some more code 
               ; and some more 
       
               jmp label1.loop

       Sometimes it is useful - in a macro, for instance - to be able to
       define a label which can be referenced from anywhere but which
       doesn't interfere with the normal local-label mechanism. Such a
       label can't be non-local because it would interfere with subsequent
       definitions of, and references to, local labels; and it can't be
       local because the macro that defined it wouldn't know the label's
       full name. NASM therefore introduces a third type of label, which is
       probably only useful in macro definitions: if a label begins with
       the special prefix `..@', then it does nothing to the local label
       mechanism. So you could code

       label1:                         ; a non-local label 
       .local:                         ; this is really label1.local 
       ..@foo:                         ; this is a special symbol 
       label2:                         ; another non-local label 
       .local:                         ; this is really label2.local 
       
               jmp     ..@foo          ; this will jump three lines up

       NASM has the capacity to define other special symbols beginning with
       a double period: for example, `..start' is used to specify the entry
       point in the `obj' output format (see section 6.2.6).

Chapter 4: The NASM Preprocessor
--------------------------------

       NASM contains a powerful macro processor, which supports conditional
       assembly, multi-level file inclusion, two forms of macro (single-
       line and multi-line), and a `context stack' mechanism for extra
       macro power. Preprocessor directives all begin with a `%' sign.

       The preprocessor collapses all lines which end with a backslash (\)
       character into a single line. Thus:

       %define THIS_VERY_LONG_MACRO_NAME_IS_DEFINED_TO \ 
               THIS_VALUE

       will work like a single-line macro without the backslash-newline
       sequence.

   4.1 Single-Line Macros

 4.1.1 The Normal Way: `%define'

       Single-line macros are defined using the `%define' preprocessor
       directive. The definitions work in a similar way to C; so you can do
       things like

       %define ctrl    0x1F & 
       %define param(a,b) ((a)+(a)*(b)) 
       
               mov     byte [param(2,ebx)], ctrl 'D'

       which will expand to

               mov     byte [(2)+(2)*(ebx)], 0x1F & 'D'

       When the expansion of a single-line macro contains tokens which
       invoke another macro, the expansion is performed at invocation time,
       not at definition time. Thus the code

       %define a(x)    1+b(x) 
       %define b(x)    2*x 
       
               mov     ax,a(8)

       will evaluate in the expected way to `mov ax,1+2*8', even though the
       macro `b' wasn't defined at the time of definition of `a'.

       Macros defined with `%define' are case sensitive: after
       `%define foo bar', only `foo' will expand to `bar': `Foo' or `FOO'
       will not. By using `%idefine' instead of `%define' (the `i' stands
       for `insensitive') you can define all the case variants of a macro
       at once, so that `%idefine foo bar' would cause `foo', `Foo', `FOO',
       `fOO' and so on all to expand to `bar'.

       There is a mechanism which detects when a macro call has occurred as
       a result of a previous expansion of the same macro, to guard against
       circular references and infinite loops. If this happens, the
       preprocessor will only expand the first occurrence of the macro.
       Hence, if you code

       %define a(x)    1+a(x) 
       
               mov     ax,a(3)

       the macro `a(3)' will expand once, becoming `1+a(3)', and will then
       expand no further. This behaviour can be useful: see section 8.1 for
       an example of its use.

       You can overload single-line macros: if you write

       %define foo(x)   1+x 
       %define foo(x,y) 1+x*y

       the preprocessor will be able to handle both types of macro call, by
       counting the parameters you pass; so `foo(3)' will become `1+3'
       whereas `foo(ebx,2)' will become `1+ebx*2'. However, if you define

       %define foo bar

       then no other definition of `foo' will be accepted: a macro with no
       parameters prohibits the definition of the same name as a macro
       _with_ parameters, and vice versa.

       This doesn't prevent single-line macros being _redefined_: you can
       perfectly well define a macro with

       %define foo bar

       and then re-define it later in the same source file with

       %define foo baz

       Then everywhere the macro `foo' is invoked, it will be expanded
       according to the most recent definition. This is particularly useful
       when defining single-line macros with `%assign' (see section 4.1.5).

       You can pre-define single-line macros using the `-d' option on the
       NASM command line: see section 2.1.12.

 4.1.2 Enhancing %define: `%xdefine'

       To have a reference to an embedded single-line macro resolved at the
       time that it is embedded, as opposed to when the calling macro is
       expanded, you need a different mechanism to the one offered by
       `%define'. The solution is to use `%xdefine', or it's case-
       insensitive counterpart `%xidefine'.

       Suppose you have the following code:

       %define  isTrue  1 
       %define  isFalse isTrue 
       %define  isTrue  0 
       
       val1:    db      isFalse 
       
       %define  isTrue  1 
       
       val2:    db      isFalse

       In this case, `val1' is equal to 0, and `val2' is equal to 1. This
       is because, when a single-line macro is defined using `%define', it
       is expanded only when it is called. As `isFalse' expands to
       `isTrue', the expansion will be the current value of `isTrue'. The
       first time it is called that is 0, and the second time it is 1.

       If you wanted `isFalse' to expand to the value assigned to the
       embedded macro `isTrue' at the time that `isFalse' was defined, you
       need to change the above code to use `%xdefine'.

       %xdefine isTrue  1 
       %xdefine isFalse isTrue 
       %xdefine isTrue  0 
       
       val1:    db      isFalse 
       
       %xdefine isTrue  1 
       
       val2:    db      isFalse

       Now, each time that `isFalse' is called, it expands to 1, as that is
       what the embedded macro `isTrue' expanded to at the time that
       `isFalse' was defined.

 4.1.3 Concatenating Single Line Macro Tokens: `%+'

       Individual tokens in single line macros can be concatenated, to
       produce longer tokens for later processing. This can be useful if
       there are several similar macros that perform similar functions.

       As an example, consider the following:

       %define BDASTART 400h                ; Start of BIOS data area

       struc   tBIOSDA                      ; its structure 
               .COM1addr       RESW    1 
               .COM2addr       RESW    1 
               ; ..and so on 
       endstruc

       Now, if we need to access the elements of tBIOSDA in different
       places, we can end up with:

               mov     ax,BDASTART + tBIOSDA.COM1addr 
               mov     bx,BDASTART + tBIOSDA.COM2addr

       This will become pretty ugly (and tedious) if used in many places,
       and can be reduced in size significantly by using the following
       macro:

       ; Macro to access BIOS variables by their names (from tBDA):

       %define BDA(x)  BDASTART + tBIOSDA. %+ x

       Now the above code can be written as:

               mov     ax,BDA(COM1addr) 
               mov     bx,BDA(COM2addr)

       Using this feature, we can simplify references to a lot of macros
       (and, in turn, reduce typing errors).

 4.1.4 Undefining macros: `%undef'

       Single-line macros can be removed with the `%undef' command. For
       example, the following sequence:

       %define foo bar 
       %undef  foo 
       
               mov     eax, foo

       will expand to the instruction `mov eax, foo', since after `%undef'
       the macro `foo' is no longer defined.

       Macros that would otherwise be pre-defined can be undefined on the
       command-line using the `-u' option on the NASM command line: see
       section 2.1.13.

 4.1.5 Preprocessor Variables: `%assign'

       An alternative way to define single-line macros is by means of the
       `%assign' command (and its case-insensitive counterpart `%iassign',
       which differs from `%assign' in exactly the same way that `%idefine'
       differs from `%define').

       `%assign' is used to define single-line macros which take no
       parameters and have a numeric value. This value can be specified in
       the form of an expression, and it will be evaluated once, when the
       `%assign' directive is processed.

       Like `%define', macros defined using `%assign' can be re-defined
       later, so you can do things like

       %assign i i+1

       to increment the numeric value of a macro.

       `%assign' is useful for controlling the termination of `%rep'
       preprocessor loops: see section 4.5 for an example of this. Another
       use for `%assign' is given in section 7.4 and section 8.1.

       The expression passed to `%assign' is a critical expression (see
       section 3.8), and must also evaluate to a pure number (rather than a
       relocatable reference such as a code or data address, or anything
       involving a register).

   4.2 String Handling in Macros: `%strlen' and `%substr'

       It's often useful to be able to handle strings in macros. NASM
       supports two simple string handling macro operators from which more
       complex operations can be constructed.

 4.2.1 String Length: `%strlen'

       The `%strlen' macro is like `%assign' macro in that it creates (or
       redefines) a numeric value to a macro. The difference is that with
       `%strlen', the numeric value is the length of a string. An example
       of the use of this would be:

       %strlen charcnt 'my string'

       In this example, `charcnt' would receive the value 8, just as if an
       `%assign' had been used. In this example, `'my string'' was a
       literal string but it could also have been a single-line macro that
       expands to a string, as in the following example:

       %define sometext 'my string' 
       %strlen charcnt sometext

       As in the first case, this would result in `charcnt' being assigned
       the value of 8.

 4.2.2 Sub-strings: `%substr'

       Individual letters in strings can be extracted using `%substr'. An
       example of its use is probably more useful than the description:

       %substr mychar  'xyz' 1         ; equivalent to %define mychar 'x' 
       %substr mychar  'xyz' 2         ; equivalent to %define mychar 'y' 
       %substr mychar  'xyz' 3         ; equivalent to %define mychar 'z'

       In this example, mychar gets the value of 'y'. As with `%strlen'
       (see section 4.2.1), the first parameter is the single-line macro to
       be created and the second is the string. The third parameter
       specifies which character is to be selected. Note that the first
       index is 1, not 0 and the last index is equal to the value that
       `%strlen' would assign given the same string. Index values out of
       range result in an empty string.

   4.3 Multi-Line Macros: `%macro'

       Multi-line macros are much more like the type of macro seen in MASM
       and TASM: a multi-line macro definition in NASM looks something like
       this.

       %macro  prologue 1 
       
               push    ebp 
               mov     ebp,esp 
               sub     esp,%1 
       
       %endmacro

       This defines a C-like function prologue as a macro: so you would
       invoke the macro with a call such as

       myfunc:   prologue 12

       which would expand to the three lines of code

       myfunc: push    ebp 
               mov     ebp,esp 
               sub     esp,12

       The number `1' after the macro name in the `%macro' line defines the
       number of parameters the macro `prologue' expects to receive. The
       use of `%1' inside the macro definition refers to the first
       parameter to the macro call. With a macro taking more than one
       parameter, subsequent parameters would be referred to as `%2', `%3'
       and so on.

       Multi-line macros, like single-line macros, are case-sensitive,
       unless you define them using the alternative directive `%imacro'.

       If you need to pass a comma as _part_ of a parameter to a multi-line
       macro, you can do that by enclosing the entire parameter in braces.
       So you could code things like

       %macro  silly 2 
       
           %2: db      %1 
       
       %endmacro 
       
               silly 'a', letter_a             ; letter_a:  db 'a' 
               silly 'ab', string_ab           ; string_ab: db 'ab' 
               silly {13,10}, crlf             ; crlf:      db 13,10

 4.3.1 Overloading Multi-Line Macros

       As with single-line macros, multi-line macros can be overloaded by
       defining the same macro name several times with different numbers of
       parameters. This time, no exception is made for macros with no
       parameters at all. So you could define

       %macro  prologue 0 
       
               push    ebp 
               mov     ebp,esp 
       
       %endmacro

       to define an alternative form of the function prologue which
       allocates no local stack space.

       Sometimes, however, you might want to `overload' a machine
       instruction; for example, you might want to define

       %macro  push 2 
       
               push    %1 
               push    %2 
       
       %endmacro

       so that you could code

               push    ebx             ; this line is not a macro call 
               push    eax,ecx         ; but this one is

       Ordinarily, NASM will give a warning for the first of the above two
       lines, since `push' is now defined to be a macro, and is being
       invoked with a number of parameters for which no definition has been
       given. The correct code will still be generated, but the assembler
       will give a warning. This warning can be disabled by the use of the
       `-w-macro-params' command-line option (see section 2.1.18).

 4.3.2 Macro-Local Labels

       NASM allows you to define labels within a multi-line macro
       definition in such a way as to make them local to the macro call: so
       calling the same macro multiple times will use a different label
       each time. You do this by prefixing `%%' to the label name. So you
       can invent an instruction which executes a `RET' if the `Z' flag is
       set by doing this:

       %macro  retz 0 
       
               jnz     %%skip 
               ret 
           %%skip: 
       
       %endmacro

       You can call this macro as many times as you want, and every time
       you call it NASM will make up a different `real' name to substitute
       for the label `%%skip'. The names NASM invents are of the form
       `..@2345.skip', where the number 2345 changes with every macro call.
       The `..@' prefix prevents macro-local labels from interfering with
       the local label mechanism, as described in section 3.9. You should
       avoid defining your own labels in this form (the `..@' prefix, then
       a number, then another period) in case they interfere with macro-
       local labels.

 4.3.3 Greedy Macro Parameters

       Occasionally it is useful to define a macro which lumps its entire
       command line into one parameter definition, possibly after
       extracting one or two smaller parameters from the front. An example
       might be a macro to write a text string to a file in MS-DOS, where
       you might want to be able to write

               writefile [filehandle],"hello, world",13,10

       NASM allows you to define the last parameter of a macro to be
       _greedy_, meaning that if you invoke the macro with more parameters
       than it expects, all the spare parameters get lumped into the last
       defined one along with the separating commas. So if you code:

       %macro  writefile 2+ 
       
               jmp     %%endstr 
         %%str:        db      %2 
         %%endstr: 
               mov     dx,%%str 
               mov     cx,%%endstr-%%str 
               mov     bx,%1 
               mov     ah,0x40 
               int     0x21 
       
       %endmacro

       then the example call to `writefile' above will work as expected:
       the text before the first comma, `[filehandle]', is used as the
       first macro parameter and expanded when `%1' is referred to, and all
       the subsequent text is lumped into `%2' and placed after the `db'.

       The greedy nature of the macro is indicated to NASM by the use of
       the `+' sign after the parameter count on the `%macro' line.

       If you define a greedy macro, you are effectively telling NASM how
       it should expand the macro given _any_ number of parameters from the
       actual number specified up to infinity; in this case, for example,
       NASM now knows what to do when it sees a call to `writefile' with 2,
       3, 4 or more parameters. NASM will take this into account when
       overloading macros, and will not allow you to define another form of
       `writefile' taking 4 parameters (for example).

       Of course, the above macro could have been implemented as a non-
       greedy macro, in which case the call to it would have had to look
       like

                 writefile [filehandle], {"hello, world",13,10}

       NASM provides both mechanisms for putting commas in macro
       parameters, and you choose which one you prefer for each macro
       definition.

       See section 5.2.1 for a better way to write the above macro.

 4.3.4 Default Macro Parameters

       NASM also allows you to define a multi-line macro with a _range_ of
       allowable parameter counts. If you do this, you can specify defaults
       for omitted parameters. So, for example:

       %macro  die 0-1 "Painful program death has occurred." 
       
               writefile 2,%1 
               mov     ax,0x4c01 
               int     0x21 
       
       %endmacro

       This macro (which makes use of the `writefile' macro defined in
       section 4.3.3) can be called with an explicit error message, which
       it will display on the error output stream before exiting, or it can
       be called with no parameters, in which case it will use the default
       error message supplied in the macro definition.

       In general, you supply a minimum and maximum number of parameters
       for a macro of this type; the minimum number of parameters are then
       required in the macro call, and then you provide defaults for the
       optional ones. So if a macro definition began with the line

       %macro foobar 1-3 eax,[ebx+2]

       then it could be called with between one and three parameters, and
       `%1' would always be taken from the macro call. `%2', if not
       specified by the macro call, would default to `eax', and `%3' if not
       specified would default to `[ebx+2]'.

       You may omit parameter defaults from the macro definition, in which
       case the parameter default is taken to be blank. This can be useful
       for macros which can take a variable number of parameters, since the
       `%0' token (see section 4.3.5) allows you to determine how many
       parameters were really passed to the macro call.

       This defaulting mechanism can be combined with the greedy-parameter
       mechanism; so the `die' macro above could be made more powerful, and
       more useful, by changing the first line of the definition to

       %macro die 0-1+ "Painful program death has occurred.",13,10

       The maximum parameter count can be infinite, denoted by `*'. In this
       case, of course, it is impossible to provide a _full_ set of default
       parameters. Examples of this usage are shown in section 4.3.6.

 4.3.5 `%0': Macro Parameter Counter

       For a macro which can take a variable number of parameters, the
       parameter reference `%0' will return a numeric constant giving the
       number of parameters passed to the macro. This can be used as an
       argument to `%rep' (see section 4.5) in order to iterate through all
       the parameters of a macro. Examples are given in section 4.3.6.

 4.3.6 `%rotate': Rotating Macro Parameters

       Unix shell programmers will be familiar with the `shift' shell
       command, which allows the arguments passed to a shell script
       (referenced as `$1', `$2' and so on) to be moved left by one place,
       so that the argument previously referenced as `$2' becomes available
       as `$1', and the argument previously referenced as `$1' is no longer
       available at all.

       NASM provides a similar mechanism, in the form of `%rotate'. As its
       name suggests, it differs from the Unix `shift' in that no
       parameters are lost: parameters rotated off the left end of the
       argument list reappear on the right, and vice versa.

       `%rotate' is invoked with a single numeric argument (which may be an
       expression). The macro parameters are rotated to the left by that
       many places. If the argument to `%rotate' is negative, the macro
       parameters are rotated to the right.

       So a pair of macros to save and restore a set of registers might
       work as follows:

       %macro  multipush 1-* 
       
         %rep  %0 
               push    %1 
         %rotate 1 
         %endrep 
       
       %endmacro

       This macro invokes the `PUSH' instruction on each of its arguments
       in turn, from left to right. It begins by pushing its first
       argument, `%1', then invokes `%rotate' to move all the arguments one
       place to the left, so that the original second argument is now
       available as `%1'. Repeating this procedure as many times as there
       were arguments (achieved by supplying `%0' as the argument to
       `%rep') causes each argument in turn to be pushed.

       Note also the use of `*' as the maximum parameter count, indicating
       that there is no upper limit on the number of parameters you may
       supply to the `multipush' macro.

       It would be convenient, when using this macro, to have a `POP'
       equivalent, which _didn't_ require the arguments to be given in
       reverse order. Ideally, you would write the `multipush' macro call,
       then cut-and-paste the line to where the pop needed to be done, and
       change the name of the called macro to `multipop', and the macro
       would take care of popping the registers in the opposite order from
       the one in which they were pushed.

       This can be done by the following definition:

       %macro  multipop 1-* 
       
         %rep %0 
         %rotate -1 
               pop     %1 
         %endrep 
       
       %endmacro

       This macro begins by rotating its arguments one place to the
       _right_, so that the original _last_ argument appears as `%1'. This
       is then popped, and the arguments are rotated right again, so the
       second-to-last argument becomes `%1'. Thus the arguments are
       iterated through in reverse order.

 4.3.7 Concatenating Macro Parameters

       NASM can concatenate macro parameters on to other text surrounding
       them. This allows you to declare a family of symbols, for example,
       in a macro definition. If, for example, you wanted to generate a
       table of key codes along with offsets into the table, you could code
       something like

       %macro keytab_entry 2 
       
           keypos%1    equ     $-keytab 
                       db      %2 
       
       %endmacro 
       
       keytab: 
                 keytab_entry F1,128+1 
                 keytab_entry F2,128+2 
                 keytab_entry Return,13

       which would expand to

       keytab: 
       keyposF1        equ     $-keytab 
                       db     128+1 
       keyposF2        equ     $-keytab 
                       db      128+2 
       keyposReturn    equ     $-keytab 
                       db      13

       You can just as easily concatenate text on to the other end of a
       macro parameter, by writing `%1foo'.

       If you need to append a _digit_ to a macro parameter, for example
       defining labels `foo1' and `foo2' when passed the parameter `foo',
       you can't code `%11' because that would be taken as the eleventh
       macro parameter. Instead, you must code `%{1}1', which will separate
       the first `1' (giving the number of the macro parameter) from the
       second (literal text to be concatenated to the parameter).

       This concatenation can also be applied to other preprocessor in-line
       objects, such as macro-local labels (section 4.3.2) and context-
       local labels (section 4.7.2). In all cases, ambiguities in syntax
       can be resolved by enclosing everything after the `%' sign and
       before the literal text in braces: so `%{%foo}bar' concatenates the
       text `bar' to the end of the real name of the macro-local label
       `%%foo'. (This is unnecessary, since the form NASM uses for the real
       names of macro-local labels means that the two usages `%{%foo}bar'
       and `%%foobar' would both expand to the same thing anyway;
       nevertheless, the capability is there.)

 4.3.8 Condition Codes as Macro Parameters

       NASM can give special treatment to a macro parameter which contains
       a condition code. For a start, you can refer to the macro parameter
       `%1' by means of the alternative syntax `%+1', which informs NASM
       that this macro parameter is supposed to contain a condition code,
       and will cause the preprocessor to report an error message if the
       macro is called with a parameter which is _not_ a valid condition
       code.

       Far more usefully, though, you can refer to the macro parameter by
       means of `%-1', which NASM will expand as the _inverse_ condition
       code. So the `retz' macro defined in section 4.3.2 can be replaced
       by a general conditional-return macro like this:

       %macro  retc 1 
       
               j%-1    %%skip 
               ret 
         %%skip: 
       
       %endmacro

       This macro can now be invoked using calls like `retc ne', which will
       cause the conditional-jump instruction in the macro expansion to
       come out as `JE', or `retc po' which will make the jump a `JPE'.

       The `%+1' macro-parameter reference is quite happy to interpret the
       arguments `CXZ' and `ECXZ' as valid condition codes; however, `%-1'
       will report an error if passed either of these, because no inverse
       condition code exists.

 4.3.9 Disabling Listing Expansion

       When NASM is generating a listing file from your program, it will
       generally expand multi-line macros by means of writing the macro
       call and then listing each line of the expansion. This allows you to
       see which instructions in the macro expansion are generating what
       code; however, for some macros this clutters the listing up
       unnecessarily.

       NASM therefore provides the `.nolist' qualifier, which you can
       include in a macro definition to inhibit the expansion of the macro
       in the listing file. The `.nolist' qualifier comes directly after
       the number of parameters, like this:

       %macro foo 1.nolist

       Or like this:

       %macro bar 1-5+.nolist a,b,c,d,e,f,g,h

   4.4 Conditional Assembly

       Similarly to the C preprocessor, NASM allows sections of a source
       file to be assembled only if certain conditions are met. The general
       syntax of this feature looks like this:

       %if<condition> 
           ; some code which only appears if <condition> is met 
       %elif<condition2> 
           ; only appears if <condition> is not met but <condition2> is 
       %else 
           ; this appears if neither <condition> nor <condition2> was met 
       %endif

       The `%else' clause is optional, as is the `%elif' clause. You can
       have more than one `%elif' clause as well.

 4.4.1 `%ifdef': Testing Single-Line Macro Existence

       Beginning a conditional-assembly block with the line `%ifdef MACRO'
       will assemble the subsequent code if, and only if, a single-line
       macro called `MACRO' is defined. If not, then the `%elif' and
       `%else' blocks (if any) will be processed instead.

       For example, when debugging a program, you might want to write code
       such as

                 ; perform some function 
       %ifdef DEBUG 
                 writefile 2,"Function performed successfully",13,10 
       %endif 
                 ; go and do something else

       Then you could use the command-line option `-dDEBUG' to create a
       version of the program which produced debugging messages, and remove
       the option to generate the final release version of the program.

       You can test for a macro _not_ being defined by using `%ifndef'
       instead of `%ifdef'. You can also test for macro definitions in
       `%elif' blocks by using `%elifdef' and `%elifndef'.

 4.4.2 `ifmacro': Testing Multi-Line Macro Existence

       The `%ifmacro' directive operates in the same way as the `%ifdef'
       directive, except that it checks for the existence of a multi-line
       macro.

       For example, you may be working with a large project and not have
       control over the macros in a library. You may want to create a macro
       with one name if it doesn't already exist, and another name if one
       with that name does exist.

       The `%ifmacro' is considered true if defining a macro with the given
       name and number of arguments would cause a definitions conflict. For
       example:

       %ifmacro MyMacro 1-3 
       
            %error "MyMacro 1-3" causes a conflict with an existing macro. 
       
       %else 
       
            %macro MyMacro 1-3 
       
                    ; insert code to define the macro 
       
            %endmacro 
       
       %endif

       This will create the macro "MyMacro 1-3" if no macro already exists
       which would conflict with it, and emits a warning if there would be
       a definition conflict.

       You can test for the macro not existing by using the `%ifnmacro'
       instead of `%ifmacro'. Additional tests can be performed in `%elif'
       blocks by using `%elifmacro' and `%elifnmacro'.

 4.4.3 `%ifctx': Testing the Context Stack

       The conditional-assembly construct `%ifctx ctxname' will cause the
       subsequent code to be assembled if and only if the top context on
       the preprocessor's context stack has the name `ctxname'. As with
       `%ifdef', the inverse and `%elif' forms `%ifnctx', `%elifctx' and
       `%elifnctx' are also supported.

       For more details of the context stack, see section 4.7. For a sample
       use of `%ifctx', see section 4.7.5.

 4.4.4 `%if': Testing Arbitrary Numeric Expressions

       The conditional-assembly construct `%if expr' will cause the
       subsequent code to be assembled if and only if the value of the
       numeric expression `expr' is non-zero. An example of the use of this
       feature is in deciding when to break out of a `%rep' preprocessor
       loop: see section 4.5 for a detailed example.

       The expression given to `%if', and its counterpart `%elif', is a
       critical expression (see section 3.8).

       `%if' extends the normal NASM expression syntax, by providing a set
       of relational operators which are not normally available in
       expressions. The operators `=', `<', `>', `<=', `>=' and `<>' test
       equality, less-than, greater-than, less-or-equal, greater-or-equal
       and not-equal respectively. The C-like forms `==' and `!=' are
       supported as alternative forms of `=' and `<>'. In addition, low-
       priority logical operators `&&', `^^' and `||' are provided,
       supplying logical AND, logical XOR and logical OR. These work like
       the C logical operators (although C has no logical XOR), in that
       they always return either 0 or 1, and treat any non-zero input as 1
       (so that `^^', for example, returns 1 if exactly one of its inputs
       is zero, and 0 otherwise). The relational operators also return 1
       for true and 0 for false.

 4.4.5 `%ifidn' and `%ifidni': Testing Exact Text Identity

       The construct `%ifidn text1,text2' will cause the subsequent code to
       be assembled if and only if `text1' and `text2', after expanding
       single-line macros, are identical pieces of text. Differences in
       white space are not counted.

       `%ifidni' is similar to `%ifidn', but is case-insensitive.

       For example, the following macro pushes a register or number on the
       stack, and allows you to treat `IP' as a real register:

       %macro  pushparam 1 
       
         %ifidni %1,ip 
               call    %%label 
         %%label: 
         %else 
               push    %1 
         %endif 
       
       %endmacro

       Like most other `%if' constructs, `%ifidn' has a counterpart
       `%elifidn', and negative forms `%ifnidn' and `%elifnidn'. Similarly,
       `%ifidni' has counterparts `%elifidni', `%ifnidni' and `%elifnidni'.

 4.4.6 `%ifid', `%ifnum', `%ifstr': Testing Token Types

       Some macros will want to perform different tasks depending on
       whether they are passed a number, a string, or an identifier. For
       example, a string output macro might want to be able to cope with
       being passed either a string constant or a pointer to an existing
       string.

       The conditional assembly construct `%ifid', taking one parameter
       (which may be blank), assembles the subsequent code if and only if
       the first token in the parameter exists and is an identifier.
       `%ifnum' works similarly, but tests for the token being a numeric
       constant; `%ifstr' tests for it being a string.

       For example, the `writefile' macro defined in section 4.3.3 can be
       extended to take advantage of `%ifstr' in the following fashion:

       %macro writefile 2-3+ 
       
         %ifstr %2 
               jmp     %%endstr 
           %if %0 = 3 
             %%str:    db      %2,%3 
           %else 
             %%str:    db      %2 
           %endif 
             %%endstr: mov     dx,%%str 
                       mov     cx,%%endstr-%%str 
         %else 
                       mov     dx,%2 
                       mov     cx,%3 
         %endif 
                       mov     bx,%1 
                       mov     ah,0x40 
                       int     0x21 
       
       %endmacro

       Then the `writefile' macro can cope with being called in either of
       the following two ways:

               writefile [file], strpointer, length 
               writefile [file], "hello", 13, 10

       In the first, `strpointer' is used as the address of an already-
       declared string, and `length' is used as its length; in the second,
       a string is given to the macro, which therefore declares it itself
       and works out the address and length for itself.

       Note the use of `%if' inside the `%ifstr': this is to detect whether
       the macro was passed two arguments (so the string would be a single
       string constant, and `db %2' would be adequate) or more (in which
       case, all but the first two would be lumped together into `%3', and
       `db %2,%3' would be required).

         The usual `%elifXXX', `%ifnXXX' and `%elifnXXX' versions exist for
       each of `%ifid', `%ifnum' and `%ifstr'.

 4.4.7 `%error': Reporting User-Defined Errors

       The preprocessor directive `%error' will cause NASM to report an
       error if it occurs in assembled code. So if other users are going to
       try to assemble your source files, you can ensure that they define
       the right macros by means of code like this:

       %ifdef SOME_MACRO 
           ; do some setup 
       %elifdef SOME_OTHER_MACRO 
           ; do some different setup 
       %else 
           %error Neither SOME_MACRO nor SOME_OTHER_MACRO was defined. 
       %endif

       Then any user who fails to understand the way your code is supposed
       to be assembled will be quickly warned of their mistake, rather than
       having to wait until the program crashes on being run and then not
       knowing what went wrong.

   4.5 Preprocessor Loops: `%rep'

       NASM's `TIMES' prefix, though useful, cannot be used to invoke a
       multi-line macro multiple times, because it is processed by NASM
       after macros have already been expanded. Therefore NASM provides
       another form of loop, this time at the preprocessor level: `%rep'.

       The directives `%rep' and `%endrep' (`%rep' takes a numeric
       argument, which can be an expression; `%endrep' takes no arguments)
       can be used to enclose a chunk of code, which is then replicated as
       many times as specified by the preprocessor:

       %assign i 0 
       %rep    64 
               inc     word [table+2*i] 
       %assign i i+1 
       %endrep

       This will generate a sequence of 64 `INC' instructions, incrementing
       every word of memory from `[table]' to `[table+126]'.

       For more complex termination conditions, or to break out of a repeat
       loop part way along, you can use the `%exitrep' directive to
       terminate the loop, like this:

       fibonacci: 
       %assign i 0 
       %assign j 1 
       %rep 100 
       %if j > 65535 
           %exitrep 
       %endif 
               dw j 
       %assign k j+i 
       %assign i j 
       %assign j k 
       %endrep 
       
       fib_number equ ($-fibonacci)/2

       This produces a list of all the Fibonacci numbers that will fit in
       16 bits. Note that a maximum repeat count must still be given to
       `%rep'. This is to prevent the possibility of NASM getting into an
       infinite loop in the preprocessor, which (on multitasking or multi-
       user systems) would typically cause all the system memory to be
       gradually used up and other applications to start crashing.

   4.6 Including Other Files

       Using, once again, a very similar syntax to the C preprocessor,
       NASM's preprocessor lets you include other source files into your
       code. This is done by the use of the `%include' directive:

       %include "macros.mac"

       will include the contents of the file `macros.mac' into the source
       file containing the `%include' directive.

       Include files are searched for in the current directory (the
       directory you're in when you run NASM, as opposed to the location of
       the NASM executable or the location of the source file), plus any
       directories specified on the NASM command line using the `-i'
       option.

       The standard C idiom for preventing a file being included more than
       once is just as applicable in NASM: if the file `macros.mac' has the
       form

       %ifndef MACROS_MAC 
           %define MACROS_MAC 
           ; now define some macros 
       %endif

       then including the file more than once will not cause errors,
       because the second time the file is included nothing will happen
       because the macro `MACROS_MAC' will already be defined.

       You can force a file to be included even if there is no `%include'
       directive that explicitly includes it, by using the `-p' option on
       the NASM command line (see section 2.1.11).

   4.7 The Context Stack

       Having labels that are local to a macro definition is sometimes not
       quite powerful enough: sometimes you want to be able to share labels
       between several macro calls. An example might be a `REPEAT' ...
       `UNTIL' loop, in which the expansion of the `REPEAT' macro would
       need to be able to refer to a label which the `UNTIL' macro had
       defined. However, for such a macro you would also want to be able to
       nest these loops.

       NASM provides this level of power by means of a _context stack_. The
       preprocessor maintains a stack of _contexts_, each of which is
       characterised by a name. You add a new context to the stack using
       the `%push' directive, and remove one using `%pop'. You can define
       labels that are local to a particular context on the stack.

 4.7.1 `%push' and `%pop': Creating and Removing Contexts

       The `%push' directive is used to create a new context and place it
       on the top of the context stack. `%push' requires one argument,
       which is the name of the context. For example:

       %push    foobar

       This pushes a new context called `foobar' on the stack. You can have
       several contexts on the stack with the same name: they can still be
       distinguished.

       The directive `%pop', requiring no arguments, removes the top
       context from the context stack and destroys it, along with any
       labels associated with it.

 4.7.2 Context-Local Labels

       Just as the usage `%%foo' defines a label which is local to the
       particular macro call in which it is used, the usage `%$foo' is used
       to define a label which is local to the context on the top of the
       context stack. So the `REPEAT' and `UNTIL' example given above could
       be implemented by means of:

       %macro repeat 0 
       
           %push   repeat 
           %$begin: 
       
       %endmacro 
       
       %macro until 1 
       
               j%-1    %$begin 
           %pop 
       
       %endmacro

       and invoked by means of, for example,

               mov     cx,string 
               repeat 
               add     cx,3 
               scasb 
               until   e

       which would scan every fourth byte of a string in search of the byte
       in `AL'.

       If you need to define, or access, labels local to the context
       _below_ the top one on the stack, you can use `%$$foo', or `%$$$foo'
       for the context below that, and so on.

 4.7.3 Context-Local Single-Line Macros

       NASM also allows you to define single-line macros which are local to
       a particular context, in just the same way:

       %define %$localmac 3

       will define the single-line macro `%$localmac' to be local to the
       top context on the stack. Of course, after a subsequent `%push', it
       can then still be accessed by the name `%$$localmac'.

 4.7.4 `%repl': Renaming a Context

       If you need to change the name of the top context on the stack (in
       order, for example, to have it respond differently to `%ifctx'), you
       can execute a `%pop' followed by a `%push'; but this will have the
       side effect of destroying all context-local labels and macros
       associated with the context that was just popped.

       NASM provides the directive `%repl', which _replaces_ a context with
       a different name, without touching the associated macros and labels.
       So you could replace the destructive code

       %pop 
       %push   newname

       with the non-destructive version `%repl newname'.

 4.7.5 Example Use of the Context Stack: Block IFs

       This example makes use of almost all the context-stack features,
       including the conditional-assembly construct `%ifctx', to implement
       a block IF statement as a set of macros.

       %macro if 1 
       
           %push if 
           j%-1  %$ifnot 
       
       %endmacro 
       
       %macro else 0 
       
         %ifctx if 
               %repl   else 
               jmp     %$ifend 
               %$ifnot: 
         %else 
               %error  "expected `if' before `else'" 
         %endif 
       
       %endmacro 
       
       %macro endif 0 
       
         %ifctx if 
               %$ifnot: 
               %pop 
         %elifctx      else 
               %$ifend: 
               %pop 
         %else 
               %error  "expected `if' or `else' before `endif'" 
         %endif 
       
       %endmacro

       This code is more robust than the `REPEAT' and `UNTIL' macros given
       in section 4.7.2, because it uses conditional assembly to check that
       the macros are issued in the right order (for example, not calling
       `endif' before `if') and issues a `%error' if they're not.

       In addition, the `endif' macro has to be able to cope with the two
       distinct cases of either directly following an `if', or following an
       `else'. It achieves this, again, by using conditional assembly to do
       different things depending on whether the context on top of the
       stack is `if' or `else'.

       The `else' macro has to preserve the context on the stack, in order
       to have the `%$ifnot' referred to by the `if' macro be the same as
       the one defined by the `endif' macro, but has to change the
       context's name so that `endif' will know there was an intervening
       `else'. It does this by the use of `%repl'.

       A sample usage of these macros might look like:

               cmp     ax,bx 
       
               if ae 
                      cmp     bx,cx 
       
                      if ae 
                              mov     ax,cx 
                      else 
                              mov     ax,bx 
                      endif 
       
               else 
                      cmp     ax,cx 
       
                      if ae 
                              mov     ax,cx 
                      endif 
       
               endif

       The block-`IF' macros handle nesting quite happily, by means of
       pushing another context, describing the inner `if', on top of the
       one describing the outer `if'; thus `else' and `endif' always refer
       to the last unmatched `if' or `else'.

   4.8 Standard Macros

       NASM defines a set of standard macros, which are already defined
       when it starts to process any source file. If you really need a
       program to be assembled with no pre-defined macros, you can use the
       `%clear' directive to empty the preprocessor of everything but
       context-local preprocessor variables and single-line macros.

       Most user-level assembler directives (see chapter 5) are implemented
       as macros which invoke primitive directives; these are described in
       chapter 5. The rest of the standard macro set is described here.

 4.8.1 `__NASM_MAJOR__', `__NASM_MINOR__', `__NASM_SUBMINOR__' and `___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__': NASM Version

       The single-line macros `__NASM_MAJOR__', `__NASM_MINOR__',
       `__NASM_SUBMINOR__' and `___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__' expand to the major,
       minor, subminor and patch level parts of the version number of NASM
       being used. So, under NASM 0.98.32p1 for example, `__NASM_MAJOR__'
       would be defined to be 0, `__NASM_MINOR__' would be defined as 98,
       `__NASM_SUBMINOR__' would be defined to 32, and
       `___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__' would be defined as 1.

 4.8.2 `__NASM_VERSION_ID__': NASM Version ID

       The single-line macro `__NASM_VERSION_ID__' expands to a dword
       integer representing the full version number of the version of nasm
       being used. The value is the equivalent to `__NASM_MAJOR__',
       `__NASM_MINOR__', `__NASM_SUBMINOR__' and `___NASM_PATCHLEVEL__'
       concatenated to produce a single doubleword. Hence, for 0.98.32p1,
       the returned number would be equivalent to:

               dd      0x00622001

       or

               db      1,32,98,0

       Note that the above lines are generate exactly the same code, the
       second line is used just to give an indication of the order that the
       separate values will be present in memory.

 4.8.3 `__NASM_VER__': NASM Version string

       The single-line macro `__NASM_VER__' expands to a string which
       defines the version number of nasm being used. So, under NASM
       0.98.32 for example,

               db      __NASM_VER__

       would expand to

               db      "0.98.32"

 4.8.4 `__FILE__' and `__LINE__': File Name and Line Number

       Like the C preprocessor, NASM allows the user to find out the file
       name and line number containing the current instruction. The macro
       `__FILE__' expands to a string constant giving the name of the
       current input file (which may change through the course of assembly
       if `%include' directives are used), and `__LINE__' expands to a
       numeric constant giving the current line number in the input file.

       These macros could be used, for example, to communicate debugging
       information to a macro, since invoking `__LINE__' inside a macro
       definition (either single-line or multi-line) will return the line
       number of the macro _call_, rather than _definition_. So to
       determine where in a piece of code a crash is occurring, for
       example, one could write a routine `stillhere', which is passed a
       line number in `EAX' and outputs something like `line 155: still
       here'. You could then write a macro

       %macro  notdeadyet 0 
       
               push    eax 
               mov     eax,__LINE__ 
               call    stillhere 
               pop     eax 
       
       %endmacro

       and then pepper your code with calls to `notdeadyet' until you find
       the crash point.

 4.8.5 `STRUC' and `ENDSTRUC': Declaring Structure Data Types

       The core of NASM contains no intrinsic means of defining data
       structures; instead, the preprocessor is sufficiently powerful that
       data structures can be implemented as a set of macros. The macros
       `STRUC' and `ENDSTRUC' are used to define a structure data type.

       `STRUC' takes one parameter, which is the name of the data type.
       This name is defined as a symbol with the value zero, and also has
       the suffix `_size' appended to it and is then defined as an `EQU'
       giving the size of the structure. Once `STRUC' has been issued, you
       are defining the structure, and should define fields using the
       `RESB' family of pseudo-instructions, and then invoke `ENDSTRUC' to
       finish the definition.

       For example, to define a structure called `mytype' containing a
       longword, a word, a byte and a string of bytes, you might code

       struc   mytype 
       
         mt_long:      resd    1 
         mt_word:      resw    1 
         mt_byte:      resb    1 
         mt_str:       resb    32 
       
       endstruc

       The above code defines six symbols: `mt_long' as 0 (the offset from
       the beginning of a `mytype' structure to the longword field),
       `mt_word' as 4, `mt_byte' as 6, `mt_str' as 7, `mytype_size' as 39,
       and `mytype' itself as zero.

       The reason why the structure type name is defined at zero is a side
       effect of allowing structures to work with the local label
       mechanism: if your structure members tend to have the same names in
       more than one structure, you can define the above structure like
       this:

       struc mytype 
       
         .long:        resd    1 
         .word:        resw    1 
         .byte:        resb    1 
         .str:         resb    32 
       
       endstruc

       This defines the offsets to the structure fields as `mytype.long',
       `mytype.word', `mytype.byte' and `mytype.str'.

       NASM, since it has no _intrinsic_ structure support, does not
       support any form of period notation to refer to the elements of a
       structure once you have one (except the above local-label notation),
       so code such as `mov ax,[mystruc.mt_word]' is not valid. `mt_word'
       is a constant just like any other constant, so the correct syntax is
       `mov ax,[mystruc+mt_word]' or `mov ax,[mystruc+mytype.word]'.

 4.8.6 `ISTRUC', `AT' and `IEND': Declaring Instances of Structures

       Having defined a structure type, the next thing you typically want
       to do is to declare instances of that structure in your data
       segment. NASM provides an easy way to do this in the `ISTRUC'
       mechanism. To declare a structure of type `mytype' in a program, you
       code something like this:

       mystruc: 
           istruc mytype 
       
               at mt_long, dd      123456 
               at mt_word, dw      1024 
               at mt_byte, db      'x' 
               at mt_str,  db      'hello, world', 13, 10, 0 
       
           iend

       The function of the `AT' macro is to make use of the `TIMES' prefix
       to advance the assembly position to the correct point for the
       specified structure field, and then to declare the specified data.
       Therefore the structure fields must be declared in the same order as
       they were specified in the structure definition.

       If the data to go in a structure field requires more than one source
       line to specify, the remaining source lines can easily come after
       the `AT' line. For example:

               at mt_str,  db      123,134,145,156,167,178,189 
                           db      190,100,0

       Depending on personal taste, you can also omit the code part of the
       `AT' line completely, and start the structure field on the next
       line:

               at mt_str 
                       db      'hello, world' 
                       db      13,10,0

 4.8.7 `ALIGN' and `ALIGNB': Data Alignment

       The `ALIGN' and `ALIGNB' macros provides a convenient way to align
       code or data on a word, longword, paragraph or other boundary. (Some
       assemblers call this directive `EVEN'.) The syntax of the `ALIGN'
       and `ALIGNB' macros is

               align   4               ; align on 4-byte boundary 
               align   16              ; align on 16-byte boundary 
               align   8,db 0          ; pad with 0s rather than NOPs 
               align   4,resb 1        ; align to 4 in the BSS 
               alignb  4               ; equivalent to previous line

       Both macros require their first argument to be a power of two; they
       both compute the number of additional bytes required to bring the
       length of the current section up to a multiple of that power of two,
       and then apply the `TIMES' prefix to their second argument to
       perform the alignment.

       If the second argument is not specified, the default for `ALIGN' is
       `NOP', and the default for `ALIGNB' is `RESB 1'. So if the second
       argument is specified, the two macros are equivalent. Normally, you
       can just use `ALIGN' in code and data sections and `ALIGNB' in BSS
       sections, and never need the second argument except for special
       purposes.

       `ALIGN' and `ALIGNB', being simple macros, perform no error
       checking: they cannot warn you if their first argument fails to be a
       power of two, or if their second argument generates more than one
       byte of code. In each of these cases they will silently do the wrong
       thing.

       `ALIGNB' (or `ALIGN' with a second argument of `RESB 1') can be used
       within structure definitions:

       struc mytype2 
       
         mt_byte: 
               resb 1 
               alignb 2 
         mt_word: 
               resw 1 
               alignb 4 
         mt_long: 
               resd 1 
         mt_str: 
               resb 32 
       
       endstruc

       This will ensure that the structure members are sensibly aligned
       relative to the base of the structure.

       A final caveat: `ALIGN' and `ALIGNB' work relative to the beginning
       of the _section_, not the beginning of the address space in the
       final executable. Aligning to a 16-byte boundary when the section
       you're in is only guaranteed to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary, for
       example, is a waste of effort. Again, NASM does not check that the
       section's alignment characteristics are sensible for the use of
       `ALIGN' or `ALIGNB'.

   4.9 TASM Compatible Preprocessor Directives

       The following preprocessor directives may only be used when TASM
       compatibility is turned on using the `-t' command line switch (This
       switch is described in section 2.1.17.)

       (*) `%arg' (see section 4.9.1)

       (*) `%stacksize' (see section 4.9.2)

       (*) `%local' (see section 4.9.3)

 4.9.1 `%arg' Directive

       The `%arg' directive is used to simplify the handling of parameters
       passed on the stack. Stack based parameter passing is used by many
       high level languages, including C, C++ and Pascal.

       While NASM comes with macros which attempt to duplicate this
       functionality (see section 7.4.5), the syntax is not particularly
       convenient to use and is not TASM compatible. Here is an example
       which shows the use of `%arg' without any external macros:

       some_function: 
       
           %push     mycontext        ; save the current context 
           %stacksize large           ; tell NASM to use bp 
           %arg      i:word, j_ptr:word 
       
               mov     ax,[i] 
               mov     bx,[j_ptr] 
               add     ax,[bx] 
               ret 
       
           %pop                       ; restore original context

       This is similar to the procedure defined in section 7.4.5 and adds
       the value in i to the value pointed to by j_ptr and returns the sum
       in the ax register. See section 4.7.1 for an explanation of `push'
       and `pop' and the use of context stacks.

 4.9.2 `%stacksize' Directive

       The `%stacksize' directive is used in conjunction with the `%arg'
       (see section 4.9.1) and the `%local' (see section 4.9.3) directives.
       It tells NASM the default size to use for subsequent `%arg' and
       `%local' directives. The `%stacksize' directive takes one required
       argument which is one of `flat', `large' or `small'.

       %stacksize flat

       This form causes NASM to use stack-based parameter addressing
       relative to `ebp' and it assumes that a near form of call was used
       to get to this label (i.e. that `eip' is on the stack).

       %stacksize large

       This form uses `bp' to do stack-based parameter addressing and
       assumes that a far form of call was used to get to this address
       (i.e. that `ip' and `cs' are on the stack).

       %stacksize small

       This form also uses `bp' to address stack parameters, but it is
       different from `large' because it also assumes that the old value of
       bp is pushed onto the stack (i.e. it expects an `ENTER'
       instruction). In other words, it expects that `bp', `ip' and `cs'
       are on the top of the stack, underneath any local space which may
       have been allocated by `ENTER'. This form is probably most useful
       when used in combination with the `%local' directive (see section
       4.9.3).

 4.9.3 `%local' Directive

       The `%local' directive is used to simplify the use of local
       temporary stack variables allocated in a stack frame. Automatic
       local variables in C are an example of this kind of variable. The
       `%local' directive is most useful when used with the `%stacksize'
       (see section 4.9.2 and is also compatible with the `%arg' directive
       (see section 4.9.1). It allows simplified reference to variables on
       the stack which have been allocated typically by using the `ENTER'
       instruction (see section B.4.65 for a description of that
       instruction). An example of its use is the following:

       silly_swap: 
       
           %push mycontext             ; save the current context 
           %stacksize small            ; tell NASM to use bp 
           %assign %$localsize 0       ; see text for explanation 
           %local old_ax:word, old_dx:word 
       
               enter   %$localsize,0   ; see text for explanation 
               mov     [old_ax],ax     ; swap ax & bx 
               mov     [old_dx],dx     ; and swap dx & cx 
               mov     ax,bx 
               mov     dx,cx 
               mov     bx,[old_ax] 
               mov     cx,[old_dx] 
               leave                   ; restore old bp 
               ret                     ; 
       
           %pop                        ; restore original context

       The `%$localsize' variable is used internally by the `%local'
       directive and _must_ be defined within the current context before
       the `%local' directive may be used. Failure to do so will result in
       one expression syntax error for each `%local' variable declared. It
       then may be used in the construction of an appropriately sized ENTER
       instruction as shown in the example.

  4.10 Other Preprocessor Directives

       NASM also has preprocessor directives which allow access to
       information from external sources. Currently they include:

       The following preprocessor directive is supported to allow NASM to
       correctly handle output of the cpp C language preprocessor.

       (*) `%line' enables NAsM to correctly handle the output of the cpp C
           language preprocessor (see section 4.10.1).

       (*) `%!' enables NASM to read in the value of an environment
           variable, which can then be used in your program (see section
           4.10.2).

4.10.1 `%line' Directive

       The `%line' directive is used to notify NASM that the input line
       corresponds to a specific line number in another file. Typically
       this other file would be an original source file, with the current
       NASM input being the output of a pre-processor. The `%line'
       directive allows NASM to output messages which indicate the line
       number of the original source file, instead of the file that is
       being read by NASM.

       This preprocessor directive is not generally of use to programmers,
       by may be of interest to preprocessor authors. The usage of the
       `%line' preprocessor directive is as follows:

       %line nnn[+mmm] [filename]

       In this directive, `nnn' indentifies the line of the original source
       file which this line corresponds to. `mmm' is an optional parameter
       which specifies a line increment value; each line of the input file
       read in is considered to correspond to `mmm' lines of the original
       source file. Finally, `filename' is an optional parameter which
       specifies the file name of the original source file.

       After reading a `%line' preprocessor directive, NASM will report all
       file name and line numbers relative to the values specified therein.

4.10.2 `%!'`<env>': Read an environment variable.

       The `%!<env>' directive makes it possible to read the value of an
       environment variable at assembly time. This could, for example, be
       used to store the contents of an environment variable into a string,
       which could be used at some other point in your code.

       For example, suppose that you have an environment variable `FOO',
       and you want the contents of `FOO' to be embedded in your program.
       You could do that as follows:

       %define FOO    %!FOO 
       %define quote   ' 
       
       tmpstr  db      quote FOO quote

       At the time of writing, this will generate an "unterminated string"
       warning at the time of defining "quote", and it will add a space
       before and after the string that is read in. I was unable to find a
       simple workaround (although a workaround can be created using a
       multi-line macro), so I believe that you will need to either learn
       how to create more complex macros, or allow for the extra spaces if
       you make use of this feature in that way.

Chapter 5: Assembler Directives
-------------------------------

       NASM, though it attempts to avoid the bureaucracy of assemblers like
       MASM and TASM, is nevertheless forced to support a _few_ directives.
       These are described in this chapter.

       NASM's directives come in two types: _user-level_ directives and
       _primitive_ directives. Typically, each directive has a user-level
       form and a primitive form. In almost all cases, we recommend that
       users use the user-level forms of the directives, which are
       implemented as macros which call the primitive forms.

       Primitive directives are enclosed in square brackets; user-level
       directives are not.

       In addition to the universal directives described in this chapter,
       each object file format can optionally supply extra directives in
       order to control particular features of that file format. These
       _format-specific_ directives are documented along with the formats
       that implement them, in chapter 6.

   5.1 `BITS': Specifying Target Processor Mode

       The `BITS' directive specifies whether NASM should generate code
       designed to run on a processor operating in 16-bit mode, or code
       designed to run on a processor operating in 32-bit mode. The syntax
       is `BITS 16' or `BITS 32'.

       In most cases, you should not need to use `BITS' explicitly. The
       `aout', `coff', `elf' and `win32' object formats, which are designed
       for use in 32-bit operating systems, all cause NASM to select 32-bit
       mode by default. The `obj' object format allows you to specify each
       segment you define as either `USE16' or `USE32', and NASM will set
       its operating mode accordingly, so the use of the `BITS' directive
       is once again unnecessary.

       The most likely reason for using the `BITS' directive is to write
       32-bit code in a flat binary file; this is because the `bin' output
       format defaults to 16-bit mode in anticipation of it being used most
       frequently to write DOS `.COM' programs, DOS `.SYS' device drivers
       and boot loader software.

       You do _not_ need to specify `BITS 32' merely in order to use 32-bit
       instructions in a 16-bit DOS program; if you do, the assembler will
       generate incorrect code because it will be writing code targeted at
       a 32-bit platform, to be run on a 16-bit one.

       When NASM is in `BITS 16' state, instructions which use 32-bit data
       are prefixed with an 0x66 byte, and those referring to 32-bit
       addresses have an 0x67 prefix. In `BITS 32' state, the reverse is
       true: 32-bit instructions require no prefixes, whereas instructions
       using 16-bit data need an 0x66 and those working on 16-bit addresses
       need an 0x67.

       The `BITS' directive has an exactly equivalent primitive form,
       `[BITS 16]' and `[BITS 32]'. The user-level form is a macro which
       has no function other than to call the primitive form.

       Note that the space is neccessary, `BITS32' will _not_ work!

 5.1.1 `USE16' & `USE32': Aliases for BITS

       The ``USE16'' and ``USE32'' directives can be used in place of
       ``BITS 16'' and ``BITS 32'', for compatibility with other
       assemblers.

   5.2 `SECTION' or `SEGMENT': Changing and Defining Sections

       The `SECTION' directive (`SEGMENT' is an exactly equivalent synonym)
       changes which section of the output file the code you write will be
       assembled into. In some object file formats, the number and names of
       sections are fixed; in others, the user may make up as many as they
       wish. Hence `SECTION' may sometimes give an error message, or may
       define a new section, if you try to switch to a section that does
       not (yet) exist.

       The Unix object formats, and the `bin' object format (but see
       section 6.1.3, all support the standardised section names `.text',
       `.data' and `.bss' for the code, data and uninitialised-data
       sections. The `obj' format, by contrast, does not recognise these
       section names as being special, and indeed will strip off the
       leading period of any section name that has one.

 5.2.1 The `__SECT__' Macro

       The `SECTION' directive is unusual in that its user-level form
       functions differently from its primitive form. The primitive form,
       `[SECTION xyz]', simply switches the current target section to the
       one given. The user-level form, `SECTION xyz', however, first
       defines the single-line macro `__SECT__' to be the primitive
       `[SECTION]' directive which it is about to issue, and then issues
       it. So the user-level directive

               SECTION .text

       expands to the two lines

       %define __SECT__        [SECTION .text] 
               [SECTION .text]

       Users may find it useful to make use of this in their own macros.
       For example, the `writefile' macro defined in section 4.3.3 can be
       usefully rewritten in the following more sophisticated form:

       %macro  writefile 2+ 
       
               [section .data] 
       
         %%str:        db      %2 
         %%endstr: 
       
               __SECT__ 
       
               mov     dx,%%str 
               mov     cx,%%endstr-%%str 
               mov     bx,%1 
               mov     ah,0x40 
               int     0x21 
       
       %endmacro

       This form of the macro, once passed a string to output, first
       switches temporarily to the data section of the file, using the
       primitive form of the `SECTION' directive so as not to modify
       `__SECT__'. It then declares its string in the data section, and
       then invokes `__SECT__' to switch back to _whichever_ section the
       user was previously working in. It thus avoids the need, in the
       previous version of the macro, to include a `JMP' instruction to
       jump over the data, and also does not fail if, in a complicated
       `OBJ' format module, the user could potentially be assembling the
       code in any of several separate code sections.

   5.3 `ABSOLUTE': Defining Absolute Labels

       The `ABSOLUTE' directive can be thought of as an alternative form of
       `SECTION': it causes the subsequent code to be directed at no
       physical section, but at the hypothetical section starting at the
       given absolute address. The only instructions you can use in this
       mode are the `RESB' family.

       `ABSOLUTE' is used as follows:

       absolute 0x1A 
       
           kbuf_chr    resw    1 
           kbuf_free   resw    1 
           kbuf        resw    16

       This example describes a section of the PC BIOS data area, at
       segment address 0x40: the above code defines `kbuf_chr' to be 0x1A,
       `kbuf_free' to be 0x1C, and `kbuf' to be 0x1E.

       The user-level form of `ABSOLUTE', like that of `SECTION', redefines
       the `__SECT__' macro when it is invoked.

       `STRUC' and `ENDSTRUC' are defined as macros which use `ABSOLUTE'
       (and also `__SECT__').

       `ABSOLUTE' doesn't have to take an absolute constant as an argument:
       it can take an expression (actually, a critical expression: see
       section 3.8) and it can be a value in a segment. For example, a TSR
       can re-use its setup code as run-time BSS like this:

               org     100h               ; it's a .COM program 
       
               jmp     setup              ; setup code comes last 
       
               ; the resident part of the TSR goes here 
       setup: 
               ; now write the code that installs the TSR here 
       
       absolute setup 
       
       runtimevar1     resw    1 
       runtimevar2     resd    20 
       
       tsr_end:

       This defines some variables `on top of' the setup code, so that
       after the setup has finished running, the space it took up can be
       re-used as data storage for the running TSR. The symbol `tsr_end'
       can be used to calculate the total size of the part of the TSR that
       needs to be made resident.

   5.4 `EXTERN': Importing Symbols from Other Modules

       `EXTERN' is similar to the MASM directive `EXTRN' and the C keyword
       `extern': it is used to declare a symbol which is not defined
       anywhere in the module being assembled, but is assumed to be defined
       in some other module and needs to be referred to by this one. Not
       every object-file format can support external variables: the `bin'
       format cannot.

       The `EXTERN' directive takes as many arguments as you like. Each
       argument is the name of a symbol:

       extern  _printf 
       extern  _sscanf,_fscanf

       Some object-file formats provide extra features to the `EXTERN'
       directive. In all cases, the extra features are used by suffixing a
       colon to the symbol name followed by object-format specific text.
       For example, the `obj' format allows you to declare that the default
       segment base of an external should be the group `dgroup' by means of
       the directive

       extern  _variable:wrt dgroup

       The primitive form of `EXTERN' differs from the user-level form only
       in that it can take only one argument at a time: the support for
       multiple arguments is implemented at the preprocessor level.

       You can declare the same variable as `EXTERN' more than once: NASM
       will quietly ignore the second and later redeclarations. You can't
       declare a variable as `EXTERN' as well as something else, though.

   5.5 `GLOBAL': Exporting Symbols to Other Modules

       `GLOBAL' is the other end of `EXTERN': if one module declares a
       symbol as `EXTERN' and refers to it, then in order to prevent linker
       errors, some other module must actually _define_ the symbol and
       declare it as `GLOBAL'. Some assemblers use the name `PUBLIC' for
       this purpose.

       The `GLOBAL' directive applying to a symbol must appear _before_ the
       definition of the symbol.

       `GLOBAL' uses the same syntax as `EXTERN', except that it must refer
       to symbols which _are_ defined in the same module as the `GLOBAL'
       directive. For example:

       global _main 
       _main: 
               ; some code

       `GLOBAL', like `EXTERN', allows object formats to define private
       extensions by means of a colon. The `elf' object format, for
       example, lets you specify whether global data items are functions or
       data:

       global  hashlookup:function, hashtable:data

       Like `EXTERN', the primitive form of `GLOBAL' differs from the user-
       level form only in that it can take only one argument at a time.

   5.6 `COMMON': Defining Common Data Areas

       The `COMMON' directive is used to declare _common variables_. A
       common variable is much like a global variable declared in the
       uninitialised data section, so that

       common  intvar  4

       is similar in function to

       global  intvar 
       section .bss 
       
       intvar  resd    1

       The difference is that if more than one module defines the same
       common variable, then at link time those variables will be _merged_,
       and references to `intvar' in all modules will point at the same
       piece of memory.

       Like `GLOBAL' and `EXTERN', `COMMON' supports object-format specific
       extensions. For example, the `obj' format allows common variables to
       be NEAR or FAR, and the `elf' format allows you to specify the
       alignment requirements of a common variable:

       common  commvar  4:near  ; works in OBJ 
       common  intarray 100:4   ; works in ELF: 4 byte aligned

       Once again, like `EXTERN' and `GLOBAL', the primitive form of
       `COMMON' differs from the user-level form only in that it can take
       only one argument at a time.

   5.7 `CPU': Defining CPU Dependencies

       The `CPU' directive restricts assembly to those instructions which
       are available on the specified CPU.

       Options are:

       (*) `CPU 8086' Assemble only 8086 instruction set

       (*) `CPU 186' Assemble instructions up to the 80186 instruction set

       (*) `CPU 286' Assemble instructions up to the 286 instruction set

       (*) `CPU 386' Assemble instructions up to the 386 instruction set

       (*) `CPU 486' 486 instruction set

       (*) `CPU 586' Pentium instruction set

       (*) `CPU PENTIUM' Same as 586

       (*) `CPU 686' P6 instruction set

       (*) `CPU PPRO' Same as 686

       (*) `CPU P2' Same as 686

       (*) `CPU P3' Pentium III (Katmai) instruction sets

       (*) `CPU KATMAI' Same as P3

       (*) `CPU P4' Pentium 4 (Willamette) instruction set

       (*) `CPU WILLAMETTE' Same as P4

       (*) `CPU PRESCOTT' Prescott instruction set

       (*) `CPU IA64' IA64 CPU (in x86 mode) instruction set

       All options are case insensitive. All instructions will be selected
       only if they apply to the selected CPU or lower. By default, all
       instructions are available.

Chapter 6: Output Formats
-------------------------

       NASM is a portable assembler, designed to be able to compile on any
       ANSI C-supporting platform and produce output to run on a variety of
       Intel x86 operating systems. For this reason, it has a large number
       of available output formats, selected using the `-f' option on the
       NASM command line. Each of these formats, along with its extensions
       to the base NASM syntax, is detailed in this chapter.

       As stated in section 2.1.1, NASM chooses a default name for your
       output file based on the input file name and the chosen output
       format. This will be generated by removing the extension (`.asm',
       `.s', or whatever you like to use) from the input file name, and
       substituting an extension defined by the output format. The
       extensions are given with each format below.

   6.1 `bin': Flat-Form Binary Output

       The `bin' format does not produce object files: it generates nothing
       in the output file except the code you wrote. Such `pure binary'
       files are used by MS-DOS: `.COM' executables and `.SYS' device
       drivers are pure binary files. Pure binary output is also useful for
       operating system and boot loader development.

       The `bin' format supports multiple section names. For details of how
       nasm handles sections in the `bin' format, see section 6.1.3.

       Using the `bin' format puts NASM by default into 16-bit mode (see
       section 5.1). In order to use `bin' to write 32-bit code such as an
       OS kernel, you need to explicitly issue the `BITS 32' directive.

       `bin' has no default output file name extension: instead, it leaves
       your file name as it is once the original extension has been
       removed. Thus, the default is for NASM to assemble `binprog.asm'
       into a binary file called `binprog'.

 6.1.1 `ORG': Binary File Program Origin

       The `bin' format provides an additional directive to the list given
       in chapter 5: `ORG'. The function of the `ORG' directive is to
       specify the origin address which NASM will assume the program begins
       at when it is loaded into memory.

       For example, the following code will generate the longword
       `0x00000104':

               org     0x100 
               dd      label 
       label:

       Unlike the `ORG' directive provided by MASM-compatible assemblers,
       which allows you to jump around in the object file and overwrite
       code you have already generated, NASM's `ORG' does exactly what the
       directive says: _origin_. Its sole function is to specify one offset
       which is added to all internal address references within the
       section; it does not permit any of the trickery that MASM's version
       does. See section 10.1.3 for further comments.

 6.1.2 `bin' Extensions to the `SECTION' Directive

       The `bin' output format extends the `SECTION' (or `SEGMENT')
       directive to allow you to specify the alignment requirements of
       segments. This is done by appending the `ALIGN' qualifier to the end
       of the section-definition line. For example,

       section .data   align=16

       switches to the section `.data' and also specifies that it must be
       aligned on a 16-byte boundary.

       The parameter to `ALIGN' specifies how many low bits of the section
       start address must be forced to zero. The alignment value given may
       be any power of two.

 6.1.3 `Multisection' support for the BIN format.

       The `bin' format allows the use of multiple sections, of arbitrary
       names, besides the "known" `.text', `.data', and `.bss' names.

       (*) Sections may be designated `progbits' or `nobits'. Default is
           `progbits' (except `.bss', which defaults to `nobits', of
           course).

       (*) Sections can be aligned at a specified boundary following the
           previous section with `align=', or at an arbitrary byte-granular
           position with `start='.

       (*) Sections can be given a virtual start address, which will be
           used for the calculation of all memory references within that
           section with `vstart='.

       (*) Sections can be ordered using `follows='`<section>' or
           `vfollows='`<section>' as an alternative to specifying an
           explicit start address.

       (*) Arguments to `org', `start', `vstart', and `align=' are critical
           expressions. See section 3.8. E.g. `align=(1 << ALIGN_SHIFT)' -
           `ALIGN_SHIFT' must be defined before it is used here.

       (*) Any code which comes before an explicit `SECTION' directive is
           directed by default into the `.text' section.

       (*) If an `ORG' statement is not given, `ORG 0' is used by default.

       (*) The `.bss' section will be placed after the last `progbits'
           section, unless `start=', `vstart=', `follows=', or `vfollows='
           has been specified.

       (*) All sections are aligned on dword boundaries, unless a different
           alignment has been specified.

       (*) Sections may not overlap.

       (*) Nasm creates the `section.<secname>.start' for each section,
           which may be used in your code.

 6.1.4 Map files

       Map files can be generated in `-f bin' format by means of the
       `[map]' option. Map types of `all' (default), `brief', `sections',
       `segments', or `symbols' may be specified. Output may be directed to
       `stdout' (default), `stderr', or a specified file. E.g.
       `[map symbols myfile.map]'. No "user form" exists, the square
       brackets must be used.

   6.2 `obj': Microsoft OMF Object Files

       The `obj' file format (NASM calls it `obj' rather than `omf' for
       historical reasons) is the one produced by MASM and TASM, which is
       typically fed to 16-bit DOS linkers to produce `.EXE' files. It is
       also the format used by OS/2.

       `obj' provides a default output file-name extension of `.obj'.

       `obj' is not exclusively a 16-bit format, though: NASM has full
       support for the 32-bit extensions to the format. In particular, 32-
       bit `obj' format files are used by Borland's Win32 compilers,
       instead of using Microsoft's newer `win32' object file format.

       The `obj' format does not define any special segment names: you can
       call your segments anything you like. Typical names for segments in
       `obj' format files are `CODE', `DATA' and `BSS'.

       If your source file contains code before specifying an explicit
       `SEGMENT' directive, then NASM will invent its own segment called
       `__NASMDEFSEG' for you.

       When you define a segment in an `obj' file, NASM defines the segment
       name as a symbol as well, so that you can access the segment address
       of the segment. So, for example:

       segment data 
       
       dvar:   dw      1234 
       
       segment code 
       
       function: 
               mov     ax,data         ; get segment address of data 
               mov     ds,ax           ; and move it into DS 
               inc     word [dvar]     ; now this reference will work 
               ret

       The `obj' format also enables the use of the `SEG' and `WRT'
       operators, so that you can write code which does things like

       extern  foo 
       
             mov   ax,seg foo            ; get preferred segment of foo 
             mov   ds,ax 
             mov   ax,data               ; a different segment 
             mov   es,ax 
             mov   ax,[ds:foo]           ; this accesses `foo' 
             mov   [es:foo wrt data],bx  ; so does this

 6.2.1 `obj' Extensions to the `SEGMENT' Directive

       The `obj' output format extends the `SEGMENT' (or `SECTION')
       directive to allow you to specify various properties of the segment
       you are defining. This is done by appending extra qualifiers to the
       end of the segment-definition line. For example,

       segment code private align=16

       defines the segment `code', but also declares it to be a private
       segment, and requires that the portion of it described in this code
       module must be aligned on a 16-byte boundary.

       The available qualifiers are:

       (*) `PRIVATE', `PUBLIC', `COMMON' and `STACK' specify the
           combination characteristics of the segment. `PRIVATE' segments
           do not get combined with any others by the linker; `PUBLIC' and
           `STACK' segments get concatenated together at link time; and
           `COMMON' segments all get overlaid on top of each other rather
           than stuck end-to-end.

       (*) `ALIGN' is used, as shown above, to specify how many low bits of
           the segment start address must be forced to zero. The alignment
           value given may be any power of two from 1 to 4096; in reality,
           the only values supported are 1, 2, 4, 16, 256 and 4096, so if 8
           is specified it will be rounded up to 16, and 32, 64 and 128
           will all be rounded up to 256, and so on. Note that alignment to
           4096-byte boundaries is a PharLap extension to the format and
           may not be supported by all linkers.

       (*) `CLASS' can be used to specify the segment class; this feature
           indicates to the linker that segments of the same class should
           be placed near each other in the output file. The class name can
           be any word, e.g. `CLASS=CODE'.

       (*) `OVERLAY', like `CLASS', is specified with an arbitrary word as
           an argument, and provides overlay information to an overlay-
           capable linker.

       (*) Segments can be declared as `USE16' or `USE32', which has the
           effect of recording the choice in the object file and also
           ensuring that NASM's default assembly mode when assembling in
           that segment is 16-bit or 32-bit respectively.

       (*) When writing OS/2 object files, you should declare 32-bit
           segments as `FLAT', which causes the default segment base for
           anything in the segment to be the special group `FLAT', and also
           defines the group if it is not already defined.

       (*) The `obj' file format also allows segments to be declared as
           having a pre-defined absolute segment address, although no
           linkers are currently known to make sensible use of this
           feature; nevertheless, NASM allows you to declare a segment such
           as `SEGMENT SCREEN ABSOLUTE=0xB800' if you need to. The
           `ABSOLUTE' and `ALIGN' keywords are mutually exclusive.

       NASM's default segment attributes are `PUBLIC', `ALIGN=1', no class,
       no overlay, and `USE16'.

 6.2.2 `GROUP': Defining Groups of Segments

       The `obj' format also allows segments to be grouped, so that a
       single segment register can be used to refer to all the segments in
       a group. NASM therefore supplies the `GROUP' directive, whereby you
       can code

       segment data 
       
               ; some data 
       
       segment bss 
       
               ; some uninitialised data 
       
       group dgroup data bss

       which will define a group called `dgroup' to contain the segments
       `data' and `bss'. Like `SEGMENT', `GROUP' causes the group name to
       be defined as a symbol, so that you can refer to a variable `var' in
       the `data' segment as `var wrt data' or as `var wrt dgroup',
       depending on which segment value is currently in your segment
       register.

       If you just refer to `var', however, and `var' is declared in a
       segment which is part of a group, then NASM will default to giving
       you the offset of `var' from the beginning of the _group_, not the
       _segment_. Therefore `SEG var', also, will return the group base
       rather than the segment base.

       NASM will allow a segment to be part of more than one group, but
       will generate a warning if you do this. Variables declared in a
       segment which is part of more than one group will default to being
       relative to the first group that was defined to contain the segment.

       A group does not have to contain any segments; you can still make
       `WRT' references to a group which does not contain the variable you
       are referring to. OS/2, for example, defines the special group
       `FLAT' with no segments in it.

 6.2.3 `UPPERCASE': Disabling Case Sensitivity in Output

       Although NASM itself is case sensitive, some OMF linkers are not;
       therefore it can be useful for NASM to output single-case object
       files. The `UPPERCASE' format-specific directive causes all segment,
       group and symbol names that are written to the object file to be
       forced to upper case just before being written. Within a source
       file, NASM is still case-sensitive; but the object file can be
       written entirely in upper case if desired.

       `UPPERCASE' is used alone on a line; it requires no parameters.

 6.2.4 `IMPORT': Importing DLL Symbols

       The `IMPORT' format-specific directive defines a symbol to be
       imported from a DLL, for use if you are writing a DLL's import
       library in NASM. You still need to declare the symbol as `EXTERN' as
       well as using the `IMPORT' directive.

       The `IMPORT' directive takes two required parameters, separated by
       white space, which are (respectively) the name of the symbol you
       wish to import and the name of the library you wish to import it
       from. For example:

           import  WSAStartup wsock32.dll

       A third optional parameter gives the name by which the symbol is
       known in the library you are importing it from, in case this is not
       the same as the name you wish the symbol to be known by to your code
       once you have imported it. For example:

           import  asyncsel wsock32.dll WSAAsyncSelect

 6.2.5 `EXPORT': Exporting DLL Symbols

       The `EXPORT' format-specific directive defines a global symbol to be
       exported as a DLL symbol, for use if you are writing a DLL in NASM.
       You still need to declare the symbol as `GLOBAL' as well as using
       the `EXPORT' directive.

       `EXPORT' takes one required parameter, which is the name of the
       symbol you wish to export, as it was defined in your source file. An
       optional second parameter (separated by white space from the first)
       gives the _external_ name of the symbol: the name by which you wish
       the symbol to be known to programs using the DLL. If this name is
       the same as the internal name, you may leave the second parameter
       off.

       Further parameters can be given to define attributes of the exported
       symbol. These parameters, like the second, are separated by white
       space. If further parameters are given, the external name must also
       be specified, even if it is the same as the internal name. The
       available attributes are:

       (*) `resident' indicates that the exported name is to be kept
           resident by the system loader. This is an optimisation for
           frequently used symbols imported by name.

       (*) `nodata' indicates that the exported symbol is a function which
           does not make use of any initialised data.

       (*) `parm=NNN', where `NNN' is an integer, sets the number of
           parameter words for the case in which the symbol is a call gate
           between 32-bit and 16-bit segments.

       (*) An attribute which is just a number indicates that the symbol
           should be exported with an identifying number (ordinal), and
           gives the desired number.

       For example:

           export  myfunc 
           export  myfunc TheRealMoreFormalLookingFunctionName 
           export  myfunc myfunc 1234  ; export by ordinal 
           export  myfunc myfunc resident parm=23 nodata

 6.2.6 `..start': Defining the Program Entry Point

       `OMF' linkers require exactly one of the object files being linked
       to define the program entry point, where execution will begin when
       the program is run. If the object file that defines the entry point
       is assembled using NASM, you specify the entry point by declaring
       the special symbol `..start' at the point where you wish execution
       to begin.

 6.2.7 `obj' Extensions to the `EXTERN' Directive

       If you declare an external symbol with the directive

           extern  foo

       then references such as `mov ax,foo' will give you the offset of
       `foo' from its preferred segment base (as specified in whichever
       module `foo' is actually defined in). So to access the contents of
       `foo' you will usually need to do something like

               mov     ax,seg foo      ; get preferred segment base 
               mov     es,ax           ; move it into ES 
               mov     ax,[es:foo]     ; and use offset `foo' from it

       This is a little unwieldy, particularly if you know that an external
       is going to be accessible from a given segment or group, say
       `dgroup'. So if `DS' already contained `dgroup', you could simply
       code

               mov     ax,[foo wrt dgroup]

       However, having to type this every time you want to access `foo' can
       be a pain; so NASM allows you to declare `foo' in the alternative
       form

           extern  foo:wrt dgroup

       This form causes NASM to pretend that the preferred segment base of
       `foo' is in fact `dgroup'; so the expression `seg foo' will now
       return `dgroup', and the expression `foo' is equivalent to
       `foo wrt dgroup'.

       This default-`WRT' mechanism can be used to make externals appear to
       be relative to any group or segment in your program. It can also be
       applied to common variables: see section 6.2.8.

 6.2.8 `obj' Extensions to the `COMMON' Directive

       The `obj' format allows common variables to be either near or far;
       NASM allows you to specify which your variables should be by the use
       of the syntax

       common  nearvar 2:near   ; `nearvar' is a near common 
       common  farvar  10:far   ; and `farvar' is far

       Far common variables may be greater in size than 64Kb, and so the
       OMF specification says that they are declared as a number of
       _elements_ of a given size. So a 10-byte far common variable could
       be declared as ten one-byte elements, five two-byte elements, two
       five-byte elements or one ten-byte element.

       Some `OMF' linkers require the element size, as well as the variable
       size, to match when resolving common variables declared in more than
       one module. Therefore NASM must allow you to specify the element
       size on your far common variables. This is done by the following
       syntax:

       common  c_5by2  10:far 5        ; two five-byte elements 
       common  c_2by5  10:far 2        ; five two-byte elements

       If no element size is specified, the default is 1. Also, the `FAR'
       keyword is not required when an element size is specified, since
       only far commons may have element sizes at all. So the above
       declarations could equivalently be

       common  c_5by2  10:5            ; two five-byte elements 
       common  c_2by5  10:2            ; five two-byte elements

       In addition to these extensions, the `COMMON' directive in `obj'
       also supports default-`WRT' specification like `EXTERN' does
       (explained in section 6.2.7). So you can also declare things like

       common  foo     10:wrt dgroup 
       common  bar     16:far 2:wrt data 
       common  baz     24:wrt data:6

   6.3 `win32': Microsoft Win32 Object Files

       The `win32' output format generates Microsoft Win32 object files,
       suitable for passing to Microsoft linkers such as Visual C++. Note
       that Borland Win32 compilers do not use this format, but use `obj'
       instead (see section 6.2).

       `win32' provides a default output file-name extension of `.obj'.

       Note that although Microsoft say that Win32 object files follow the
       `COFF' (Common Object File Format) standard, the object files
       produced by Microsoft Win32 compilers are not compatible with COFF
       linkers such as DJGPP's, and vice versa. This is due to a difference
       of opinion over the precise semantics of PC-relative relocations. To
       produce COFF files suitable for DJGPP, use NASM's `coff' output
       format; conversely, the `coff' format does not produce object files
       that Win32 linkers can generate correct output from.

 6.3.1 `win32' Extensions to the `SECTION' Directive

       Like the `obj' format, `win32' allows you to specify additional
       information on the `SECTION' directive line, to control the type and
       properties of sections you declare. Section types and properties are
       generated automatically by NASM for the standard section names
       `.text', `.data' and `.bss', but may still be overridden by these
       qualifiers.

       The available qualifiers are:

       (*) `code', or equivalently `text', defines the section to be a code
           section. This marks the section as readable and executable, but
           not writable, and also indicates to the linker that the type of
           the section is code.

       (*) `data' and `bss' define the section to be a data section,
           analogously to `code'. Data sections are marked as readable and
           writable, but not executable. `data' declares an initialised
           data section, whereas `bss' declares an uninitialised data
           section.

       (*) `rdata' declares an initialised data section that is readable
           but not writable. Microsoft compilers use this section to place
           constants in it.

       (*) `info' defines the section to be an informational section, which
           is not included in the executable file by the linker, but may
           (for example) pass information _to_ the linker. For example,
           declaring an `info'-type section called `.drectve' causes the
           linker to interpret the contents of the section as command-line
           options.

       (*) `align=', used with a trailing number as in `obj', gives the
           alignment requirements of the section. The maximum you may
           specify is 64: the Win32 object file format contains no means to
           request a greater section alignment than this. If alignment is
           not explicitly specified, the defaults are 16-byte alignment for
           code sections, 8-byte alignment for rdata sections and 4-byte
           alignment for data (and BSS) sections. Informational sections
           get a default alignment of 1 byte (no alignment), though the
           value does not matter.

       The defaults assumed by NASM if you do not specify the above
       qualifiers are:

       section .text    code  align=16 
       section .data    data  align=4 
       section .rdata   rdata align=8 
       section .bss     bss   align=4

       Any other section name is treated by default like `.text'.

   6.4 `coff': Common Object File Format

       The `coff' output type produces `COFF' object files suitable for
       linking with the DJGPP linker.

       `coff' provides a default output file-name extension of `.o'.

       The `coff' format supports the same extensions to the `SECTION'
       directive as `win32' does, except that the `align' qualifier and the
       `info' section type are not supported.

   6.5 `elf': Executable and Linkable Format Object Files

       The `elf' output format generates `ELF32' (Executable and Linkable
       Format) object files, as used by Linux as well as Unix System V,
       including Solaris x86, UnixWare and SCO Unix. `elf' provides a
       default output file-name extension of `.o'.

 6.5.1 `elf' Extensions to the `SECTION' Directive

       Like the `obj' format, `elf' allows you to specify additional
       information on the `SECTION' directive line, to control the type and
       properties of sections you declare. Section types and properties are
       generated automatically by NASM for the standard section names
       `.text', `.data' and `.bss', but may still be overridden by these
       qualifiers.

       The available qualifiers are:

       (*) `alloc' defines the section to be one which is loaded into
           memory when the program is run. `noalloc' defines it to be one
           which is not, such as an informational or comment section.

       (*) `exec' defines the section to be one which should have execute
           permission when the program is run. `noexec' defines it as one
           which should not.

       (*) `write' defines the section to be one which should be writable
           when the program is run. `nowrite' defines it as one which
           should not.

       (*) `progbits' defines the section to be one with explicit contents
           stored in the object file: an ordinary code or data section, for
           example, `nobits' defines the section to be one with no explicit
           contents given, such as a BSS section.

       (*) `align=', used with a trailing number as in `obj', gives the
           alignment requirements of the section.

       The defaults assumed by NASM if you do not specify the above
       qualifiers are:

       section .text    progbits  alloc  exec    nowrite  align=16 
       section .rodata  progbits  alloc  noexec  nowrite  align=4 
       section .data    progbits  alloc  noexec  write    align=4 
       section .bss     nobits    alloc  noexec  write    align=4 
       section other    progbits  alloc  noexec  nowrite  align=1

       (Any section name other than `.text', `.rodata', `.data' and `.bss'
       is treated by default like `other' in the above code.)

 6.5.2 Position-Independent Code: `elf' Special Symbols and `WRT'

       The `ELF' specification contains enough features to allow position-
       independent code (PIC) to be written, which makes ELF shared
       libraries very flexible. However, it also means NASM has to be able
       to generate a variety of strange relocation types in ELF object
       files, if it is to be an assembler which can write PIC.

       Since `ELF' does not support segment-base references, the `WRT'
       operator is not used for its normal purpose; therefore NASM's `elf'
       output format makes use of `WRT' for a different purpose, namely the
       PIC-specific relocation types.

       `elf' defines five special symbols which you can use as the right-
       hand side of the `WRT' operator to obtain PIC relocation types. They
       are `..gotpc', `..gotoff', `..got', `..plt' and `..sym'. Their
       functions are summarised here:

       (*) Referring to the symbol marking the global offset table base
           using `wrt ..gotpc' will end up giving the distance from the
           beginning of the current section to the global offset table.
           (`_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_' is the standard symbol name used to
           refer to the GOT.) So you would then need to add `$$' to the
           result to get the real address of the GOT.

       (*) Referring to a location in one of your own sections using
           `wrt ..gotoff' will give the distance from the beginning of the
           GOT to the specified location, so that adding on the address of
           the GOT would give the real address of the location you wanted.

       (*) Referring to an external or global symbol using `wrt ..got'
           causes the linker to build an entry _in_ the GOT containing the
           address of the symbol, and the reference gives the distance from
           the beginning of the GOT to the entry; so you can add on the
           address of the GOT, load from the resulting address, and end up
           with the address of the symbol.

       (*) Referring to a procedure name using `wrt ..plt' causes the
           linker to build a procedure linkage table entry for the symbol,
           and the reference gives the address of the PLT entry. You can
           only use this in contexts which would generate a PC-relative
           relocation normally (i.e. as the destination for `CALL' or
           `JMP'), since ELF contains no relocation type to refer to PLT
           entries absolutely.

       (*) Referring to a symbol name using `wrt ..sym' causes NASM to
           write an ordinary relocation, but instead of making the
           relocation relative to the start of the section and then adding
           on the offset to the symbol, it will write a relocation record
           aimed directly at the symbol in question. The distinction is a
           necessary one due to a peculiarity of the dynamic linker.

       A fuller explanation of how to use these relocation types to write
       shared libraries entirely in NASM is given in section 8.2.

 6.5.3 `elf' Extensions to the `GLOBAL' Directive

       `ELF' object files can contain more information about a global
       symbol than just its address: they can contain the size of the
       symbol and its type as well. These are not merely debugger
       conveniences, but are actually necessary when the program being
       written is a shared library. NASM therefore supports some extensions
       to the `GLOBAL' directive, allowing you to specify these features.

       You can specify whether a global variable is a function or a data
       object by suffixing the name with a colon and the word `function' or
       `data'. (`object' is a synonym for `data'.) For example:

       global   hashlookup:function, hashtable:data

       exports the global symbol `hashlookup' as a function and `hashtable'
       as a data object.

       You can also specify the size of the data associated with the
       symbol, as a numeric expression (which may involve labels, and even
       forward references) after the type specifier. Like this:

       global  hashtable:data (hashtable.end - hashtable) 
       
       hashtable: 
               db this,that,theother  ; some data here 
       .end:

       This makes NASM automatically calculate the length of the table and
       place that information into the `ELF' symbol table.

       Declaring the type and size of global symbols is necessary when
       writing shared library code. For more information, see section
       8.2.4.

 6.5.4 `elf' Extensions to the `COMMON' Directive 

       `ELF' also allows you to specify alignment requirements on common
       variables. This is done by putting a number (which must be a power
       of two) after the name and size of the common variable, separated
       (as usual) by a colon. For example, an array of doublewords would
       benefit from 4-byte alignment:

       common  dwordarray 128:4

       This declares the total size of the array to be 128 bytes, and
       requires that it be aligned on a 4-byte boundary.

 6.5.5 16-bit code and ELF 

       The `ELF32' specification doesn't provide relocations for 8- and 16-
       bit values, but the GNU `ld' linker adds these as an extension. NASM
       can generate GNU-compatible relocations, to allow 16-bit code to be
       linked as ELF using GNU `ld'. If NASM is used with the
       `-w+gnu-elf-extensions' option, a warning is issued when one of
       these relocations is generated.

   6.6 `aout': Linux `a.out' Object Files

       The `aout' format generates `a.out' object files, in the form used
       by early Linux systems (current Linux systems use ELF, see section
       6.5.) These differ from other `a.out' object files in that the magic
       number in the first four bytes of the file is different; also, some
       implementations of `a.out', for example NetBSD's, support position-
       independent code, which Linux's implementation does not.

       `a.out' provides a default output file-name extension of `.o'.

       `a.out' is a very simple object format. It supports no special
       directives, no special symbols, no use of `SEG' or `WRT', and no
       extensions to any standard directives. It supports only the three
       standard section names `.text', `.data' and `.bss'.

   6.7 `aoutb': NetBSD/FreeBSD/OpenBSD `a.out' Object Files

       The `aoutb' format generates `a.out' object files, in the form used
       by the various free `BSD Unix' clones, `NetBSD', `FreeBSD' and
       `OpenBSD'. For simple object files, this object format is exactly
       the same as `aout' except for the magic number in the first four
       bytes of the file. However, the `aoutb' format supports
       position-independent code in the same way as the `elf' format, so
       you can use it to write `BSD' shared libraries.

       `aoutb' provides a default output file-name extension of `.o'.

       `aoutb' supports no special directives, no special symbols, and only
       the three standard section names `.text', `.data' and `.bss'.
       However, it also supports the same use of `WRT' as `elf' does, to
       provide position-independent code relocation types. See section
       6.5.2 for full documentation of this feature.

       `aoutb' also supports the same extensions to the `GLOBAL' directive
       as `elf' does: see section 6.5.3 for documentation of this.

   6.8 `as86': Minix/Linux `as86' Object Files

       The Minix/Linux 16-bit assembler `as86' has its own non-standard
       object file format. Although its companion linker `ld86' produces
       something close to ordinary `a.out' binaries as output, the object
       file format used to communicate between `as86' and `ld86' is not
       itself `a.out'.

       NASM supports this format, just in case it is useful, as `as86'.
       `as86' provides a default output file-name extension of `.o'.

       `as86' is a very simple object format (from the NASM user's point of
       view). It supports no special directives, no special symbols, no use
       of `SEG' or `WRT', and no extensions to any standard directives. It
       supports only the three standard section names `.text', `.data' and
       `.bss'.

   6.9 `rdf': Relocatable Dynamic Object File Format

       The `rdf' output format produces `RDOFF' object files. `RDOFF'
       (Relocatable Dynamic Object File Format) is a home-grown object-file
       format, designed alongside NASM itself and reflecting in its file
       format the internal structure of the assembler.

       `RDOFF' is not used by any well-known operating systems. Those
       writing their own systems, however, may well wish to use `RDOFF' as
       their object format, on the grounds that it is designed primarily
       for simplicity and contains very little file-header bureaucracy.

       The Unix NASM archive, and the DOS archive which includes sources,
       both contain an `rdoff' subdirectory holding a set of RDOFF
       utilities: an RDF linker, an `RDF' static-library manager, an RDF
       file dump utility, and a program which will load and execute an RDF
       executable under Linux.

       `rdf' supports only the standard section names `.text', `.data' and
       `.bss'.

 6.9.1 Requiring a Library: The `LIBRARY' Directive

       `RDOFF' contains a mechanism for an object file to demand a given
       library to be linked to the module, either at load time or run time.
       This is done by the `LIBRARY' directive, which takes one argument
       which is the name of the module:

           library  mylib.rdl

 6.9.2 Specifying a Module Name: The `MODULE' Directive

       Special `RDOFF' header record is used to store the name of the
       module. It can be used, for example, by run-time loader to perform
       dynamic linking. `MODULE' directive takes one argument which is the
       name of current module:

           module  mymodname

       Note that when you statically link modules and tell linker to strip
       the symbols from output file, all module names will be stripped too.
       To avoid it, you should start module names with `$', like:

           module  $kernel.core

 6.9.3 `rdf' Extensions to the `GLOBAL' directive

       `RDOFF' global symbols can contain additional information needed by
       the static linker. You can mark a global symbol as exported, thus
       telling the linker do not strip it from target executable or library
       file. Like in `ELF', you can also specify whether an exported symbol
       is a procedure (function) or data object.

       Suffixing the name with a colon and the word `export' you make the
       symbol exported:

           global  sys_open:export

       To specify that exported symbol is a procedure (function), you add
       the word `proc' or `function' after declaration:

           global  sys_open:export proc

       Similarly, to specify exported data object, add the word `data' or
       `object' to the directive:

           global  kernel_ticks:export data

 6.9.4 `rdf' Extensions to the `EXTERN' directive

       By default the `EXTERN' directive in `RDOFF' declares a "pure
       external" symbol (i.e. the static linker will complain if such a
       symbol is not resolved). To declare an "imported" symbol, which must
       be resolved later during a dynamic linking phase, `RDOFF' offers an
       additional `import' modifier. As in `GLOBAL', you can also specify
       whether an imported symbol is a procedure (function) or data object.
       For example:

           library $libc 
           extern  _open:import 
           extern  _printf:import proc 
           extern  _errno:import data

       Here the directive `LIBRARY' is also included, which gives the
       dynamic linker a hint as to where to find requested symbols.

  6.10 `dbg': Debugging Format

       The `dbg' output format is not built into NASM in the default
       configuration. If you are building your own NASM executable from the
       sources, you can define `OF_DBG' in `outform.h' or on the compiler
       command line, and obtain the `dbg' output format.

       The `dbg' format does not output an object file as such; instead, it
       outputs a text file which contains a complete list of all the
       transactions between the main body of NASM and the output-format
       back end module. It is primarily intended to aid people who want to
       write their own output drivers, so that they can get a clearer idea
       of the various requests the main program makes of the output driver,
       and in what order they happen.

       For simple files, one can easily use the `dbg' format like this:

       nasm -f dbg filename.asm

       which will generate a diagnostic file called `filename.dbg'.
       However, this will not work well on files which were designed for a
       different object format, because each object format defines its own
       macros (usually user-level forms of directives), and those macros
       will not be defined in the `dbg' format. Therefore it can be useful
       to run NASM twice, in order to do the preprocessing with the native
       object format selected:

       nasm -e -f rdf -o rdfprog.i rdfprog.asm 
       nasm -a -f dbg rdfprog.i

       This preprocesses `rdfprog.asm' into `rdfprog.i', keeping the `rdf'
       object format selected in order to make sure RDF special directives
       are converted into primitive form correctly. Then the preprocessed
       source is fed through the `dbg' format to generate the final
       diagnostic output.

       This workaround will still typically not work for programs intended
       for `obj' format, because the `obj' `SEGMENT' and `GROUP' directives
       have side effects of defining the segment and group names as
       symbols; `dbg' will not do this, so the program will not assemble.
       You will have to work around that by defining the symbols yourself
       (using `EXTERN', for example) if you really need to get a `dbg'
       trace of an `obj'-specific source file.

       `dbg' accepts any section name and any directives at all, and logs
       them all to its output file.

Chapter 7: Writing 16-bit Code (DOS, Windows 3/3.1)
---------------------------------------------------

       This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues encountered
       when writing 16-bit code to run under `MS-DOS' or `Windows 3.x'. It
       covers how to link programs to produce `.EXE' or `.COM' files, how
       to write `.SYS' device drivers, and how to interface assembly
       language code with 16-bit C compilers and with Borland Pascal.

   7.1 Producing `.EXE' Files

       Any large program written under DOS needs to be built as a `.EXE'
       file: only `.EXE' files have the necessary internal structure
       required to span more than one 64K segment. Windows programs, also,
       have to be built as `.EXE' files, since Windows does not support the
       `.COM' format.

       In general, you generate `.EXE' files by using the `obj' output
       format to produce one or more `.OBJ' files, and then linking them
       together using a linker. However, NASM also supports the direct
       generation of simple DOS `.EXE' files using the `bin' output format
       (by using `DB' and `DW' to construct the `.EXE' file header), and a
       macro package is supplied to do this. Thanks to Yann Guidon for
       contributing the code for this.

       NASM may also support `.EXE' natively as another output format in
       future releases.

 7.1.1 Using the `obj' Format To Generate `.EXE' Files

       This section describes the usual method of generating `.EXE' files
       by linking `.OBJ' files together.

       Most 16-bit programming language packages come with a suitable
       linker; if you have none of these, there is a free linker called
       VAL, available in `LZH' archive format from `x2ftp.oulu.fi'. An LZH
       archiver can be found at `ftp.simtel.net'. There is another `free'
       linker (though this one doesn't come with sources) called FREELINK,
       available from `www.pcorner.com'. A third, `djlink', written by DJ
       Delorie, is available at `www.delorie.com'. A fourth linker,
       `ALINK', written by Anthony A.J. Williams, is available at
       `alink.sourceforge.net'.

       When linking several `.OBJ' files into a `.EXE' file, you should
       ensure that exactly one of them has a start point defined (using the
       `..start' special symbol defined by the `obj' format: see section
       6.2.6). If no module defines a start point, the linker will not know
       what value to give the entry-point field in the output file header;
       if more than one defines a start point, the linker will not know
       _which_ value to use.

       An example of a NASM source file which can be assembled to a `.OBJ'
       file and linked on its own to a `.EXE' is given here. It
       demonstrates the basic principles of defining a stack, initialising
       the segment registers, and declaring a start point. This file is
       also provided in the `test' subdirectory of the NASM archives, under
       the name `objexe.asm'.

       segment code 
       
       ..start: 
               mov     ax,data 
               mov     ds,ax 
               mov     ax,stack 
               mov     ss,ax 
               mov     sp,stacktop

       This initial piece of code sets up `DS' to point to the data
       segment, and initialises `SS' and `SP' to point to the top of the
       provided stack. Notice that interrupts are implicitly disabled for
       one instruction after a move into `SS', precisely for this
       situation, so that there's no chance of an interrupt occurring
       between the loads of `SS' and `SP' and not having a stack to execute
       on.

       Note also that the special symbol `..start' is defined at the
       beginning of this code, which means that will be the entry point
       into the resulting executable file.

               mov     dx,hello 
               mov     ah,9 
               int     0x21

       The above is the main program: load `DS:DX' with a pointer to the
       greeting message (`hello' is implicitly relative to the segment
       `data', which was loaded into `DS' in the setup code, so the full
       pointer is valid), and call the DOS print-string function.

               mov     ax,0x4c00 
               int     0x21

       This terminates the program using another DOS system call.

       segment data 
       
       hello:  db      'hello, world', 13, 10, '$'

       The data segment contains the string we want to display.

       segment stack stack 
               resb 64 
       stacktop:

       The above code declares a stack segment containing 64 bytes of
       uninitialised stack space, and points `stacktop' at the top of it.
       The directive `segment stack stack' defines a segment _called_
       `stack', and also of _type_ `STACK'. The latter is not necessary to
       the correct running of the program, but linkers are likely to issue
       warnings or errors if your program has no segment of type `STACK'.

       The above file, when assembled into a `.OBJ' file, will link on its
       own to a valid `.EXE' file, which when run will print `hello, world'
       and then exit.

 7.1.2 Using the `bin' Format To Generate `.EXE' Files

       The `.EXE' file format is simple enough that it's possible to build
       a `.EXE' file by writing a pure-binary program and sticking a 32-
       byte header on the front. This header is simple enough that it can
       be generated using `DB' and `DW' commands by NASM itself, so that
       you can use the `bin' output format to directly generate `.EXE'
       files.

       Included in the NASM archives, in the `misc' subdirectory, is a file
       `exebin.mac' of macros. It defines three macros: `EXE_begin',
       `EXE_stack' and `EXE_end'.

       To produce a `.EXE' file using this method, you should start by
       using `%include' to load the `exebin.mac' macro package into your
       source file. You should then issue the `EXE_begin' macro call (which
       takes no arguments) to generate the file header data. Then write
       code as normal for the `bin' format - you can use all three standard
       sections `.text', `.data' and `.bss'. At the end of the file you
       should call the `EXE_end' macro (again, no arguments), which defines
       some symbols to mark section sizes, and these symbols are referred
       to in the header code generated by `EXE_begin'.

       In this model, the code you end up writing starts at `0x100', just
       like a `.COM' file - in fact, if you strip off the 32-byte header
       from the resulting `.EXE' file, you will have a valid `.COM'
       program. All the segment bases are the same, so you are limited to a
       64K program, again just like a `.COM' file. Note that an `ORG'
       directive is issued by the `EXE_begin' macro, so you should not
       explicitly issue one of your own.

       You can't directly refer to your segment base value, unfortunately,
       since this would require a relocation in the header, and things
       would get a lot more complicated. So you should get your segment
       base by copying it out of `CS' instead.

       On entry to your `.EXE' file, `SS:SP' are already set up to point to
       the top of a 2Kb stack. You can adjust the default stack size of 2Kb
       by calling the `EXE_stack' macro. For example, to change the stack
       size of your program to 64 bytes, you would call `EXE_stack 64'.

       A sample program which generates a `.EXE' file in this way is given
       in the `test' subdirectory of the NASM archive, as `binexe.asm'.

   7.2 Producing `.COM' Files

       While large DOS programs must be written as `.EXE' files, small ones
       are often better written as `.COM' files. `.COM' files are pure
       binary, and therefore most easily produced using the `bin' output
       format.

 7.2.1 Using the `bin' Format To Generate `.COM' Files

       `.COM' files expect to be loaded at offset `100h' into their segment
       (though the segment may change). Execution then begins at `100h',
       i.e. right at the start of the program. So to write a `.COM'
       program, you would create a source file looking like

               org 100h 
       
       section .text 
       
       start: 
               ; put your code here 
       
       section .data 
       
               ; put data items here 
       
       section .bss 
       
               ; put uninitialised data here

       The `bin' format puts the `.text' section first in the file, so you
       can declare data or BSS items before beginning to write code if you
       want to and the code will still end up at the front of the file
       where it belongs.

       The BSS (uninitialised data) section does not take up space in the
       `.COM' file itself: instead, addresses of BSS items are resolved to
       point at space beyond the end of the file, on the grounds that this
       will be free memory when the program is run. Therefore you should
       not rely on your BSS being initialised to all zeros when you run.

       To assemble the above program, you should use a command line like

       nasm myprog.asm -fbin -o myprog.com

       The `bin' format would produce a file called `myprog' if no explicit
       output file name were specified, so you have to override it and give
       the desired file name.

 7.2.2 Using the `obj' Format To Generate `.COM' Files

       If you are writing a `.COM' program as more than one module, you may
       wish to assemble several `.OBJ' files and link them together into a
       `.COM' program. You can do this, provided you have a linker capable
       of outputting `.COM' files directly (TLINK does this), or
       alternatively a converter program such as `EXE2BIN' to transform the
       `.EXE' file output from the linker into a `.COM' file.

       If you do this, you need to take care of several things:

       (*) The first object file containing code should start its code
           segment with a line like `RESB 100h'. This is to ensure that the
           code begins at offset `100h' relative to the beginning of the
           code segment, so that the linker or converter program does not
           have to adjust address references within the file when
           generating the `.COM' file. Other assemblers use an `ORG'
           directive for this purpose, but `ORG' in NASM is a format-
           specific directive to the `bin' output format, and does not mean
           the same thing as it does in MASM-compatible assemblers.

       (*) You don't need to define a stack segment.

       (*) All your segments should be in the same group, so that every
           time your code or data references a symbol offset, all offsets
           are relative to the same segment base. This is because, when a
           `.COM' file is loaded, all the segment registers contain the
           same value.

   7.3 Producing `.SYS' Files

       MS-DOS device drivers - `.SYS' files - are pure binary files,
       similar to `.COM' files, except that they start at origin zero
       rather than `100h'. Therefore, if you are writing a device driver
       using the `bin' format, you do not need the `ORG' directive, since
       the default origin for `bin' is zero. Similarly, if you are using
       `obj', you do not need the `RESB 100h' at the start of your code
       segment.

       `.SYS' files start with a header structure, containing pointers to
       the various routines inside the driver which do the work. This
       structure should be defined at the start of the code segment, even
       though it is not actually code.

       For more information on the format of `.SYS' files, and the data
       which has to go in the header structure, a list of books is given in
       the Frequently Asked Questions list for the newsgroup
       `comp.os.msdos.programmer'.

   7.4 Interfacing to 16-bit C Programs

       This section covers the basics of writing assembly routines that
       call, or are called from, C programs. To do this, you would
       typically write an assembly module as a `.OBJ' file, and link it
       with your C modules to produce a mixed-language program.

 7.4.1 External Symbol Names

       C compilers have the convention that the names of all global symbols
       (functions or data) they define are formed by prefixing an
       underscore to the name as it appears in the C program. So, for
       example, the function a C programmer thinks of as `printf' appears
       to an assembly language programmer as `_printf'. This means that in
       your assembly programs, you can define symbols without a leading
       underscore, and not have to worry about name clashes with C symbols.

       If you find the underscores inconvenient, you can define macros to
       replace the `GLOBAL' and `EXTERN' directives as follows:

       %macro  cglobal 1 
       
         global  _%1 
         %define %1 _%1 
       
       %endmacro 
       
       %macro  cextern 1 
       
         extern  _%1 
         %define %1 _%1 
       
       %endmacro

       (These forms of the macros only take one argument at a time; a
       `%rep' construct could solve this.)

       If you then declare an external like this:

       cextern printf

       then the macro will expand it as

       extern  _printf 
       %define printf _printf

       Thereafter, you can reference `printf' as if it was a symbol, and
       the preprocessor will put the leading underscore on where necessary.

       The `cglobal' macro works similarly. You must use `cglobal' before
       defining the symbol in question, but you would have had to do that
       anyway if you used `GLOBAL'.

       Also see section 2.1.21.

 7.4.2 Memory Models

       NASM contains no mechanism to support the various C memory models
       directly; you have to keep track yourself of which one you are
       writing for. This means you have to keep track of the following
       things:

       (*) In models using a single code segment (tiny, small and compact),
           functions are near. This means that function pointers, when
           stored in data segments or pushed on the stack as function
           arguments, are 16 bits long and contain only an offset field
           (the `CS' register never changes its value, and always gives the
           segment part of the full function address), and that functions
           are called using ordinary near `CALL' instructions and return
           using `RETN' (which, in NASM, is synonymous with `RET' anyway).
           This means both that you should write your own routines to
           return with `RETN', and that you should call external C routines
           with near `CALL' instructions.

       (*) In models using more than one code segment (medium, large and
           huge), functions are far. This means that function pointers are
           32 bits long (consisting of a 16-bit offset followed by a 16-bit
           segment), and that functions are called using `CALL FAR' (or
           `CALL seg:offset') and return using `RETF'. Again, you should
           therefore write your own routines to return with `RETF' and use
           `CALL FAR' to call external routines.

       (*) In models using a single data segment (tiny, small and medium),
           data pointers are 16 bits long, containing only an offset field
           (the `DS' register doesn't change its value, and always gives
           the segment part of the full data item address).

       (*) In models using more than one data segment (compact, large and
           huge), data pointers are 32 bits long, consisting of a 16-bit
           offset followed by a 16-bit segment. You should still be careful
           not to modify `DS' in your routines without restoring it
           afterwards, but `ES' is free for you to use to access the
           contents of 32-bit data pointers you are passed.

       (*) The huge memory model allows single data items to exceed 64K in
           size. In all other memory models, you can access the whole of a
           data item just by doing arithmetic on the offset field of the
           pointer you are given, whether a segment field is present or
           not; in huge model, you have to be more careful of your pointer
           arithmetic.

       (*) In most memory models, there is a _default_ data segment, whose
           segment address is kept in `DS' throughout the program. This
           data segment is typically the same segment as the stack, kept in
           `SS', so that functions' local variables (which are stored on
           the stack) and global data items can both be accessed easily
           without changing `DS'. Particularly large data items are
           typically stored in other segments. However, some memory models
           (though not the standard ones, usually) allow the assumption
           that `SS' and `DS' hold the same value to be removed. Be careful
           about functions' local variables in this latter case.

       In models with a single code segment, the segment is called `_TEXT',
       so your code segment must also go by this name in order to be linked
       into the same place as the main code segment. In models with a
       single data segment, or with a default data segment, it is called
       `_DATA'.

 7.4.3 Function Definitions and Function Calls

       The C calling convention in 16-bit programs is as follows. In the
       following description, the words _caller_ and _callee_ are used to
       denote the function doing the calling and the function which gets
       called.

       (*) The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
           after another, in reverse order (right to left, so that the
           first argument specified to the function is pushed last).

       (*) The caller then executes a `CALL' instruction to pass control to
           the callee. This `CALL' is either near or far depending on the
           memory model.

       (*) The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
           actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access
           their parameters) starts by saving the value of `SP' in `BP' so
           as to be able to use `BP' as a base pointer to find its
           parameters on the stack. However, the caller was probably doing
           this too, so part of the calling convention states that `BP'
           must be preserved by any C function. Hence the callee, if it is
           going to set up `BP' as a _frame pointer_, must push the
           previous value first.

       (*) The callee may then access its parameters relative to `BP'. The
           word at `[BP]' holds the previous value of `BP' as it was
           pushed; the next word, at `[BP+2]', holds the offset part of the
           return address, pushed implicitly by `CALL'. In a small-model
           (near) function, the parameters start after that, at `[BP+4]';
           in a large-model (far) function, the segment part of the return
           address lives at `[BP+4]', and the parameters begin at `[BP+6]'.
           The leftmost parameter of the function, since it was pushed
           last, is accessible at this offset from `BP'; the others follow,
           at successively greater offsets. Thus, in a function such as
           `printf' which takes a variable number of parameters, the
           pushing of the parameters in reverse order means that the
           function knows where to find its first parameter, which tells it
           the number and type of the remaining ones.

       (*) The callee may also wish to decrease `SP' further, so as to
           allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then
           be accessible at negative offsets from `BP'.

       (*) The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
           leave the value in `AL', `AX' or `DX:AX' depending on the size
           of the value. Floating-point results are sometimes (depending on
           the compiler) returned in `ST0'.

       (*) Once the callee has finished processing, it restores `SP' from
           `BP' if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the
           previous value of `BP', and returns via `RETN' or `RETF'
           depending on memory model.

       (*) When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
           parameters are still on the stack, so it typically adds an
           immediate constant to `SP' to remove them (instead of executing
           a number of slow `POP' instructions). Thus, if a function is
           accidentally called with the wrong number of parameters due to a
           prototype mismatch, the stack will still be returned to a
           sensible state since the caller, which _knows_ how many
           parameters it pushed, does the removing.

       It is instructive to compare this calling convention with that for
       Pascal programs (described in section 7.5.1). Pascal has a simpler
       convention, since no functions have variable numbers of parameters.
       Therefore the callee knows how many parameters it should have been
       passed, and is able to deallocate them from the stack itself by
       passing an immediate argument to the `RET' or `RETF' instruction, so
       the caller does not have to do it. Also, the parameters are pushed
       in left-to-right order, not right-to-left, which means that a
       compiler can give better guarantees about sequence points without
       performance suffering.

       Thus, you would define a function in C style in the following way.
       The following example is for small model:

       global  _myfunc 
       
       _myfunc: 
               push    bp 
               mov     bp,sp 
               sub     sp,0x40         ; 64 bytes of local stack space 
               mov     bx,[bp+4]       ; first parameter to function 
       
               ; some more code 
       
               mov     sp,bp           ; undo "sub sp,0x40" above 
               pop     bp 
               ret

       For a large-model function, you would replace `RET' by `RETF', and
       look for the first parameter at `[BP+6]' instead of `[BP+4]'. Of
       course, if one of the parameters is a pointer, then the offsets of
       _subsequent_ parameters will change depending on the memory model as
       well: far pointers take up four bytes on the stack when passed as a
       parameter, whereas near pointers take up two.

       At the other end of the process, to call a C function from your
       assembly code, you would do something like this:

       extern  _printf 
       
             ; and then, further down... 
       
             push    word [myint]        ; one of my integer variables 
             push    word mystring       ; pointer into my data segment 
             call    _printf 
             add     sp,byte 4           ; `byte' saves space 
       
             ; then those data items... 
       
       segment _DATA 
       
       myint         dw    1234 
       mystring      db    'This number -> %d <- should be 1234',10,0

       This piece of code is the small-model assembly equivalent of the C
       code

           int myint = 1234; 
           printf("This number -> %d <- should be 1234\n", myint);

       In large model, the function-call code might look more like this. In
       this example, it is assumed that `DS' already holds the segment base
       of the segment `_DATA'. If not, you would have to initialise it
       first.

             push    word [myint] 
             push    word seg mystring   ; Now push the segment, and... 
             push    word mystring       ; ... offset of "mystring" 
             call    far _printf 
             add    sp,byte 6

       The integer value still takes up one word on the stack, since large
       model does not affect the size of the `int' data type. The first
       argument (pushed last) to `printf', however, is a data pointer, and
       therefore has to contain a segment and offset part. The segment
       should be stored second in memory, and therefore must be pushed
       first. (Of course, `PUSH DS' would have been a shorter instruction
       than `PUSH WORD SEG mystring', if `DS' was set up as the above
       example assumed.) Then the actual call becomes a far call, since
       functions expect far calls in large model; and `SP' has to be
       increased by 6 rather than 4 afterwards to make up for the extra
       word of parameters.

 7.4.4 Accessing Data Items

       To get at the contents of C variables, or to declare variables which
       C can access, you need only declare the names as `GLOBAL' or
       `EXTERN'. (Again, the names require leading underscores, as stated
       in section 7.4.1.) Thus, a C variable declared as `int i' can be
       accessed from assembler as

       extern _i 
       
               mov ax,[_i]

       And to declare your own integer variable which C programs can access
       as `extern int j', you do this (making sure you are assembling in
       the `_DATA' segment, if necessary):

       global  _j 
       
       _j      dw      0

       To access a C array, you need to know the size of the components of
       the array. For example, `int' variables are two bytes long, so if a
       C program declares an array as `int a[10]', you can access `a[3]' by
       coding `mov ax,[_a+6]'. (The byte offset 6 is obtained by
       multiplying the desired array index, 3, by the size of the array
       element, 2.) The sizes of the C base types in 16-bit compilers are:
       1 for `char', 2 for `short' and `int', 4 for `long' and `float', and
       8 for `double'.

       To access a C data structure, you need to know the offset from the
       base of the structure to the field you are interested in. You can
       either do this by converting the C structure definition into a NASM
       structure definition (using `STRUC'), or by calculating the one
       offset and using just that.

       To do either of these, you should read your C compiler's manual to
       find out how it organises data structures. NASM gives no special
       alignment to structure members in its own `STRUC' macro, so you have
       to specify alignment yourself if the C compiler generates it.
       Typically, you might find that a structure like

       struct { 
           char c; 
           int i; 
       } foo;

       might be four bytes long rather than three, since the `int' field
       would be aligned to a two-byte boundary. However, this sort of
       feature tends to be a configurable option in the C compiler, either
       using command-line options or `#pragma' lines, so you have to find
       out how your own compiler does it.

 7.4.5 `c16.mac': Helper Macros for the 16-bit C Interface

       Included in the NASM archives, in the `misc' directory, is a file
       `c16.mac' of macros. It defines three macros: `proc', `arg' and
       `endproc'. These are intended to be used for C-style procedure
       definitions, and they automate a lot of the work involved in keeping
       track of the calling convention.

       (An alternative, TASM compatible form of `arg' is also now built
       into NASM's preprocessor. See section 4.9 for details.)

       An example of an assembly function using the macro set is given
       here:

       proc    _nearproc 
       
       %$i     arg 
       %$j     arg 
               mov     ax,[bp + %$i] 
               mov     bx,[bp + %$j] 
               add     ax,[bx] 
       
       endproc

       This defines `_nearproc' to be a procedure taking two arguments, the
       first (`i') an integer and the second (`j') a pointer to an integer.
       It returns `i + *j'.

       Note that the `arg' macro has an `EQU' as the first line of its
       expansion, and since the label before the macro call gets prepended
       to the first line of the expanded macro, the `EQU' works, defining
       `%$i' to be an offset from `BP'. A context-local variable is used,
       local to the context pushed by the `proc' macro and popped by the
       `endproc' macro, so that the same argument name can be used in later
       procedures. Of course, you don't _have_ to do that.

       The macro set produces code for near functions (tiny, small and
       compact-model code) by default. You can have it generate far
       functions (medium, large and huge-model code) by means of coding
       `%define FARCODE'. This changes the kind of return instruction
       generated by `endproc', and also changes the starting point for the
       argument offsets. The macro set contains no intrinsic dependency on
       whether data pointers are far or not.

       `arg' can take an optional parameter, giving the size of the
       argument. If no size is given, 2 is assumed, since it is likely that
       many function parameters will be of type `int'.

       The large-model equivalent of the above function would look like
       this:

       %define FARCODE 
       
       proc    _farproc 
       
       %$i     arg 
       %$j     arg     4 
               mov     ax,[bp + %$i] 
               mov     bx,[bp + %$j] 
               mov     es,[bp + %$j + 2] 
               add     ax,[bx] 
       
       endproc

       This makes use of the argument to the `arg' macro to define a
       parameter of size 4, because `j' is now a far pointer. When we load
       from `j', we must load a segment and an offset.

   7.5 Interfacing to Borland Pascal Programs

       Interfacing to Borland Pascal programs is similar in concept to
       interfacing to 16-bit C programs. The differences are:

       (*) The leading underscore required for interfacing to C programs is
           not required for Pascal.

       (*) The memory model is always large: functions are far, data
           pointers are far, and no data item can be more than 64K long.
           (Actually, some functions are near, but only those functions
           that are local to a Pascal unit and never called from outside
           it. All assembly functions that Pascal calls, and all Pascal
           functions that assembly routines are able to call, are far.)
           However, all static data declared in a Pascal program goes into
           the default data segment, which is the one whose segment address
           will be in `DS' when control is passed to your assembly code.
           The only things that do not live in the default data segment are
           local variables (they live in the stack segment) and dynamically
           allocated variables. All data _pointers_, however, are far.

       (*) The function calling convention is different - described below.

       (*) Some data types, such as strings, are stored differently.

       (*) There are restrictions on the segment names you are allowed to
           use - Borland Pascal will ignore code or data declared in a
           segment it doesn't like the name of. The restrictions are
           described below.

 7.5.1 The Pascal Calling Convention

       The 16-bit Pascal calling convention is as follows. In the following
       description, the words _caller_ and _callee_ are used to denote the
       function doing the calling and the function which gets called.

       (*) The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
           after another, in normal order (left to right, so that the first
           argument specified to the function is pushed first).

       (*) The caller then executes a far `CALL' instruction to pass
           control to the callee.

       (*) The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
           actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access
           their parameters) starts by saving the value of `SP' in `BP' so
           as to be able to use `BP' as a base pointer to find its
           parameters on the stack. However, the caller was probably doing
           this too, so part of the calling convention states that `BP'
           must be preserved by any function. Hence the callee, if it is
           going to set up `BP' as a frame pointer, must push the previous
           value first.

       (*) The callee may then access its parameters relative to `BP'. The
           word at `[BP]' holds the previous value of `BP' as it was
           pushed. The next word, at `[BP+2]', holds the offset part of the
           return address, and the next one at `[BP+4]' the segment part.
           The parameters begin at `[BP+6]'. The rightmost parameter of the
           function, since it was pushed last, is accessible at this offset
           from `BP'; the others follow, at successively greater offsets.

       (*) The callee may also wish to decrease `SP' further, so as to
           allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then
           be accessible at negative offsets from `BP'.

       (*) The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
           leave the value in `AL', `AX' or `DX:AX' depending on the size
           of the value. Floating-point results are returned in `ST0'.
           Results of type `Real' (Borland's own custom floating-point data
           type, not handled directly by the FPU) are returned in
           `DX:BX:AX'. To return a result of type `String', the caller
           pushes a pointer to a temporary string before pushing the
           parameters, and the callee places the returned string value at
           that location. The pointer is not a parameter, and should not be
           removed from the stack by the `RETF' instruction.

       (*) Once the callee has finished processing, it restores `SP' from
           `BP' if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the
           previous value of `BP', and returns via `RETF'. It uses the form
           of `RETF' with an immediate parameter, giving the number of
           bytes taken up by the parameters on the stack. This causes the
           parameters to be removed from the stack as a side effect of the
           return instruction.

       (*) When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
           parameters have already been removed from the stack, so it needs
           to do nothing further.

       Thus, you would define a function in Pascal style, taking two
       `Integer'-type parameters, in the following way:

       global  myfunc 
       
       myfunc: push    bp 
               mov     bp,sp 
               sub     sp,0x40         ; 64 bytes of local stack space 
               mov     bx,[bp+8]       ; first parameter to function 
               mov     bx,[bp+6]       ; second parameter to function 
       
               ; some more code 
       
               mov     sp,bp           ; undo "sub sp,0x40" above 
               pop     bp 
               retf    4               ; total size of params is 4

       At the other end of the process, to call a Pascal function from your
       assembly code, you would do something like this:

       extern  SomeFunc 
       
              ; and then, further down... 
       
              push   word seg mystring   ; Now push the segment, and... 
              push   word mystring       ; ... offset of "mystring" 
              push   word [myint]        ; one of my variables 
              call   far SomeFunc

       This is equivalent to the Pascal code

       procedure SomeFunc(String: PChar; Int: Integer); 
           SomeFunc(@mystring, myint);

 7.5.2 Borland Pascal Segment Name Restrictions

       Since Borland Pascal's internal unit file format is completely
       different from `OBJ', it only makes a very sketchy job of actually
       reading and understanding the various information contained in a
       real `OBJ' file when it links that in. Therefore an object file
       intended to be linked to a Pascal program must obey a number of
       restrictions:

       (*) Procedures and functions must be in a segment whose name is
           either `CODE', `CSEG', or something ending in `_TEXT'.

       (*) Initialised data must be in a segment whose name is either
           `CONST' or something ending in `_DATA'.

       (*) Uninitialised data must be in a segment whose name is either
           `DATA', `DSEG', or something ending in `_BSS'.

       (*) Any other segments in the object file are completely ignored.
           `GROUP' directives and segment attributes are also ignored.

 7.5.3 Using `c16.mac' With Pascal Programs

       The `c16.mac' macro package, described in section 7.4.5, can also be
       used to simplify writing functions to be called from Pascal
       programs, if you code `%define PASCAL'. This definition ensures that
       functions are far (it implies `FARCODE'), and also causes procedure
       return instructions to be generated with an operand.

       Defining `PASCAL' does not change the code which calculates the
       argument offsets; you must declare your function's arguments in
       reverse order. For example:

       %define PASCAL 
       
       proc    _pascalproc 
       
       %$j     arg 4 
       %$i     arg 
               mov     ax,[bp + %$i] 
               mov     bx,[bp + %$j] 
               mov     es,[bp + %$j + 2] 
               add     ax,[bx] 
       
       endproc

       This defines the same routine, conceptually, as the example in
       section 7.4.5: it defines a function taking two arguments, an
       integer and a pointer to an integer, which returns the sum of the
       integer and the contents of the pointer. The only difference between
       this code and the large-model C version is that `PASCAL' is defined
       instead of `FARCODE', and that the arguments are declared in reverse
       order.

Chapter 8: Writing 32-bit Code (Unix, Win32, DJGPP)
---------------------------------------------------

       This chapter attempts to cover some of the common issues involved
       when writing 32-bit code, to run under Win32 or Unix, or to be
       linked with C code generated by a Unix-style C compiler such as
       DJGPP. It covers how to write assembly code to interface with 32-bit
       C routines, and how to write position-independent code for shared
       libraries.

       Almost all 32-bit code, and in particular all code running under
       `Win32', `DJGPP' or any of the PC Unix variants, runs in _flat_
       memory model. This means that the segment registers and paging have
       already been set up to give you the same 32-bit 4Gb address space no
       matter what segment you work relative to, and that you should ignore
       all segment registers completely. When writing flat-model
       application code, you never need to use a segment override or modify
       any segment register, and the code-section addresses you pass to
       `CALL' and `JMP' live in the same address space as the data-section
       addresses you access your variables by and the stack-section
       addresses you access local variables and procedure parameters by.
       Every address is 32 bits long and contains only an offset part.

   8.1 Interfacing to 32-bit C Programs

       A lot of the discussion in section 7.4, about interfacing to 16-bit
       C programs, still applies when working in 32 bits. The absence of
       memory models or segmentation worries simplifies things a lot.

 8.1.1 External Symbol Names

       Most 32-bit C compilers share the convention used by 16-bit
       compilers, that the names of all global symbols (functions or data)
       they define are formed by prefixing an underscore to the name as it
       appears in the C program. However, not all of them do: the `ELF'
       specification states that C symbols do _not_ have a leading
       underscore on their assembly-language names.

       The older Linux `a.out' C compiler, all `Win32' compilers, `DJGPP',
       and `NetBSD' and `FreeBSD', all use the leading underscore; for
       these compilers, the macros `cextern' and `cglobal', as given in
       section 7.4.1, will still work. For `ELF', though, the leading
       underscore should not be used.

       See also section 2.1.21.

 8.1.2 Function Definitions and Function Calls

       The C calling conventionThe C calling convention in 32-bit programs
       is as follows. In the following description, the words _caller_ and
       _callee_ are used to denote the function doing the calling and the
       function which gets called.

       (*) The caller pushes the function's parameters on the stack, one
           after another, in reverse order (right to left, so that the
           first argument specified to the function is pushed last).

       (*) The caller then executes a near `CALL' instruction to pass
           control to the callee.

       (*) The callee receives control, and typically (although this is not
           actually necessary, in functions which do not need to access
           their parameters) starts by saving the value of `ESP' in `EBP'
           so as to be able to use `EBP' as a base pointer to find its
           parameters on the stack. However, the caller was probably doing
           this too, so part of the calling convention states that `EBP'
           must be preserved by any C function. Hence the callee, if it is
           going to set up `EBP' as a frame pointer, must push the previous
           value first.

       (*) The callee may then access its parameters relative to `EBP'. The
           doubleword at `[EBP]' holds the previous value of `EBP' as it
           was pushed; the next doubleword, at `[EBP+4]', holds the return
           address, pushed implicitly by `CALL'. The parameters start after
           that, at `[EBP+8]'. The leftmost parameter of the function,
           since it was pushed last, is accessible at this offset from
           `EBP'; the others follow, at successively greater offsets. Thus,
           in a function such as `printf' which takes a variable number of
           parameters, the pushing of the parameters in reverse order means
           that the function knows where to find its first parameter, which
           tells it the number and type of the remaining ones.

       (*) The callee may also wish to decrease `ESP' further, so as to
           allocate space on the stack for local variables, which will then
           be accessible at negative offsets from `EBP'.

       (*) The callee, if it wishes to return a value to the caller, should
           leave the value in `AL', `AX' or `EAX' depending on the size of
           the value. Floating-point results are typically returned in
           `ST0'.

       (*) Once the callee has finished processing, it restores `ESP' from
           `EBP' if it had allocated local stack space, then pops the
           previous value of `EBP', and returns via `RET' (equivalently,
           `RETN').

       (*) When the caller regains control from the callee, the function
           parameters are still on the stack, so it typically adds an
           immediate constant to `ESP' to remove them (instead of executing
           a number of slow `POP' instructions). Thus, if a function is
           accidentally called with the wrong number of parameters due to a
           prototype mismatch, the stack will still be returned to a
           sensible state since the caller, which _knows_ how many
           parameters it pushed, does the removing.

       There is an alternative calling convention used by Win32 programs
       for Windows API calls, and also for functions called _by_ the
       Windows API such as window procedures: they follow what Microsoft
       calls the `__stdcall' convention. This is slightly closer to the
       Pascal convention, in that the callee clears the stack by passing a
       parameter to the `RET' instruction. However, the parameters are
       still pushed in right-to-left order.

       Thus, you would define a function in C style in the following way:

       global  _myfunc 
       
       _myfunc: 
               push    ebp 
               mov     ebp,esp 
               sub     esp,0x40        ; 64 bytes of local stack space 
               mov     ebx,[ebp+8]     ; first parameter to function 
       
               ; some more code 
       
               leave                   ; mov esp,ebp / pop ebp 
               ret

       At the other end of the process, to call a C function from your
       assembly code, you would do something like this:

       extern  _printf 
       
               ; and then, further down... 
       
               push    dword [myint]   ; one of my integer variables 
               push    dword mystring  ; pointer into my data segment 
               call    _printf 
               add     esp,byte 8      ; `byte' saves space 
       
               ; then those data items... 
       
       segment _DATA 
       
       myint       dd   1234 
       mystring    db   'This number -> %d <- should be 1234',10,0

       This piece of code is the assembly equivalent of the C code

           int myint = 1234; 
           printf("This number -> %d <- should be 1234\n", myint);

 8.1.3 Accessing Data Items

       To get at the contents of C variables, or to declare variables which
       C can access, you need only declare the names as `GLOBAL' or
       `EXTERN'. (Again, the names require leading underscores, as stated
       in section 8.1.1.) Thus, a C variable declared as `int i' can be
       accessed from assembler as

                 extern _i 
                 mov eax,[_i]

       And to declare your own integer variable which C programs can access
       as `extern int j', you do this (making sure you are assembling in
       the `_DATA' segment, if necessary):

                 global _j 
       _j        dd 0

       To access a C array, you need to know the size of the components of
       the array. For example, `int' variables are four bytes long, so if a
       C program declares an array as `int a[10]', you can access `a[3]' by
       coding `mov ax,[_a+12]'. (The byte offset 12 is obtained by
       multiplying the desired array index, 3, by the size of the array
       element, 4.) The sizes of the C base types in 32-bit compilers are:
       1 for `char', 2 for `short', 4 for `int', `long' and `float', and 8
       for `double'. Pointers, being 32-bit addresses, are also 4 bytes
       long.

       To access a C data structure, you need to know the offset from the
       base of the structure to the field you are interested in. You can
       either do this by converting the C structure definition into a NASM
       structure definition (using `STRUC'), or by calculating the one
       offset and using just that.

       To do either of these, you should read your C compiler's manual to
       find out how it organises data structures. NASM gives no special
       alignment to structure members in its own `STRUC' macro, so you have
       to specify alignment yourself if the C compiler generates it.
       Typically, you might find that a structure like

       struct { 
           char c; 
           int i; 
       } foo;

       might be eight bytes long rather than five, since the `int' field
       would be aligned to a four-byte boundary. However, this sort of
       feature is sometimes a configurable option in the C compiler, either
       using command-line options or `#pragma' lines, so you have to find
       out how your own compiler does it.

 8.1.4 `c32.mac': Helper Macros for the 32-bit C Interface

       Included in the NASM archives, in the `misc' directory, is a file
       `c32.mac' of macros. It defines three macros: `proc', `arg' and
       `endproc'. These are intended to be used for C-style procedure
       definitions, and they automate a lot of the work involved in keeping
       track of the calling convention.

       An example of an assembly function using the macro set is given
       here:

       proc    _proc32 
       
       %$i     arg 
       %$j     arg 
               mov     eax,[ebp + %$i] 
               mov     ebx,[ebp + %$j] 
               add     eax,[ebx] 
       
       endproc

       This defines `_proc32' to be a procedure taking two arguments, the
       first (`i') an integer and the second (`j') a pointer to an integer.
       It returns `i + *j'.

       Note that the `arg' macro has an `EQU' as the first line of its
       expansion, and since the label before the macro call gets prepended
       to the first line of the expanded macro, the `EQU' works, defining
       `%$i' to be an offset from `BP'. A context-local variable is used,
       local to the context pushed by the `proc' macro and popped by the
       `endproc' macro, so that the same argument name can be used in later
       procedures. Of course, you don't _have_ to do that.

       `arg' can take an optional parameter, giving the size of the
       argument. If no size is given, 4 is assumed, since it is likely that
       many function parameters will be of type `int' or pointers.

   8.2 Writing NetBSD/FreeBSD/OpenBSD and Linux/ELF Shared Libraries

       `ELF' replaced the older `a.out' object file format under Linux
       because it contains support for position-independent code (PIC),
       which makes writing shared libraries much easier. NASM supports the
       `ELF' position-independent code features, so you can write Linux
       `ELF' shared libraries in NASM.

       NetBSD, and its close cousins FreeBSD and OpenBSD, take a different
       approach by hacking PIC support into the `a.out' format. NASM
       supports this as the `aoutb' output format, so you can write BSD
       shared libraries in NASM too.

       The operating system loads a PIC shared library by memory-mapping
       the library file at an arbitrarily chosen point in the address space
       of the running process. The contents of the library's code section
       must therefore not depend on where it is loaded in memory.

       Therefore, you cannot get at your variables by writing code like
       this:

               mov     eax,[myvar]             ; WRONG

       Instead, the linker provides an area of memory called the _global
       offset table_, or GOT; the GOT is situated at a constant distance
       from your library's code, so if you can find out where your library
       is loaded (which is typically done using a `CALL' and `POP'
       combination), you can obtain the address of the GOT, and you can
       then load the addresses of your variables out of linker-generated
       entries in the GOT.

       The _data_ section of a PIC shared library does not have these
       restrictions: since the data section is writable, it has to be
       copied into memory anyway rather than just paged in from the library
       file, so as long as it's being copied it can be relocated too. So
       you can put ordinary types of relocation in the data section without
       too much worry (but see section 8.2.4 for a caveat).

 8.2.1 Obtaining the Address of the GOT

       Each code module in your shared library should define the GOT as an
       external symbol:

       extern  _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_   ; in ELF 
       extern  __GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_  ; in BSD a.out

       At the beginning of any function in your shared library which plans
       to access your data or BSS sections, you must first calculate the
       address of the GOT. This is typically done by writing the function
       in this form:

       func:   push    ebp 
               mov     ebp,esp 
               push    ebx 
               call    .get_GOT 
       .get_GOT: 
               pop     ebx 
               add     ebx,_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_+$$-.get_GOT wrt ..gotpc 
       
               ; the function body comes here 
       
               mov     ebx,[ebp-4] 
               mov     esp,ebp 
               pop     ebp 
               ret

       (For BSD, again, the symbol `_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE' requires a second
       leading underscore.)

       The first two lines of this function are simply the standard C
       prologue to set up a stack frame, and the last three lines are
       standard C function epilogue. The third line, and the fourth to last
       line, save and restore the `EBX' register, because PIC shared
       libraries use this register to store the address of the GOT.

       The interesting bit is the `CALL' instruction and the following two
       lines. The `CALL' and `POP' combination obtains the address of the
       label `.get_GOT', without having to know in advance where the
       program was loaded (since the `CALL' instruction is encoded relative
       to the current position). The `ADD' instruction makes use of one of
       the special PIC relocation types: GOTPC relocation. With the
       `WRT ..gotpc' qualifier specified, the symbol referenced (here
       `_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_', the special symbol assigned to the GOT) is
       given as an offset from the beginning of the section. (Actually,
       `ELF' encodes it as the offset from the operand field of the `ADD'
       instruction, but NASM simplifies this deliberately, so you do things
       the same way for both `ELF' and `BSD'.) So the instruction then
       _adds_ the beginning of the section, to get the real address of the
       GOT, and subtracts the value of `.get_GOT' which it knows is in
       `EBX'. Therefore, by the time that instruction has finished, `EBX'
       contains the address of the GOT.

       If you didn't follow that, don't worry: it's never necessary to
       obtain the address of the GOT by any other means, so you can put
       those three instructions into a macro and safely ignore them:

       %macro  get_GOT 0 
       
               call    %%getgot 
         %%getgot: 
               pop     ebx 
               add     ebx,_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_+$$-%%getgot wrt ..gotpc 
       
       %endmacro

 8.2.2 Finding Your Local Data Items

       Having got the GOT, you can then use it to obtain the addresses of
       your data items. Most variables will reside in the sections you have
       declared; they can be accessed using the `..gotoff' special `WRT'
       type. The way this works is like this:

               lea     eax,[ebx+myvar wrt ..gotoff]

       The expression `myvar wrt ..gotoff' is calculated, when the shared
       library is linked, to be the offset to the local variable `myvar'
       from the beginning of the GOT. Therefore, adding it to `EBX' as
       above will place the real address of `myvar' in `EAX'.

       If you declare variables as `GLOBAL' without specifying a size for
       them, they are shared between code modules in the library, but do
       not get exported from the library to the program that loaded it.
       They will still be in your ordinary data and BSS sections, so you
       can access them in the same way as local variables, using the above
       `..gotoff' mechanism.

       Note that due to a peculiarity of the way BSD `a.out' format handles
       this relocation type, there must be at least one non-local symbol in
       the same section as the address you're trying to access.

 8.2.3 Finding External and Common Data Items

       If your library needs to get at an external variable (external to
       the _library_, not just to one of the modules within it), you must
       use the `..got' type to get at it. The `..got' type, instead of
       giving you the offset from the GOT base to the variable, gives you
       the offset from the GOT base to a GOT _entry_ containing the address
       of the variable. The linker will set up this GOT entry when it
       builds the library, and the dynamic linker will place the correct
       address in it at load time. So to obtain the address of an external
       variable `extvar' in `EAX', you would code

               mov     eax,[ebx+extvar wrt ..got]

       This loads the address of `extvar' out of an entry in the GOT. The
       linker, when it builds the shared library, collects together every
       relocation of type `..got', and builds the GOT so as to ensure it
       has every necessary entry present.

       Common variables must also be accessed in this way.

 8.2.4 Exporting Symbols to the Library User

       If you want to export symbols to the user of the library, you have
       to declare whether they are functions or data, and if they are data,
       you have to give the size of the data item. This is because the
       dynamic linker has to build procedure linkage table entries for any
       exported functions, and also moves exported data items away from the
       library's data section in which they were declared.

       So to export a function to users of the library, you must use

       global  func:function           ; declare it as a function 
       
       func:   push    ebp 
       
               ; etc.

       And to export a data item such as an array, you would have to code

       global  array:data array.end-array      ; give the size too 
       
       array:  resd    128 
       .end:

       Be careful: If you export a variable to the library user, by
       declaring it as `GLOBAL' and supplying a size, the variable will end
       up living in the data section of the main program, rather than in
       your library's data section, where you declared it. So you will have
       to access your own global variable with the `..got' mechanism rather
       than `..gotoff', as if it were external (which, effectively, it has
       become).

       Equally, if you need to store the address of an exported global in
       one of your data sections, you can't do it by means of the standard
       sort of code:

       dataptr:        dd      global_data_item        ; WRONG

       NASM will interpret this code as an ordinary relocation, in which
       `global_data_item' is merely an offset from the beginning of the
       `.data' section (or whatever); so this reference will end up
       pointing at your data section instead of at the exported global
       which resides elsewhere.

       Instead of the above code, then, you must write

       dataptr:        dd      global_data_item wrt ..sym

       which makes use of the special `WRT' type `..sym' to instruct NASM
       to search the symbol table for a particular symbol at that address,
       rather than just relocating by section base.

       Either method will work for functions: referring to one of your
       functions by means of

       funcptr:        dd      my_function

       will give the user the address of the code you wrote, whereas

       funcptr:        dd      my_function wrt .sym

       will give the address of the procedure linkage table for the
       function, which is where the calling program will _believe_ the
       function lives. Either address is a valid way to call the function.

 8.2.5 Calling Procedures Outside the Library

       Calling procedures outside your shared library has to be done by
       means of a _procedure linkage table_, or PLT. The PLT is placed at a
       known offset from where the library is loaded, so the library code
       can make calls to the PLT in a position-independent way. Within the
       PLT there is code to jump to offsets contained in the GOT, so
       function calls to other shared libraries or to routines in the main
       program can be transparently passed off to their real destinations.

       To call an external routine, you must use another special PIC
       relocation type, `WRT ..plt'. This is much easier than the GOT-based
       ones: you simply replace calls such as `CALL printf' with the PLT-
       relative version `CALL printf WRT ..plt'.

 8.2.6 Generating the Library File

       Having written some code modules and assembled them to `.o' files,
       you then generate your shared library with a command such as

       ld -shared -o library.so module1.o module2.o       # for ELF 
       ld -Bshareable -o library.so module1.o module2.o   # for BSD

       For ELF, if your shared library is going to reside in system
       directories such as `/usr/lib' or `/lib', it is usually worth using
       the `-soname' flag to the linker, to store the final library file
       name, with a version number, into the library:

       ld -shared -soname library.so.1 -o library.so.1.2 *.o

       You would then copy `library.so.1.2' into the library directory, and
       create `library.so.1' as a symbolic link to it.

Chapter 9: Mixing 16 and 32 Bit Code
------------------------------------

       This chapter tries to cover some of the issues, largely related to
       unusual forms of addressing and jump instructions, encountered when
       writing operating system code such as protected-mode initialisation
       routines, which require code that operates in mixed segment sizes,
       such as code in a 16-bit segment trying to modify data in a 32-bit
       one, or jumps between different-size segments.

   9.1 Mixed-Size Jumps

       The most common form of mixed-size instruction is the one used when
       writing a 32-bit OS: having done your setup in 16-bit mode, such as
       loading the kernel, you then have to boot it by switching into
       protected mode and jumping to the 32-bit kernel start address. In a
       fully 32-bit OS, this tends to be the _only_ mixed-size instruction
       you need, since everything before it can be done in pure 16-bit
       code, and everything after it can be pure 32-bit.

       This jump must specify a 48-bit far address, since the target
       segment is a 32-bit one. However, it must be assembled in a 16-bit
       segment, so just coding, for example,

               jmp     0x1234:0x56789ABC       ; wrong!

       will not work, since the offset part of the address will be
       truncated to `0x9ABC' and the jump will be an ordinary 16-bit far
       one.

       The Linux kernel setup code gets round the inability of `as86' to
       generate the required instruction by coding it manually, using `DB'
       instructions. NASM can go one better than that, by actually
       generating the right instruction itself. Here's how to do it right:

               jmp     dword 0x1234:0x56789ABC         ; right

       The `DWORD' prefix (strictly speaking, it should come _after_ the
       colon, since it is declaring the _offset_ field to be a doubleword;
       but NASM will accept either form, since both are unambiguous) forces
       the offset part to be treated as far, in the assumption that you are
       deliberately writing a jump from a 16-bit segment to a 32-bit one.

       You can do the reverse operation, jumping from a 32-bit segment to a
       16-bit one, by means of the `WORD' prefix:

               jmp     word 0x8765:0x4321      ; 32 to 16 bit

       If the `WORD' prefix is specified in 16-bit mode, or the `DWORD'
       prefix in 32-bit mode, they will be ignored, since each is
       explicitly forcing NASM into a mode it was in anyway.

   9.2 Addressing Between Different-Size Segments

       If your OS is mixed 16 and 32-bit, or if you are writing a DOS
       extender, you are likely to have to deal with some 16-bit segments
       and some 32-bit ones. At some point, you will probably end up
       writing code in a 16-bit segment which has to access data in a 32-
       bit segment, or vice versa.

       If the data you are trying to access in a 32-bit segment lies within
       the first 64K of the segment, you may be able to get away with using
       an ordinary 16-bit addressing operation for the purpose; but sooner
       or later, you will want to do 32-bit addressing from 16-bit mode.

       The easiest way to do this is to make sure you use a register for
       the address, since any effective address containing a 32-bit
       register is forced to be a 32-bit address. So you can do

               mov     eax,offset_into_32_bit_segment_specified_by_fs 
               mov     dword [fs:eax],0x11223344

       This is fine, but slightly cumbersome (since it wastes an
       instruction and a register) if you already know the precise offset
       you are aiming at. The x86 architecture does allow 32-bit effective
       addresses to specify nothing but a 4-byte offset, so why shouldn't
       NASM be able to generate the best instruction for the purpose?

       It can. As in section 9.1, you need only prefix the address with the
       `DWORD' keyword, and it will be forced to be a 32-bit address:

               mov     dword [fs:dword my_offset],0x11223344

       Also as in section 9.1, NASM is not fussy about whether the `DWORD'
       prefix comes before or after the segment override, so arguably a
       nicer-looking way to code the above instruction is

               mov     dword [dword fs:my_offset],0x11223344

       Don't confuse the `DWORD' prefix _outside_ the square brackets,
       which controls the size of the data stored at the address, with the
       one `inside' the square brackets which controls the length of the
       address itself. The two can quite easily be different:

               mov     word [dword 0x12345678],0x9ABC

       This moves 16 bits of data to an address specified by a 32-bit
       offset.

       You can also specify `WORD' or `DWORD' prefixes along with the `FAR'
       prefix to indirect far jumps or calls. For example:

               call    dword far [fs:word 0x4321]

       This instruction contains an address specified by a 16-bit offset;
       it loads a 48-bit far pointer from that (16-bit segment and 32-bit
       offset), and calls that address.

   9.3 Other Mixed-Size Instructions

       The other way you might want to access data might be using the
       string instructions (`LODSx', `STOSx' and so on) or the `XLATB'
       instruction. These instructions, since they take no parameters,
       might seem to have no easy way to make them perform 32-bit
       addressing when assembled in a 16-bit segment.

       This is the purpose of NASM's `a16' and `a32' prefixes. If you are
       coding `LODSB' in a 16-bit segment but it is supposed to be
       accessing a string in a 32-bit segment, you should load the desired
       address into `ESI' and then code

               a32     lodsb

       The prefix forces the addressing size to 32 bits, meaning that
       `LODSB' loads from `[DS:ESI]' instead of `[DS:SI]'. To access a
       string in a 16-bit segment when coding in a 32-bit one, the
       corresponding `a16' prefix can be used.

       The `a16' and `a32' prefixes can be applied to any instruction in
       NASM's instruction table, but most of them can generate all the
       useful forms without them. The prefixes are necessary only for
       instructions with implicit addressing: `CMPSx' (section B.4.27),
       `SCASx' (section B.4.286), `LODSx' (section B.4.141), `STOSx'
       (section B.4.303), `MOVSx' (section B.4.178), `INSx' (section
       B.4.121), `OUTSx' (section B.4.195), and `XLATB' (section B.4.334).
       Also, the various push and pop instructions (`PUSHA' and `POPF' as
       well as the more usual `PUSH' and `POP') can accept `a16' or `a32'
       prefixes to force a particular one of `SP' or `ESP' to be used as a
       stack pointer, in case the stack segment in use is a different size
       from the code segment.

       `PUSH' and `POP', when applied to segment registers in 32-bit mode,
       also have the slightly odd behaviour that they push and pop 4 bytes
       at a time, of which the top two are ignored and the bottom two give
       the value of the segment register being manipulated. To force the
       16-bit behaviour of segment-register push and pop instructions, you
       can use the operand-size prefix `o16':

               o16 push    ss 
               o16 push    ds

       This code saves a doubleword of stack space by fitting two segment
       registers into the space which would normally be consumed by pushing
       one.

       (You can also use the `o32' prefix to force the 32-bit behaviour
       when in 16-bit mode, but this seems less useful.)

Chapter 10: Troubleshooting
---------------------------

       This chapter describes some of the common problems that users have
       been known to encounter with NASM, and answers them. It also gives
       instructions for reporting bugs in NASM if you find a difficulty
       that isn't listed here.

  10.1 Common Problems

10.1.1 NASM Generates Inefficient Code

       We sometimes get `bug' reports about NASM generating inefficient, or
       even `wrong', code on instructions such as `ADD ESP,8'. This is a
       deliberate design feature, connected to predictability of output:
       NASM, on seeing `ADD ESP,8', will generate the form of the
       instruction which leaves room for a 32-bit offset. You need to code
       `ADD ESP,BYTE 8' if you want the space-efficient form of the
       instruction. This isn't a bug, it's user error: if you prefer to
       have NASM produce the more efficient code automatically enable
       optimization with the `-On' option (see section 2.1.16).

10.1.2 My Jumps are Out of Range

       Similarly, people complain that when they issue conditional jumps
       (which are `SHORT' by default) that try to jump too far, NASM
       reports `short jump out of range' instead of making the jumps
       longer.

       This, again, is partly a predictability issue, but in fact has a
       more practical reason as well. NASM has no means of being told what
       type of processor the code it is generating will be run on; so it
       cannot decide for itself that it should generate `Jcc NEAR' type
       instructions, because it doesn't know that it's working for a 386 or
       above. Alternatively, it could replace the out-of-range short `JNE'
       instruction with a very short `JE' instruction that jumps over a
       `JMP NEAR'; this is a sensible solution for processors below a 386,
       but hardly efficient on processors which have good branch prediction
       _and_ could have used `JNE NEAR' instead. So, once again, it's up to
       the user, not the assembler, to decide what instructions should be
       generated. See section 2.1.16.

10.1.3 `ORG' Doesn't Work

       People writing boot sector programs in the `bin' format often
       complain that `ORG' doesn't work the way they'd like: in order to
       place the `0xAA55' signature word at the end of a 512-byte boot
       sector, people who are used to MASM tend to code

               ORG 0 
       
               ; some boot sector code 
       
               ORG 510 
               DW 0xAA55

       This is not the intended use of the `ORG' directive in NASM, and
       will not work. The correct way to solve this problem in NASM is to
       use the `TIMES' directive, like this:

               ORG 0 
       
               ; some boot sector code 
       
               TIMES 510-($-$$) DB 0 
               DW 0xAA55

       The `TIMES' directive will insert exactly enough zero bytes into the
       output to move the assembly point up to 510. This method also has
       the advantage that if you accidentally fill your boot sector too
       full, NASM will catch the problem at assembly time and report it, so
       you won't end up with a boot sector that you have to disassemble to
       find out what's wrong with it.

10.1.4 `TIMES' Doesn't Work

       The other common problem with the above code is people who write the
       `TIMES' line as

               TIMES 510-$ DB 0

       by reasoning that `$' should be a pure number, just like 510, so the
       difference between them is also a pure number and can happily be fed
       to `TIMES'.

       NASM is a _modular_ assembler: the various component parts are
       designed to be easily separable for re-use, so they don't exchange
       information unnecessarily. In consequence, the `bin' output format,
       even though it has been told by the `ORG' directive that the `.text'
       section should start at 0, does not pass that information back to
       the expression evaluator. So from the evaluator's point of view, `$'
       isn't a pure number: it's an offset from a section base. Therefore
       the difference between `$' and 510 is also not a pure number, but
       involves a section base. Values involving section bases cannot be
       passed as arguments to `TIMES'.

       The solution, as in the previous section, is to code the `TIMES'
       line in the form

               TIMES 510-($-$$) DB 0

       in which `$' and `$$' are offsets from the same section base, and so
       their difference is a pure number. This will solve the problem and
       generate sensible code.

  10.2 Bugs

       We have never yet released a version of NASM with any _known_ bugs.
       That doesn't usually stop there being plenty we didn't know about,
       though. Any that you find should be reported firstly via the
       `bugtracker' at `https://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm/' (click on
       "Bugs"), or if that fails then through one of the contacts in
       section 1.2.

       Please read section 2.2 first, and don't report the bug if it's
       listed in there as a deliberate feature. (If you think the feature
       is badly thought out, feel free to send us reasons why you think it
       should be changed, but don't just send us mail saying `This is a
       bug' if the documentation says we did it on purpose.) Then read
       section 10.1, and don't bother reporting the bug if it's listed
       there.

       If you do report a bug, _please_ give us all of the following
       information:

       (*) What operating system you're running NASM under. DOS, Linux,
           NetBSD, Win16, Win32, VMS (I'd be impressed), whatever.

       (*) If you're running NASM under DOS or Win32, tell us whether
           you've compiled your own executable from the DOS source archive,
           or whether you were using the standard distribution binaries out
           of the archive. If you were using a locally built executable,
           try to reproduce the problem using one of the standard binaries,
           as this will make it easier for us to reproduce your problem
           prior to fixing it.

       (*) Which version of NASM you're using, and exactly how you invoked
           it. Give us the precise command line, and the contents of the
           `NASMENV' environment variable if any.

       (*) Which versions of any supplementary programs you're using, and
           how you invoked them. If the problem only becomes visible at
           link time, tell us what linker you're using, what version of it
           you've got, and the exact linker command line. If the problem
           involves linking against object files generated by a compiler,
           tell us what compiler, what version, and what command line or
           options you used. (If you're compiling in an IDE, please try to
           reproduce the problem with the command-line version of the
           compiler.)

       (*) If at all possible, send us a NASM source file which exhibits
           the problem. If this causes copyright problems (e.g. you can
           only reproduce the bug in restricted-distribution code) then
           bear in mind the following two points: firstly, we guarantee
           that any source code sent to us for the purposes of debugging
           NASM will be used _only_ for the purposes of debugging NASM, and
           that we will delete all our copies of it as soon as we have
           found and fixed the bug or bugs in question; and secondly, we
           would prefer _not_ to be mailed large chunks of code anyway. The
           smaller the file, the better. A three-line sample file that does
           nothing useful _except_ demonstrate the problem is much easier
           to work with than a fully fledged ten-thousand-line program. (Of
           course, some errors _do_ only crop up in large files, so this
           may not be possible.)

       (*) A description of what the problem actually _is_. `It doesn't
           work' is _not_ a helpful description! Please describe exactly
           what is happening that shouldn't be, or what isn't happening
           that should. Examples might be: `NASM generates an error message
           saying Line 3 for an error that's actually on Line 5'; `NASM
           generates an error message that I believe it shouldn't be
           generating at all'; `NASM fails to generate an error message
           that I believe it _should_ be generating'; `the object file
           produced from this source code crashes my linker'; `the ninth
           byte of the output file is 66 and I think it should be 77
           instead'.

       (*) If you believe the output file from NASM to be faulty, send it
           to us. That allows us to determine whether our own copy of NASM
           generates the same file, or whether the problem is related to
           portability issues between our development platforms and yours.
           We can handle binary files mailed to us as MIME attachments,
           uuencoded, and even BinHex. Alternatively, we may be able to
           provide an FTP site you can upload the suspect files to; but
           mailing them is easier for us.

       (*) Any other information or data files that might be helpful. If,
           for example, the problem involves NASM failing to generate an
           object file while TASM can generate an equivalent file without
           trouble, then send us _both_ object files, so we can see what
           TASM is doing differently from us.

Appendix A: Ndisasm
-------------------

       The Netwide Disassembler, NDISASM

   A.1 Introduction

       The Netwide Disassembler is a small companion program to the Netwide
       Assembler, NASM. It seemed a shame to have an x86 assembler,
       complete with a full instruction table, and not make as much use of
       it as possible, so here's a disassembler which shares the
       instruction table (and some other bits of code) with NASM.

       The Netwide Disassembler does nothing except to produce
       disassemblies of _binary_ source files. NDISASM does not have any
       understanding of object file formats, like `objdump', and it will
       not understand `DOS .EXE' files like `debug' will. It just
       disassembles.

   A.2 Getting Started: Installation

       See section 1.3 for installation instructions. NDISASM, like NASM,
       has a `man page' which you may want to put somewhere useful, if you
       are on a Unix system.

   A.3 Running NDISASM

       To disassemble a file, you will typically use a command of the form

              ndisasm [-b16 | -b32] filename

       NDISASM can disassemble 16-bit code or 32-bit code equally easily,
       provided of course that you remember to specify which it is to work
       with. If no `-b' switch is present, NDISASM works in 16-bit mode by
       default. The `-u' switch (for USE32) also invokes 32-bit mode.

       Two more command line options are `-r' which reports the version
       number of NDISASM you are running, and `-h' which gives a short
       summary of command line options.

 A.3.1 COM Files: Specifying an Origin

       To disassemble a `DOS .COM' file correctly, a disassembler must
       assume that the first instruction in the file is loaded at address
       `0x100', rather than at zero. NDISASM, which assumes by default that
       any file you give it is loaded at zero, will therefore need to be
       informed of this.

       The `-o' option allows you to declare a different origin for the
       file you are disassembling. Its argument may be expressed in any of
       the NASM numeric formats: decimal by default, if it begins with
       ``$'' or ``0x'' or ends in ``H'' it's `hex', if it ends in ``Q''
       it's `octal', and if it ends in ``B'' it's `binary'.

       Hence, to disassemble a `.COM' file:

              ndisasm -o100h filename.com

       will do the trick.

 A.3.2 Code Following Data: Synchronisation

       Suppose you are disassembling a file which contains some data which
       isn't machine code, and _then_ contains some machine code. NDISASM
       will faithfully plough through the data section, producing machine
       instructions wherever it can (although most of them will look
       bizarre, and some may have unusual prefixes, e.g.
       ``FS OR AX,0x240A''), and generating `DB' instructions ever so often
       if it's totally stumped. Then it will reach the code section.

       Supposing NDISASM has just finished generating a strange machine
       instruction from part of the data section, and its file position is
       now one byte _before_ the beginning of the code section. It's
       entirely possible that another spurious instruction will get
       generated, starting with the final byte of the data section, and
       then the correct first instruction in the code section will not be
       seen because the starting point skipped over it. This isn't really
       ideal.

       To avoid this, you can specify a ``synchronisation'' point, or
       indeed as many synchronisation points as you like (although NDISASM
       can only handle 8192 sync points internally). The definition of a
       sync point is this: NDISASM guarantees to hit sync points exactly
       during disassembly. If it is thinking about generating an
       instruction which would cause it to jump over a sync point, it will
       discard that instruction and output a ``db'' instead. So it _will_
       start disassembly exactly from the sync point, and so you _will_ see
       all the instructions in your code section.

       Sync points are specified using the `-s' option: they are measured
       in terms of the program origin, not the file position. So if you
       want to synchronise after 32 bytes of a `.COM' file, you would have
       to do

              ndisasm -o100h -s120h file.com

       rather than

              ndisasm -o100h -s20h file.com

       As stated above, you can specify multiple sync markers if you need
       to, just by repeating the `-s' option.

 A.3.3 Mixed Code and Data: Automatic (Intelligent) Synchronisation 

       Suppose you are disassembling the boot sector of a `DOS' floppy
       (maybe it has a virus, and you need to understand the virus so that
       you know what kinds of damage it might have done you). Typically,
       this will contain a `JMP' instruction, then some data, then the rest
       of the code. So there is a very good chance of NDISASM being
       _misaligned_ when the data ends and the code begins. Hence a sync
       point is needed.

       On the other hand, why should you have to specify the sync point
       manually? What you'd do in order to find where the sync point would
       be, surely, would be to read the `JMP' instruction, and then to use
       its target address as a sync point. So can NDISASM do that for you?

       The answer, of course, is yes: using either of the synonymous
       switches `-a' (for automatic sync) or `-i' (for intelligent sync)
       will enable `auto-sync' mode. Auto-sync mode automatically generates
       a sync point for any forward-referring PC-relative jump or call
       instruction that NDISASM encounters. (Since NDISASM is one-pass, if
       it encounters a PC-relative jump whose target has already been
       processed, there isn't much it can do about it...)

       Only PC-relative jumps are processed, since an absolute jump is
       either through a register (in which case NDISASM doesn't know what
       the register contains) or involves a segment address (in which case
       the target code isn't in the same segment that NDISASM is working
       in, and so the sync point can't be placed anywhere useful).

       For some kinds of file, this mechanism will automatically put sync
       points in all the right places, and save you from having to place
       any sync points manually. However, it should be stressed that auto-
       sync mode is _not_ guaranteed to catch all the sync points, and you
       may still have to place some manually.

       Auto-sync mode doesn't prevent you from declaring manual sync
       points: it just adds automatically generated ones to the ones you
       provide. It's perfectly feasible to specify `-i' _and_ some `-s'
       options.

       Another caveat with auto-sync mode is that if, by some unpleasant
       fluke, something in your data section should disassemble to a PC-
       relative call or jump instruction, NDISASM may obediently place a
       sync point in a totally random place, for example in the middle of
       one of the instructions in your code section. So you may end up with
       a wrong disassembly even if you use auto-sync. Again, there isn't
       much I can do about this. If you have problems, you'll have to use
       manual sync points, or use the `-k' option (documented below) to
       suppress disassembly of the data area.

 A.3.4 Other Options

       The `-e' option skips a header on the file, by ignoring the first N
       bytes. This means that the header is _not_ counted towards the
       disassembly offset: if you give `-e10 -o10', disassembly will start
       at byte 10 in the file, and this will be given offset 10, not 20.

       The `-k' option is provided with two comma-separated numeric
       arguments, the first of which is an assembly offset and the second
       is a number of bytes to skip. This _will_ count the skipped bytes
       towards the assembly offset: its use is to suppress disassembly of a
       data section which wouldn't contain anything you wanted to see
       anyway.

   A.4 Bugs and Improvements

       There are no known bugs. However, any you find, with patches if
       possible, should be sent to `jules@dsf.org.uk' or
       `anakin@pobox.com', or to the developer's site at
       `https://sourceforge.net/projects/nasm/' and we'll try to fix them.
       Feel free to send contributions and new features as well.

       Future plans include awareness of which processors certain
       instructions will run on, and marking of instructions that are too
       advanced for some processor (or are `FPU' instructions, or are
       undocumented opcodes, or are privileged protected-mode instructions,
       or whatever).

       That's All Folks!

       I hope NDISASM is of some use to somebody. Including me. :-)

       I don't recommend taking NDISASM apart to see how an efficient
       disassembler works, because as far as I know, it isn't an efficient
       one anyway. You have been warned.

Appendix B: x86 Instruction Reference
-------------------------------------

       This appendix provides a complete list of the machine instructions
       which NASM will assemble, and a short description of the function of
       each one.

       It is not intended to be exhaustive documentation on the fine
       details of the instructions' function, such as which exceptions they
       can trigger: for such documentation, you should go to Intel's Web
       site, `http://developer.intel.com/design/Pentium4/manuals/'.

       Instead, this appendix is intended primarily to provide
       documentation on the way the instructions may be used within NASM.
       For example, looking up `LOOP' will tell you that NASM allows `CX'
       or `ECX' to be specified as an optional second argument to the
       `LOOP' instruction, to enforce which of the two possible counter
       registers should be used if the default is not the one desired.

       The instructions are not quite listed in alphabetical order, since
       groups of instructions with similar functions are lumped together in
       the same entry. Most of them don't move very far from their
       alphabetic position because of this.

   B.1 Key to Operand Specifications

       The instruction descriptions in this appendix specify their operands
       using the following notation:

       (*) Registers: `reg8' denotes an 8-bit general purpose register,
           `reg16' denotes a 16-bit general purpose register, and `reg32' a
           32-bit one. `fpureg' denotes one of the eight FPU stack
           registers, `mmxreg' denotes one of the eight 64-bit MMX
           registers, and `segreg' denotes a segment register. In addition,
           some registers (such as `AL', `DX' or `ECX') may be specified
           explicitly.

       (*) Immediate operands: `imm' denotes a generic immediate operand.
           `imm8', `imm16' and `imm32' are used when the operand is
           intended to be a specific size. For some of these instructions,
           NASM needs an explicit specifier: for example, `ADD ESP,16'
           could be interpreted as either `ADD r/m32,imm32' or
           `ADD r/m32,imm8'. NASM chooses the former by default, and so you
           must specify `ADD ESP,BYTE 16' for the latter.

       (*) Memory references: `mem' denotes a generic memory reference;
           `mem8', `mem16', `mem32', `mem64' and `mem80' are used when the
           operand needs to be a specific size. Again, a specifier is
           needed in some cases: `DEC [address]' is ambiguous and will be
           rejected by NASM. You must specify `DEC BYTE [address]',
           `DEC WORD [address]' or `DEC DWORD [address]' instead.

       (*) Restricted memory references: one form of the `MOV' instruction
           allows a memory address to be specified _without_ allowing the
           normal range of register combinations and effective address
           processing. This is denoted by `memoffs8', `memoffs16' and
           `memoffs32'.

       (*) Register or memory choices: many instructions can accept either
           a register _or_ a memory reference as an operand. `r/m8' is a
           shorthand for `reg8/mem8'; similarly `r/m16' and `r/m32'.
           `r/m64' is MMX-related, and is a shorthand for `mmxreg/mem64'.

   B.2 Key to Opcode Descriptions

       This appendix also provides the opcodes which NASM will generate for
       each form of each instruction. The opcodes are listed in the
       following way:

       (*) A hex number, such as `3F', indicates a fixed byte containing
           that number.

       (*) A hex number followed by `+r', such as `C8+r', indicates that
           one of the operands to the instruction is a register, and the
           `register value' of that register should be added to the hex
           number to produce the generated byte. For example, EDX has
           register value 2, so the code `C8+r', when the register operand
           is EDX, generates the hex byte `CA'. Register values for
           specific registers are given in section B.2.1.

       (*) A hex number followed by `+cc', such as `40+cc', indicates that
           the instruction name has a condition code suffix, and the
           numeric representation of the condition code should be added to
           the hex number to produce the generated byte. For example, the
           code `40+cc', when the instruction contains the `NE' condition,
           generates the hex byte `45'. Condition codes and their numeric
           representations are given in section B.2.2.

       (*) A slash followed by a digit, such as `/2', indicates that one of
           the operands to the instruction is a memory address or register
           (denoted `mem' or `r/m', with an optional size). This is to be
           encoded as an effective address, with a ModR/M byte, an optional
           SIB byte, and an optional displacement, and the spare (register)
           field of the ModR/M byte should be the digit given (which will
           be from 0 to 7, so it fits in three bits). The encoding of
           effective addresses is given in section B.2.5.

       (*) The code `/r' combines the above two: it indicates that one of
           the operands is a memory address or `r/m', and another is a
           register, and that an effective address should be generated with
           the spare (register) field in the ModR/M byte being equal to the
           `register value' of the register operand. The encoding of
           effective addresses is given in section B.2.5; register values
           are given in section B.2.1.

       (*) The codes `ib', `iw' and `id' indicate that one of the operands
           to the instruction is an immediate value, and that this is to be
           encoded as a byte, little-endian word or little-endian
           doubleword respectively.

       (*) The codes `rb', `rw' and `rd' indicate that one of the operands
           to the instruction is an immediate value, and that the
           _difference_ between this value and the address of the end of
           the instruction is to be encoded as a byte, word or doubleword
           respectively. Where the form `rw/rd' appears, it indicates that
           either `rw' or `rd' should be used according to whether assembly
           is being performed in `BITS 16' or `BITS 32' state respectively.

       (*) The codes `ow' and `od' indicate that one of the operands to the
           instruction is a reference to the contents of a memory address
           specified as an immediate value: this encoding is used in some
           forms of the `MOV' instruction in place of the standard
           effective-address mechanism. The displacement is encoded as a
           word or doubleword. Again, `ow/od' denotes that `ow' or `od'
           should be chosen according to the `BITS' setting.

       (*) The codes `o16' and `o32' indicate that the given form of the
           instruction should be assembled with operand size 16 or 32 bits.
           In other words, `o16' indicates a `66' prefix in `BITS 32'
           state, but generates no code in `BITS 16' state; and `o32'
           indicates a `66' prefix in `BITS 16' state but generates nothing
           in `BITS 32'.

       (*) The codes `a16' and `a32', similarly to `o16' and `o32',
           indicate the address size of the given form of the instruction.
           Where this does not match the `BITS' setting, a `67' prefix is
           required.

 B.2.1 Register Values

       Where an instruction requires a register value, it is already
       implicit in the encoding of the rest of the instruction what type of
       register is intended: an 8-bit general-purpose register, a segment
       register, a debug register, an MMX register, or whatever. Therefore
       there is no problem with registers of different types sharing an
       encoding value.

       The encodings for the various classes of register are:

       (*) 8-bit general registers: `AL' is 0, `CL' is 1, `DL' is 2, `BL'
           is 3, `AH' is 4, `CH' is 5, `DH' is 6, and `BH' is 7.

       (*) 16-bit general registers: `AX' is 0, `CX' is 1, `DX' is 2, `BX'
           is 3, `SP' is 4, `BP' is 5, `SI' is 6, and `DI' is 7.

       (*) 32-bit general registers: `EAX' is 0, `ECX' is 1, `EDX' is 2,
           `EBX' is 3, `ESP' is 4, `EBP' is 5, `ESI' is 6, and `EDI' is 7.

       (*) Segment registers: `ES' is 0, `CS' is 1, `SS' is 2, `DS' is 3,
           `FS' is 4, and `GS' is 5.

       (*) Floating-point registers: `ST0' is 0, `ST1' is 1, `ST2' is 2,
           `ST3' is 3, `ST4' is 4, `ST5' is 5, `ST6' is 6, and `ST7' is 7.

       (*) 64-bit MMX registers: `MM0' is 0, `MM1' is 1, `MM2' is 2, `MM3'
           is 3, `MM4' is 4, `MM5' is 5, `MM6' is 6, and `MM7' is 7.

       (*) Control registers: `CR0' is 0, `CR2' is 2, `CR3' is 3, and `CR4'
           is 4.

       (*) Debug registers: `DR0' is 0, `DR1' is 1, `DR2' is 2, `DR3' is 3,
           `DR6' is 6, and `DR7' is 7.

       (*) Test registers: `TR3' is 3, `TR4' is 4, `TR5' is 5, `TR6' is 6,
           and `TR7' is 7.

       (Note that wherever a register name contains a number, that number
       is also the register value for that register.)

 B.2.2 Condition Codes

       The available condition codes are given here, along with their
       numeric representations as part of opcodes. Many of these condition
       codes have synonyms, so several will be listed at a time.

       In the following descriptions, the word `either', when applied to
       two possible trigger conditions, is used to mean `either or both'.
       If `either but not both' is meant, the phrase `exactly one of' is
       used.

       (*) `O' is 0 (trigger if the overflow flag is set); `NO' is 1.

       (*) `B', `C' and `NAE' are 2 (trigger if the carry flag is set);
           `AE', `NB' and `NC' are 3.

       (*) `E' and `Z' are 4 (trigger if the zero flag is set); `NE' and
           `NZ' are 5.

       (*) `BE' and `NA' are 6 (trigger if either of the carry or zero
           flags is set); `A' and `NBE' are 7.

       (*) `S' is 8 (trigger if the sign flag is set); `NS' is 9.

       (*) `P' and `PE' are 10 (trigger if the parity flag is set); `NP'
           and `PO' are 11.

       (*) `L' and `NGE' are 12 (trigger if exactly one of the sign and
           overflow flags is set); `GE' and `NL' are 13.

       (*) `LE' and `NG' are 14 (trigger if either the zero flag is set, or
           exactly one of the sign and overflow flags is set); `G' and
           `NLE' are 15.

       Note that in all cases, the sense of a condition code may be
       reversed by changing the low bit of the numeric representation.

       For details of when an instruction sets each of the status flags,
       see the individual instruction, plus the Status Flags reference in
       section B.2.4

 B.2.3 SSE Condition Predicates

       The condition predicates for SSE comparison instructions are the
       codes used as part of the opcode, to determine what form of
       comparison is being carried out. In each case, the imm8 value is the
       final byte of the opcode encoding, and the predicate is the code
       used as part of the mnemonic for the instruction (equivalent to the
       "cc" in an integer instruction that used a condition code). The
       instructions that use this will give details of what the various
       mnemonics are, this table is used to help you work out details of
       what is happening.

       Predi-  imm8  Description Relation where:   Emula- Result   QNaN 
        cate  Encod-             A Is 1st Operand  tion   if NaN   Signal 
               ing               B Is 2nd Operand         Operand  Invalid 
       
       EQ     000B   equal       A = B                    False     No 
       
       LT     001B   less-than   A < B                    False     Yes 
       
       LE     010B   less-than-  A <= B                   False     Yes 
                      or-equal 
       
       ---    ----   greater     A > B             Swap   False     Yes 
                     than                          Operands, 
                                                   Use LT 
       
       ---    ----   greater-    A >= B            Swap   False     Yes 
                     than-or-equal                 Operands, 
                                                   Use LE 
       
       UNORD  011B   unordered   A, B = Unordered         True      No 
       
       NEQ    100B   not-equal   A != B                   True      No 
       
       NLT    101B   not-less-   NOT(A < B)               True      Yes 
                     than 
       
       NLE    110B   not-less-   NOT(A <= B)              True      Yes 
                     than-or- 
                     equal 
       
       ---    ----   not-greater NOT(A > B)        Swap   True      Yes 
                     than                          Operands, 
                                                   Use NLT 
       
       ---    ----   not-greater NOT(A >= B)       Swap   True      Yes 
                     than-                         Operands, 
                     or-equal                      Use NLE 
       
       ORD    111B   ordered      A , B = Ordered         False     No

       The unordered relationship is true when at least one of the two
       values being compared is a NaN or in an unsupported format.

       Note that the comparisons which are listed as not having a predicate
       or encoding can only be achieved through software emulation, as
       described in the "emulation" column. Note in particular that an
       instruction such as `greater-than' is not the same as `NLE', as,
       unlike with the `CMP' instruction, it has to take into account the
       possibility of one operand containing a NaN or an unsupported
       numeric format.

 B.2.4 Status Flags

       The status flags provide some information about the result of the
       arithmetic instructions. This information can be used by conditional
       instructions (such a `Jcc' and `CMOVcc') as well as by some of the
       other instructions (such as `ADC' and `INTO').

       There are 6 status flags:

       CF - Carry flag.

       Set if an arithmetic operation generates a carry or a borrow out of
       the most-significant bit of the result; cleared otherwise. This flag
       indicates an overflow condition for unsigned-integer arithmetic. It
       is also used in multiple-precision arithmetic.

       PF - Parity flag.

       Set if the least-significant byte of the result contains an even
       number of 1 bits; cleared otherwise.

       AF - Adjust flag.

       Set if an arithmetic operation generates a carry or a borrow out of
       bit 3 of the result; cleared otherwise. This flag is used in binary-
       coded decimal (BCD) arithmetic.

       ZF - Zero flag.

       Set if the result is zero; cleared otherwise.

       SF - Sign flag.

       Set equal to the most-significant bit of the result, which is the
       sign bit of a signed integer. (0 indicates a positive value and 1
       indicates a negative value.)

       OF - Overflow flag.

       Set if the integer result is too large a positive number or too
       small a negative number (excluding the sign-bit) to fit in the
       destination operand; cleared otherwise. This flag indicates an
       overflow condition for signed-integer (two's complement) arithmetic.

 B.2.5 Effective Address Encoding: ModR/M and SIB

       An effective address is encoded in up to three parts: a ModR/M byte,
       an optional SIB byte, and an optional byte, word or doubleword
       displacement field.

       The ModR/M byte consists of three fields: the `mod' field, ranging
       from 0 to 3, in the upper two bits of the byte, the `r/m' field,
       ranging from 0 to 7, in the lower three bits, and the spare
       (register) field in the middle (bit 3 to bit 5). The spare field is
       not relevant to the effective address being encoded, and either
       contains an extension to the instruction opcode or the register
       value of another operand.

       The ModR/M system can be used to encode a direct register reference
       rather than a memory access. This is always done by setting the
       `mod' field to 3 and the `r/m' field to the register value of the
       register in question (it must be a general-purpose register, and the
       size of the register must already be implicit in the encoding of the
       rest of the instruction). In this case, the SIB byte and
       displacement field are both absent.

       In 16-bit addressing mode (either `BITS 16' with no `67' prefix, or
       `BITS 32' with a `67' prefix), the SIB byte is never used. The
       general rules for `mod' and `r/m' (there is an exception, given
       below) are:

       (*) The `mod' field gives the length of the displacement field: 0
           means no displacement, 1 means one byte, and 2 means two bytes.

       (*) The `r/m' field encodes the combination of registers to be added
           to the displacement to give the accessed address: 0 means
           `BX+SI', 1 means `BX+DI', 2 means `BP+SI', 3 means `BP+DI', 4
           means `SI' only, 5 means `DI' only, 6 means `BP' only, and 7
           means `BX' only.

       However, there is a special case:

       (*) If `mod' is 0 and `r/m' is 6, the effective address encoded is
           not `[BP]' as the above rules would suggest, but instead
           `[disp16]': the displacement field is present and is two bytes
           long, and no registers are added to the displacement.

       Therefore the effective address `[BP]' cannot be encoded as
       efficiently as `[BX]'; so if you code `[BP]' in a program, NASM adds
       a notional 8-bit zero displacement, and sets `mod' to 1, `r/m' to 6,
       and the one-byte displacement field to 0.

       In 32-bit addressing mode (either `BITS 16' with a `67' prefix, or
       `BITS 32' with no `67' prefix) the general rules (again, there are
       exceptions) for `mod' and `r/m' are:

       (*) The `mod' field gives the length of the displacement field: 0
           means no displacement, 1 means one byte, and 2 means four bytes.

       (*) If only one register is to be added to the displacement, and it
           is not `ESP', the `r/m' field gives its register value, and the
           SIB byte is absent. If the `r/m' field is 4 (which would encode
           `ESP'), the SIB byte is present and gives the combination and
           scaling of registers to be added to the displacement.

       If the SIB byte is present, it describes the combination of
       registers (an optional base register, and an optional index register
       scaled by multiplication by 1, 2, 4 or 8) to be added to the
       displacement. The SIB byte is divided into the `scale' field, in the
       top two bits, the `index' field in the next three, and the `base'
       field in the bottom three. The general rules are:

       (*) The `base' field encodes the register value of the base
           register.

       (*) The `index' field encodes the register value of the index
           register, unless it is 4, in which case no index register is
           used (so `ESP' cannot be used as an index register).

       (*) The `scale' field encodes the multiplier by which the index
           register is scaled before adding it to the base and
           displacement: 0 encodes a multiplier of 1, 1 encodes 2, 2
           encodes 4 and 3 encodes 8.

       The exceptions to the 32-bit encoding rules are:

       (*) If `mod' is 0 and `r/m' is 5, the effective address encoded is
           not `[EBP]' as the above rules would suggest, but instead
           `[disp32]': the displacement field is present and is four bytes
           long, and no registers are added to the displacement.

       (*) If `mod' is 0, `r/m' is 4 (meaning the SIB byte is present) and
           `base' is 4, the effective address encoded is not `[EBP+index]'
           as the above rules would suggest, but instead `[disp32+index]':
           the displacement field is present and is four bytes long, and
           there is no base register (but the index register is still
           processed in the normal way).

   B.3 Key to Instruction Flags

       Given along with each instruction in this appendix is a set of
       flags, denoting the type of the instruction. The types are as
       follows:

       (*) `8086', `186', `286', `386', `486', `PENT' and `P6' denote the
           lowest processor type that supports the instruction. Most
           instructions run on all processors above the given type; those
           that do not are documented. The Pentium II contains no
           additional instructions beyond the P6 (Pentium Pro); from the
           point of view of its instruction set, it can be thought of as a
           P6 with MMX capability.

       (*) `3DNOW' indicates that the instruction is a 3DNow! one, and will
           run on the AMD K6-2 and later processors. ATHLON extensions to
           the 3DNow! instruction set are documented as such.

       (*) `CYRIX' indicates that the instruction is specific to Cyrix
           processors, for example the extra MMX instructions in the Cyrix
           extended MMX instruction set.

       (*) `FPU' indicates that the instruction is a floating-point one,
           and will only run on machines with a coprocessor (automatically
           including 486DX, Pentium and above).

       (*) `KATMAI' indicates that the instruction was introduced as part
           of the Katmai New Instruction set. These instructions are
           available on the Pentium III and later processors. Those which
           are not specifically SSE instructions are also available on the
           AMD Athlon.

       (*) `MMX' indicates that the instruction is an MMX one, and will run
           on MMX-capable Pentium processors and the Pentium II.

       (*) `PRIV' indicates that the instruction is a protected-mode
           management instruction. Many of these may only be used in
           protected mode, or only at privilege level zero.

       (*) `SSE' and `SSE2' indicate that the instruction is a Streaming
           SIMD Extension instruction. These instructions operate on
           multiple values in a single operation. SSE was introduced with
           the Pentium III and SSE2 was introduced with the Pentium 4.

       (*) `UNDOC' indicates that the instruction is an undocumented one,
           and not part of the official Intel Architecture; it may or may
           not be supported on any given machine.

       (*) `WILLAMETTE' indicates that the instruction was introduced as
           part of the new instruction set in the Pentium 4 and Intel Xeon
           processors. These instructions are also known as SSE2
           instructions.

   B.4 x86 Instruction Set

 B.4.1 `AAA', `AAS', `AAM', `AAD': ASCII Adjustments

       AAA                           ; 37                   [8086]

       AAS                           ; 3F                   [8086]

       AAD                           ; D5 0A                [8086] 
       AAD imm                       ; D5 ib                [8086]

       AAM                           ; D4 0A                [8086] 
       AAM imm                       ; D4 ib                [8086]

       These instructions are used in conjunction with the add, subtract,
       multiply and divide instructions to perform binary-coded decimal
       arithmetic in _unpacked_ (one BCD digit per byte - easy to translate
       to and from `ASCII', hence the instruction names) form. There are
       also packed BCD instructions `DAA' and `DAS': see section B.4.57.

       (*) `AAA' (ASCII Adjust After Addition) should be used after a one-
           byte `ADD' instruction whose destination was the `AL' register:
           by means of examining the value in the low nibble of `AL' and
           also the auxiliary carry flag `AF', it determines whether the
           addition has overflowed, and adjusts it (and sets the carry
           flag) if so. You can add long BCD strings together by doing
           `ADD'/`AAA' on the low digits, then doing `ADC'/`AAA' on each
           subsequent digit.

       (*) `AAS' (ASCII Adjust AL After Subtraction) works similarly to
           `AAA', but is for use after `SUB' instructions rather than
           `ADD'.

       (*) `AAM' (ASCII Adjust AX After Multiply) is for use after you have
           multiplied two decimal digits together and left the result in
           `AL': it divides `AL' by ten and stores the quotient in `AH',
           leaving the remainder in `AL'. The divisor 10 can be changed by
           specifying an operand to the instruction: a particularly handy
           use of this is `AAM 16', causing the two nibbles in `AL' to be
           separated into `AH' and `AL'.

       (*) `AAD' (ASCII Adjust AX Before Division) performs the inverse
           operation to `AAM': it multiplies `AH' by ten, adds it to `AL',
           and sets `AH' to zero. Again, the multiplier 10 can be changed.

 B.4.2 `ADC': Add with Carry

       ADC r/m8,reg8                 ; 10 /r                [8086] 
       ADC r/m16,reg16               ; o16 11 /r            [8086] 
       ADC r/m32,reg32               ; o32 11 /r            [386]

       ADC reg8,r/m8                 ; 12 /r                [8086] 
       ADC reg16,r/m16               ; o16 13 /r            [8086] 
       ADC reg32,r/m32               ; o32 13 /r            [386]

       ADC r/m8,imm8                 ; 80 /2 ib             [8086] 
       ADC r/m16,imm16               ; o16 81 /2 iw         [8086] 
       ADC r/m32,imm32               ; o32 81 /2 id         [386]

       ADC r/m16,imm8                ; o16 83 /2 ib         [8086] 
       ADC r/m32,imm8                ; o32 83 /2 ib         [386]

       ADC AL,imm8                   ; 14 ib                [8086] 
       ADC AX,imm16                  ; o16 15 iw            [8086] 
       ADC EAX,imm32                 ; o32 15 id            [386]

       `ADC' performs integer addition: it adds its two operands together,
       plus the value of the carry flag, and leaves the result in its
       destination (first) operand. The destination operand can be a
       register or a memory location. The source operand can be a register,
       a memory location or an immediate value.

       The flags are set according to the result of the operation: in
       particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used by a
       subsequent `ADC' instruction.

       In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
       first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
       sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
       the `BYTE' qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
       form of the instruction.

       To add two numbers without also adding the contents of the carry
       flag, use `ADD' (section B.4.3).

 B.4.3 `ADD': Add Integers

       ADD r/m8,reg8                 ; 00 /r                [8086] 
       ADD r/m16,reg16               ; o16 01 /r            [8086] 
       ADD r/m32,reg32               ; o32 01 /r            [386]

       ADD reg8,r/m8                 ; 02 /r                [8086] 
       ADD reg16,r/m16               ; o16 03 /r            [8086] 
       ADD reg32,r/m32               ; o32 03 /r            [386]

       ADD r/m8,imm8                 ; 80 /7 ib             [8086] 
       ADD r/m16,imm16               ; o16 81 /7 iw         [8086] 
       ADD r/m32,imm32               ; o32 81 /7 id         [386]

       ADD r/m16,imm8                ; o16 83 /7 ib         [8086] 
       ADD r/m32,imm8                ; o32 83 /7 ib         [386]

       ADD AL,imm8                   ; 04 ib                [8086] 
       ADD AX,imm16                  ; o16 05 iw            [8086] 
       ADD EAX,imm32                 ; o32 05 id            [386]

       `ADD' performs integer addition: it adds its two operands together,
       and leaves the result in its destination (first) operand. The
       destination operand can be a register or a memory location. The
       source operand can be a register, a memory location or an immediate
       value.

       The flags are set according to the result of the operation: in
       particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used by a
       subsequent `ADC' instruction.

       In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
       first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
       sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
       the `BYTE' qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
       form of the instruction.

 B.4.4 `ADDPD': ADD Packed Double-Precision FP Values

       ADDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128        ; 66 0F 58 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `ADDPD' performs addition on each of two packed double-precision FP
       value pairs.

          dst[0-63]   := dst[0-63]   + src[0-63], 
          dst[64-127] := dst[64-127] + src[64-127].

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

 B.4.5 `ADDPS': ADD Packed Single-Precision FP Values

       ADDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128        ; 0F 58 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `ADDPS' performs addition on each of four packed single-precision FP
       value pairs

          dst[0-31]   := dst[0-31]   + src[0-31], 
          dst[32-63]  := dst[32-63]  + src[32-63], 
          dst[64-95]  := dst[64-95]  + src[64-95], 
          dst[96-127] := dst[96-127] + src[96-127].

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

 B.4.6 `ADDSD': ADD Scalar Double-Precision FP Values

       ADDSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64         ; F2 0F 58 /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `ADDSD' adds the low double-precision FP values from the source and
       destination operands and stores the double-precision FP result in
       the destination operand.

          dst[0-63]   := dst[0-63] + src[0-63], 
          dst[64-127) remains unchanged.

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 64-bit memory location.

 B.4.7 `ADDSS': ADD Scalar Single-Precision FP Values

       ADDSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32         ; F3 0F 58 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `ADDSS' adds the low single-precision FP values from the source and
       destination operands and stores the single-precision FP result in
       the destination operand.

          dst[0-31]   := dst[0-31] + src[0-31], 
          dst[32-127] remains unchanged.

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 32-bit memory location.

 B.4.8 `AND': Bitwise AND

       AND r/m8,reg8                 ; 20 /r                [8086] 
       AND r/m16,reg16               ; o16 21 /r            [8086] 
       AND r/m32,reg32               ; o32 21 /r            [386]

       AND reg8,r/m8                 ; 22 /r                [8086] 
       AND reg16,r/m16               ; o16 23 /r            [8086] 
       AND reg32,r/m32               ; o32 23 /r            [386]

       AND r/m8,imm8                 ; 80 /4 ib             [8086] 
       AND r/m16,imm16               ; o16 81 /4 iw         [8086] 
       AND r/m32,imm32               ; o32 81 /4 id         [386]

       AND r/m16,imm8                ; o16 83 /4 ib         [8086] 
       AND r/m32,imm8                ; o32 83 /4 ib         [386]

       AND AL,imm8                   ; 24 ib                [8086] 
       AND AX,imm16                  ; o16 25 iw            [8086] 
       AND EAX,imm32                 ; o32 25 id            [386]

       `AND' performs a bitwise AND operation between its two operands
       (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if the corresponding
       bits of the two inputs were both 1), and stores the result in the
       destination (first) operand. The destination operand can be a
       register or a memory location. The source operand can be a register,
       a memory location or an immediate value.

       In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
       first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
       sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
       the `BYTE' qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
       form of the instruction.

       The `MMX' instruction `PAND' (see section B.4.202) performs the same
       operation on the 64-bit `MMX' registers.

 B.4.9 `ANDNPD': Bitwise Logical AND NOT of Packed Double-Precision FP Values

       ANDNPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128       ; 66 0F 55 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `ANDNPD' inverts the bits of the two double-precision floating-point
       values in the destination register, and then performs a logical AND
       between the two double-precision floating-point values in the source
       operand and the temporary inverted result, storing the result in the
       destination register.

          dst[0-63]   := src[0-63]   AND NOT dst[0-63], 
          dst[64-127] := src[64-127] AND NOT dst[64-127].

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

B.4.10 `ANDNPS': Bitwise Logical AND NOT of Packed Single-Precision FP Values

       ANDNPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128       ; 0F 55 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `ANDNPS' inverts the bits of the four single-precision floating-
       point values in the destination register, and then performs a
       logical AND between the four single-precision floating-point values
       in the source operand and the temporary inverted result, storing the
       result in the destination register.

          dst[0-31]   := src[0-31]   AND NOT dst[0-31], 
          dst[32-63]  := src[32-63]  AND NOT dst[32-63], 
          dst[64-95]  := src[64-95]  AND NOT dst[64-95], 
          dst[96-127] := src[96-127] AND NOT dst[96-127].

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

B.4.11 `ANDPD': Bitwise Logical AND For Single FP

       ANDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128        ; 66 0F 54 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `ANDPD' performs a bitwise logical AND of the two double-precision
       floating point values in the source and destination operand, and
       stores the result in the destination register.

          dst[0-63]   := src[0-63]   AND dst[0-63], 
          dst[64-127] := src[64-127] AND dst[64-127].

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

B.4.12 `ANDPS': Bitwise Logical AND For Single FP

       ANDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128        ; 0F 54 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `ANDPS' performs a bitwise logical AND of the four single-precision
       floating point values in the source and destination operand, and
       stores the result in the destination register.

          dst[0-31]   := src[0-31]   AND dst[0-31], 
          dst[32-63]  := src[32-63]  AND dst[32-63], 
          dst[64-95]  := src[64-95]  AND dst[64-95], 
          dst[96-127] := src[96-127] AND dst[96-127].

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

B.4.13 `ARPL': Adjust RPL Field of Selector

       ARPL r/m16,reg16              ; 63 /r                [286,PRIV]

       `ARPL' expects its two word operands to be segment selectors. It
       adjusts the `RPL' (requested privilege level - stored in the bottom
       two bits of the selector) field of the destination (first) operand
       to ensure that it is no less (i.e. no more privileged than) the
       `RPL' field of the source operand. The zero flag is set if and only
       if a change had to be made.

B.4.14 `BOUND': Check Array Index against Bounds

       BOUND reg16,mem               ; o16 62 /r            [186] 
       BOUND reg32,mem               ; o32 62 /r            [386]

       `BOUND' expects its second operand to point to an area of memory
       containing two signed values of the same size as its first operand
       (i.e. two words for the 16-bit form; two doublewords for the 32-bit
       form). It performs two signed comparisons: if the value in the
       register passed as its first operand is less than the first of the
       in-memory values, or is greater than or equal to the second, it
       throws a `BR' exception. Otherwise, it does nothing.

B.4.15 `BSF', `BSR': Bit Scan

       BSF reg16,r/m16               ; o16 0F BC /r         [386] 
       BSF reg32,r/m32               ; o32 0F BC /r         [386]

       BSR reg16,r/m16               ; o16 0F BD /r         [386] 
       BSR reg32,r/m32               ; o32 0F BD /r         [386]

       (*) `BSF' searches for the least significant set bit in its source
           (second) operand, and if it finds one, stores the index in its
           destination (first) operand. If no set bit is found, the
           contents of the destination operand are undefined. If the source
           operand is zero, the zero flag is set.

       (*) `BSR' performs the same function, but searches from the top
           instead, so it finds the most significant set bit.

       Bit indices are from 0 (least significant) to 15 or 31 (most
       significant). The destination operand can only be a register. The
       source operand can be a register or a memory location.

B.4.16 `BSWAP': Byte Swap

       BSWAP reg32                   ; o32 0F C8+r          [486]

       `BSWAP' swaps the order of the four bytes of a 32-bit register: bits
       0-7 exchange places with bits 24-31, and bits 8-15 swap with bits
       16-23. There is no explicit 16-bit equivalent: to byte-swap `AX',
       `BX', `CX' or `DX', `XCHG' can be used. When `BSWAP' is used with a
       16-bit register, the result is undefined.

B.4.17 `BT', `BTC', `BTR', `BTS': Bit Test

       BT r/m16,reg16                ; o16 0F A3 /r         [386] 
       BT r/m32,reg32                ; o32 0F A3 /r         [386] 
       BT r/m16,imm8                 ; o16 0F BA /4 ib      [386] 
       BT r/m32,imm8                 ; o32 0F BA /4 ib      [386]

       BTC r/m16,reg16               ; o16 0F BB /r         [386] 
       BTC r/m32,reg32               ; o32 0F BB /r         [386] 
       BTC r/m16,imm8                ; o16 0F BA /7 ib      [386] 
       BTC r/m32,imm8                ; o32 0F BA /7 ib      [386]

       BTR r/m16,reg16               ; o16 0F B3 /r         [386] 
       BTR r/m32,reg32               ; o32 0F B3 /r         [386] 
       BTR r/m16,imm8                ; o16 0F BA /6 ib      [386] 
       BTR r/m32,imm8                ; o32 0F BA /6 ib      [386]

       BTS r/m16,reg16               ; o16 0F AB /r         [386] 
       BTS r/m32,reg32               ; o32 0F AB /r         [386] 
       BTS r/m16,imm                 ; o16 0F BA /5 ib      [386] 
       BTS r/m32,imm                 ; o32 0F BA /5 ib      [386]

       These instructions all test one bit of their first operand, whose
       index is given by the second operand, and store the value of that
       bit into the carry flag. Bit indices are from 0 (least significant)
       to 15 or 31 (most significant).

       In addition to storing the original value of the bit into the carry
       flag, `BTR' also resets (clears) the bit in the operand itself.
       `BTS' sets the bit, and `BTC' complements the bit. `BT' does not
       modify its operands.

       The destination can be a register or a memory location. The source
       can be a register or an immediate value.

       If the destination operand is a register, the bit offset should be
       in the range 0-15 (for 16-bit operands) or 0-31 (for 32-bit
       operands). An immediate value outside these ranges will be taken
       modulo 16/32 by the processor.

       If the destination operand is a memory location, then an immediate
       bit offset follows the same rules as for a register. If the bit
       offset is in a register, then it can be anything within the signed
       range of the register used (ie, for a 32-bit operand, it can be (-
       2^31) to (2^31 - 1)

B.4.18 `CALL': Call Subroutine

       CALL imm                      ; E8 rw/rd             [8086] 
       CALL imm:imm16                ; o16 9A iw iw         [8086] 
       CALL imm:imm32                ; o32 9A id iw         [386] 
       CALL FAR mem16                ; o16 FF /3            [8086] 
       CALL FAR mem32                ; o32 FF /3            [386] 
       CALL r/m16                    ; o16 FF /2            [8086] 
       CALL r/m32                    ; o32 FF /2            [386]

       `CALL' calls a subroutine, by means of pushing the current
       instruction pointer (`IP') and optionally `CS' as well on the stack,
       and then jumping to a given address.

       `CS' is pushed as well as `IP' if and only if the call is a far
       call, i.e. a destination segment address is specified in the
       instruction. The forms involving two colon-separated arguments are
       far calls; so are the `CALL FAR mem' forms.

       The immediate near call takes one of two forms (`call imm16/imm32',
       determined by the current segment size limit. For 16-bit operands,
       you would use `CALL 0x1234', and for 32-bit operands you would use
       `CALL 0x12345678'. The value passed as an operand is a relative
       offset.

       You can choose between the two immediate far call forms
       (`CALL imm:imm') by the use of the `WORD' and `DWORD' keywords:
       `CALL WORD 0x1234:0x5678') or `CALL DWORD 0x1234:0x56789abc'.

       The `CALL FAR mem' forms execute a far call by loading the
       destination address out of memory. The address loaded consists of 16
       or 32 bits of offset (depending on the operand size), and 16 bits of
       segment. The operand size may be overridden using
       `CALL WORD FAR mem' or `CALL DWORD FAR mem'.

       The `CALL r/m' forms execute a near call (within the same segment),
       loading the destination address out of memory or out of a register.
       The keyword `NEAR' may be specified, for clarity, in these forms,
       but is not necessary. Again, operand size can be overridden using
       `CALL WORD mem' or `CALL DWORD mem'.

       As a convenience, NASM does not require you to call a far procedure
       symbol by coding the cumbersome `CALL SEG routine:routine', but
       instead allows the easier synonym `CALL FAR routine'.

       The `CALL r/m' forms given above are near calls; NASM will accept
       the `NEAR' keyword (e.g. `CALL NEAR [address]'), even though it is
       not strictly necessary.

B.4.19 `CBW', `CWD', `CDQ', `CWDE': Sign Extensions

       CBW                           ; o16 98               [8086] 
       CWDE                          ; o32 98               [386]

       CWD                           ; o16 99               [8086] 
       CDQ                           ; o32 99               [386]

       All these instructions sign-extend a short value into a longer one,
       by replicating the top bit of the original value to fill the
       extended one.

       `CBW' extends `AL' into `AX' by repeating the top bit of `AL' in
       every bit of `AH'. `CWDE' extends `AX' into `EAX'. `CWD' extends
       `AX' into `DX:AX' by repeating the top bit of `AX' throughout `DX',
       and `CDQ' extends `EAX' into `EDX:EAX'.

B.4.20 `CLC', `CLD', `CLI', `CLTS': Clear Flags

       CLC                           ; F8                   [8086] 
       CLD                           ; FC                   [8086] 
       CLI                           ; FA                   [8086] 
       CLTS                          ; 0F 06                [286,PRIV]

       These instructions clear various flags. `CLC' clears the carry flag;
       `CLD' clears the direction flag; `CLI' clears the interrupt flag
       (thus disabling interrupts); and `CLTS' clears the task-switched
       (`TS') flag in `CR0'.

       To set the carry, direction, or interrupt flags, use the `STC',
       `STD' and `STI' instructions (section B.4.301). To invert the carry
       flag, use `CMC' (section B.4.22).

B.4.21 `CLFLUSH': Flush Cache Line

       CLFLUSH mem                   ; 0F AE /7        [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CLFLUSH' invalidates the cache line that contains the linear
       address specified by the source operand from all levels of the
       processor cache hierarchy (data and instruction). If, at any level
       of the cache hierarchy, the line is inconsistent with memory (dirty)
       it is written to memory before invalidation. The source operand
       points to a byte-sized memory location.

       Although `CLFLUSH' is flagged `SSE2' and above, it may not be
       present on all processors which have `SSE2' support, and it may be
       supported on other processors; the `CPUID' instruction (section
       B.4.34) will return a bit which indicates support for the `CLFLUSH'
       instruction.

B.4.22 `CMC': Complement Carry Flag

       CMC                           ; F5                   [8086]

       `CMC' changes the value of the carry flag: if it was 0, it sets it
       to 1, and vice versa.

B.4.23 `CMOVcc': Conditional Move

       CMOVcc reg16,r/m16            ; o16 0F 40+cc /r      [P6] 
       CMOVcc reg32,r/m32            ; o32 0F 40+cc /r      [P6]

       `CMOV' moves its source (second) operand into its destination
       (first) operand if the given condition code is satisfied; otherwise
       it does nothing.

       For a list of condition codes, see section B.2.2.

       Although the `CMOV' instructions are flagged `P6' and above, they
       may not be supported by all Pentium Pro processors; the `CPUID'
       instruction (section B.4.34) will return a bit which indicates
       whether conditional moves are supported.

B.4.24 `CMP': Compare Integers

       CMP r/m8,reg8                 ; 38 /r                [8086] 
       CMP r/m16,reg16               ; o16 39 /r            [8086] 
       CMP r/m32,reg32               ; o32 39 /r            [386]

       CMP reg8,r/m8                 ; 3A /r                [8086] 
       CMP reg16,r/m16               ; o16 3B /r            [8086] 
       CMP reg32,r/m32               ; o32 3B /r            [386]

       CMP r/m8,imm8                 ; 80 /7 ib             [8086] 
       CMP r/m16,imm16               ; o16 81 /7 iw         [8086] 
       CMP r/m32,imm32               ; o32 81 /7 id         [386]

       CMP r/m16,imm8                ; o16 83 /7 ib         [8086] 
       CMP r/m32,imm8                ; o32 83 /7 ib         [386]

       CMP AL,imm8                   ; 3C ib                [8086] 
       CMP AX,imm16                  ; o16 3D iw            [8086] 
       CMP EAX,imm32                 ; o32 3D id            [386]

       `CMP' performs a `mental' subtraction of its second operand from its
       first operand, and affects the flags as if the subtraction had taken
       place, but does not store the result of the subtraction anywhere.

       In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
       first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
       sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
       the `BYTE' qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
       form of the instruction.

       The destination operand can be a register or a memory location. The
       source can be a register, memory location or an immediate value of
       the same size as the destination.

B.4.25 `CMPccPD': Packed Double-Precision FP Compare        

       CMPPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128,imm8   ; 66 0F C2 /r ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       CMPEQPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128      ; 66 0F C2 /r 00  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPLTPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128      ; 66 0F C2 /r 01  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPLEPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128      ; 66 0F C2 /r 02  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPUNORDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128   ; 66 0F C2 /r 03  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPNEQPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 66 0F C2 /r 04  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPNLTPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 66 0F C2 /r 05  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPNLEPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 66 0F C2 /r 06  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPORDPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 66 0F C2 /r 07  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       The `CMPccPD' instructions compare the two packed double-precision
       FP values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
       result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
       each comparison is a quadword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
       all 0s (comparison false).

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source can be either an
       `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
       bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the 8
       two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third operand
       already filled in. The  `Condition Predicates' are:

       EQ     0   Equal 
       LT     1   Less-than 
       LE     2   Less-than-or-equal 
       UNORD  3   Unordered 
       NE     4   Not-equal 
       NLT    5   Not-less-than 
       NLE    6   Not-less-than-or-equal 
       ORD    7   Ordered

       For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how to
       emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see section B.2.3

B.4.26 `CMPccPS': Packed Single-Precision FP Compare        

       CMPPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128,imm8   ; 0F C2 /r ib     [KATMAI,SSE]

       CMPEQPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128      ; 0F C2 /r 00     [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPLTPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128      ; 0F C2 /r 01     [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPLEPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128      ; 0F C2 /r 02     [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPUNORDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128   ; 0F C2 /r 03     [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPNEQPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 0F C2 /r 04     [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPNLTPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 0F C2 /r 05     [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPNLEPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 0F C2 /r 06     [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPORDPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 0F C2 /r 07     [KATMAI,SSE]

       The `CMPccPS' instructions compare the two packed single-precision
       FP values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
       result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
       each comparison is a doubleword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
       all 0s (comparison false).

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source can be either an
       `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
       bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the 8
       two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third operand
       already filled in. The  `Condition Predicates' are:

       EQ     0   Equal 
       LT     1   Less-than 
       LE     2   Less-than-or-equal 
       UNORD  3   Unordered 
       NE     4   Not-equal 
       NLT    5   Not-less-than 
       NLE    6   Not-less-than-or-equal 
       ORD    7   Ordered

       For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how to
       emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see section B.2.3

B.4.27 `CMPSB', `CMPSW', `CMPSD': Compare Strings

       CMPSB                         ; A6                   [8086] 
       CMPSW                         ; o16 A7               [8086] 
       CMPSD                         ; o32 A7               [386]

       `CMPSB' compares the byte at `[DS:SI]' or `[DS:ESI]' with the byte
       at `[ES:DI]' or `[ES:EDI]', and sets the flags accordingly. It then
       increments or decrements (depending on the direction flag:
       increments if the flag is clear, decrements if it is set) `SI' and
       `DI' (or `ESI' and `EDI').

       The registers used are `SI' and `DI' if the address size is 16 bits,
       and `ESI' and `EDI' if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address
       size not equal to the current `BITS' setting, you can use an
       explicit `a16' or `a32' prefix.

       The segment register used to load from `[SI]' or `[ESI]' can be
       overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
       example, `ES CMPSB'). The use of `ES' for the load from `[DI]' or
       `[EDI]' cannot be overridden.

       `CMPSW' and `CMPSD' work in the same way, but they compare a word or
       a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
       addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.

       The `REPE' and `REPNE' prefixes (equivalently, `REPZ' and `REPNZ')
       may be used to repeat the instruction up to `CX' (or `ECX' - again,
       the address size chooses which) times until the first unequal or
       equal byte is found.

B.4.28 `CMPccSD': Scalar Double-Precision FP Compare        

       CMPSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64,imm8    ; F2 0F C2 /r ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       CMPEQSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64       ; F2 0F C2 /r 00  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPLTSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64       ; F2 0F C2 /r 01  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPLESD xmm1,xmm2/mem64       ; F2 0F C2 /r 02  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPUNORDSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64    ; F2 0F C2 /r 03  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPNEQSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64      ; F2 0F C2 /r 04  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPNLTSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64      ; F2 0F C2 /r 05  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPNLESD xmm1,xmm2/mem64      ; F2 0F C2 /r 06  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       CMPORDSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64      ; F2 0F C2 /r 07  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       The `CMPccSD' instructions compare the low-order double-precision FP
       values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
       result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
       each comparison is a quadword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
       all 0s (comparison false).

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source can be either an
       `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
       bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the 8
       two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third operand
       already filled in. The  `Condition Predicates' are:

       EQ     0   Equal 
       LT     1   Less-than 
       LE     2   Less-than-or-equal 
       UNORD  3   Unordered 
       NE     4   Not-equal 
       NLT    5   Not-less-than 
       NLE    6   Not-less-than-or-equal 
       ORD    7   Ordered

       For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how to
       emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see section B.2.3

B.4.29 `CMPccSS': Scalar Single-Precision FP Compare        

       CMPSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32,imm8    ; F3 0F C2 /r ib  [KATMAI,SSE]

       CMPEQSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32       ; F3 0F C2 /r 00  [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPLTSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32       ; F3 0F C2 /r 01  [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPLESS xmm1,xmm2/mem32       ; F3 0F C2 /r 02  [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPUNORDSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32    ; F3 0F C2 /r 03  [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPNEQSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32      ; F3 0F C2 /r 04  [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPNLTSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32      ; F3 0F C2 /r 05  [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPNLESS xmm1,xmm2/mem32      ; F3 0F C2 /r 06  [KATMAI,SSE] 
       CMPORDSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32      ; F3 0F C2 /r 07  [KATMAI,SSE]

       The `CMPccSS' instructions compare the low-order single-precision FP
       values in the source and destination operands, and returns the
       result of the comparison in the destination register. The result of
       each comparison is a doubleword mask of all 1s (comparison true) or
       all 0s (comparison false).

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source can be either an
       `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       The third operand is an 8-bit immediate value, of which the low 3
       bits define the type of comparison. For ease of programming, the 8
       two-operand pseudo-instructions are provided, with the third operand
       already filled in. The  `Condition Predicates' are:

       EQ     0   Equal 
       LT     1   Less-than 
       LE     2   Less-than-or-equal 
       UNORD  3   Unordered 
       NE     4   Not-equal 
       NLT    5   Not-less-than 
       NLE    6   Not-less-than-or-equal 
       ORD    7   Ordered

       For more details of the comparison predicates, and details of how to
       emulate the "greater-than" equivalents, see section B.2.3

B.4.30 `CMPXCHG', `CMPXCHG486': Compare and Exchange

       CMPXCHG r/m8,reg8             ; 0F B0 /r             [PENT] 
       CMPXCHG r/m16,reg16           ; o16 0F B1 /r         [PENT] 
       CMPXCHG r/m32,reg32           ; o32 0F B1 /r         [PENT]

       CMPXCHG486 r/m8,reg8          ; 0F A6 /r             [486,UNDOC] 
       CMPXCHG486 r/m16,reg16        ; o16 0F A7 /r         [486,UNDOC] 
       CMPXCHG486 r/m32,reg32        ; o32 0F A7 /r         [486,UNDOC]

       These two instructions perform exactly the same operation; however,
       apparently some (not all) 486 processors support it under a non-
       standard opcode, so NASM provides the undocumented `CMPXCHG486' form
       to generate the non-standard opcode.

       `CMPXCHG' compares its destination (first) operand to the value in
       `AL', `AX' or `EAX' (depending on the operand size of the
       instruction). If they are equal, it copies its source (second)
       operand into the destination and sets the zero flag. Otherwise, it
       clears the zero flag and copies the destination register to AL, AX
       or EAX.

       The destination can be either a register or a memory location. The
       source is a register.

       `CMPXCHG' is intended to be used for atomic operations in
       multitasking or multiprocessor environments. To safely update a
       value in shared memory, for example, you might load the value into
       `EAX', load the updated value into `EBX', and then execute the
       instruction `LOCK CMPXCHG [value],EBX'. If `value' has not changed
       since being loaded, it is updated with your desired new value, and
       the zero flag is set to let you know it has worked. (The `LOCK'
       prefix prevents another processor doing anything in the middle of
       this operation: it guarantees atomicity.) However, if another
       processor has modified the value in between your load and your
       attempted store, the store does not happen, and you are notified of
       the failure by a cleared zero flag, so you can go round and try
       again.

B.4.31 `CMPXCHG8B': Compare and Exchange Eight Bytes

       CMPXCHG8B mem                 ; 0F C7 /1             [PENT]

       This is a larger and more unwieldy version of `CMPXCHG': it compares
       the 64-bit (eight-byte) value stored at `[mem]' with the value in
       `EDX:EAX'. If they are equal, it sets the zero flag and stores
       `ECX:EBX' into the memory area. If they are unequal, it clears the
       zero flag and stores the memory contents into `EDX:EAX'.

       `CMPXCHG8B' can be used with the `LOCK' prefix, to allow atomic
       execution. This is useful in multi-processor and multi-tasking
       environments.

B.4.32 `COMISD': Scalar Ordered Double-Precision FP Compare and Set EFLAGS

       COMISD xmm1,xmm2/mem64        ; 66 0F 2F /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `COMISD' compares the low-order double-precision FP value in the two
       source operands. ZF, PF and CF are set according to the result. OF,
       AF and AF are cleared. The unordered result is returned if either
       source is a NaN (QNaN or SNaN).

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a memory location.

       The flags are set according to the following rules:

          Result          Flags        Values

          UNORDERED:      ZF,PF,CF <-- 111; 
          GREATER_THAN:   ZF,PF,CF <-- 000; 
          LESS_THAN:      ZF,PF,CF <-- 001; 
          EQUAL:          ZF,PF,CF <-- 100;

B.4.33 `COMISS': Scalar Ordered Single-Precision FP Compare and Set EFLAGS

       COMISS xmm1,xmm2/mem32        ; 66 0F 2F /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `COMISS' compares the low-order single-precision FP value in the two
       source operands. ZF, PF and CF are set according to the result. OF,
       AF and AF are cleared. The unordered result is returned if either
       source is a NaN (QNaN or SNaN).

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a memory location.

       The flags are set according to the following rules:

          Result          Flags        Values

          UNORDERED:      ZF,PF,CF <-- 111; 
          GREATER_THAN:   ZF,PF,CF <-- 000; 
          LESS_THAN:      ZF,PF,CF <-- 001; 
          EQUAL:          ZF,PF,CF <-- 100;

B.4.34 `CPUID': Get CPU Identification Code

       CPUID                         ; 0F A2                [PENT]

       `CPUID' returns various information about the processor it is being
       executed on. It fills the four registers `EAX', `EBX', `ECX' and
       `EDX' with information, which varies depending on the input contents
       of `EAX'.

       `CPUID' also acts as a barrier to serialise instruction execution:
       executing the `CPUID' instruction guarantees that all the effects
       (memory modification, flag modification, register modification) of
       previous instructions have been completed before the next
       instruction gets fetched.

       The information returned is as follows:

       (*) If `EAX' is zero on input, `EAX' on output holds the maximum
           acceptable input value of `EAX', and `EBX:EDX:ECX' contain the
           string `"GenuineIntel"' (or not, if you have a clone processor).
           That is to say, `EBX' contains `"Genu"' (in NASM's own sense of
           character constants, described in section 3.4.2), `EDX' contains
           `"ineI"' and `ECX' contains `"ntel"'.

       (*) If `EAX' is one on input, `EAX' on output contains version
           information about the processor, and `EDX' contains a set of
           feature flags, showing the presence and absence of various
           features. For example, bit 8 is set if the `CMPXCHG8B'
           instruction (section B.4.31) is supported, bit 15 is set if the
           conditional move instructions (section B.4.23 and section
           B.4.72) are supported, and bit 23 is set if `MMX' instructions
           are supported.

       (*) If `EAX' is two on input, `EAX', `EBX', `ECX' and `EDX' all
           contain information about caches and TLBs (Translation Lookahead
           Buffers).

       For more information on the data returned from `CPUID', see the
       documentation from Intel and other processor manufacturers.

B.4.35 `CVTDQ2PD': Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Double-Precision FP Conversion

       CVTDQ2PD xmm1,xmm2/mem64      ; F3 0F E6 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTDQ2PD' converts two packed signed doublewords from the source
       operand to two packed double-precision FP values in the destination
       operand.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source
       is a register, the packed integers are in the low quadword.

B.4.36 `CVTDQ2PS': Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Single-Precision FP Conversion

       CVTDQ2PS xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 0F 5B /r        [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTDQ2PS' converts four packed signed doublewords from the source
       operand to four packed single-precision FP values in the destination
       operand.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.37 `CVTPD2DQ': Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion

       CVTPD2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; F2 0F E6 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTPD2DQ' converts two packed double-precision FP values from the
       source operand to two packed signed doublewords in the low quadword
       of the destination operand. The high quadword of the destination is
       set to all 0s.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.38 `CVTPD2PI': Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion

       CVTPD2PI mm,xmm/mem128        ; 66 0F 2D /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTPD2PI' converts two packed double-precision FP values from the
       source operand to two packed signed doublewords in the destination
       operand.

       The destination operand is an `MMX' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.39 `CVTPD2PS': Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Single-Precision FP Conversion

       CVTPD2PS xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 66 0F 5A /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTPD2PS' converts two packed double-precision FP values from the
       source operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the low
       quadword of the destination operand. The high quadword of the
       destination is set to all 0s.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.40 `CVTPI2PD': Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Double-Precision FP Conversion

       CVTPI2PD xmm,mm/mem64         ; 66 0F 2A /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTPI2PD' converts two packed signed doublewords from the source
       operand to two packed double-precision FP values in the destination
       operand.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `MMX' register or a 64-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.41 `CVTPI2PS': Packed Signed INT32 to Packed Single-FP Conversion

       CVTPI2PS xmm,mm/mem64         ; 0F 2A /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `CVTPI2PS' converts two packed signed doublewords from the source
       operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the low quadword
       of the destination operand. The high quadword of the destination
       remains unchanged.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `MMX' register or a 64-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.42 `CVTPS2DQ': Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion

       CVTPS2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128     ; 66 0F 5B /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTPS2DQ' converts four packed single-precision FP values from the
       source operand to four packed signed doublewords in the destination
       operand.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.43 `CVTPS2PD': Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Double-Precision FP Conversion

       CVTPS2PD xmm1,xmm2/mem64      ; 0F 5A /r        [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTPS2PD' converts two packed single-precision FP values from the
       source operand to two packed double-precision FP values in the
       destination operand.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source
       is a register, the input values are in the low quadword.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.44 `CVTPS2PI': Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion

       CVTPS2PI mm,xmm/mem64         ; 0F 2D /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `CVTPS2PI' converts two packed single-precision FP values from the
       source operand to two packed signed doublewords in the destination
       operand.

       The destination operand is an `MMX' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source
       is a register, the input values are in the low quadword.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.45 `CVTSD2SI': Scalar Double-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion

       CVTSD2SI reg32,xmm/mem64      ; F2 0F 2D /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTSD2SI' converts a double-precision FP value from the source
       operand to a signed doubleword in the destination operand.

       The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source
       can be either an `XMM' register or a 64-bit memory location. If the
       source is a register, the input value is in the low quadword.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.46 `CVTSD2SS': Scalar Double-Precision FP to Scalar Single-Precision FP Conversion

       CVTSD2SS xmm1,xmm2/mem64      ; F2 0F 5A /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `CVTSD2SS' converts a double-precision FP value from the source
       operand to a single-precision FP value in the low doubleword of the
       destination operand. The upper 3 doublewords are left unchanged.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source
       is a register, the input value is in the low quadword.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.47 `CVTSI2SD': Signed INT32 to Scalar Double-Precision FP Conversion

       CVTSI2SD xmm,r/m32            ; F2 0F 2A /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTSI2SD' converts a signed doubleword from the source operand to a
       double-precision FP value in the low quadword of the destination
       operand. The high quadword is left unchanged.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either a general purpose register or a 32-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.48 `CVTSI2SS': Signed INT32 to Scalar Single-Precision FP Conversion

       CVTSI2SS xmm,r/m32            ; F3 0F 2A /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `CVTSI2SS' converts a signed doubleword from the source operand to a
       single-precision FP value in the low doubleword of the destination
       operand. The upper 3 doublewords are left unchanged.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either a general purpose register or a 32-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.49 `CVTSS2SD': Scalar Single-Precision FP to Scalar Double-Precision FP Conversion

       CVTSS2SD xmm1,xmm2/mem32      ; F3 0F 5A /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTSS2SD' converts a single-precision FP value from the source
       operand to a double-precision FP value in the low quadword of the
       destination operand. The upper quadword is left unchanged.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 32-bit memory location. If the source
       is a register, the input value is contained in the low doubleword.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.50 `CVTSS2SI': Scalar Single-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion

       CVTSS2SI reg32,xmm/mem32      ; F3 0F 2D /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `CVTSS2SI' converts a single-precision FP value from the source
       operand to a signed doubleword in the destination operand.

       The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source
       can be either an `XMM' register or a 32-bit memory location. If the
       source is a register, the input value is in the low doubleword.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.51 `CVTTPD2DQ': Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation

       CVTTPD2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128    ; 66 0F E6 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTTPD2DQ' converts two packed double-precision FP values in the
       source operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the
       destination operand. If the result is inexact, it is truncated
       (rounded toward zero). The high quadword is set to all 0s.

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.52 `CVTTPD2PI': Packed Double-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation

       CVTTPD2PI mm,xmm/mem128        ; 66 0F 2C /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTTPD2PI' converts two packed double-precision FP values in the
       source operand to two packed single-precision FP values in the
       destination operand. If the result is inexact, it is truncated
       (rounded toward zero).

       The destination operand is an `MMX' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.53 `CVTTPS2DQ': Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation

       CVTTPS2DQ xmm1,xmm2/mem128    ; F3 0F 5B /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTTPS2DQ' converts four packed single-precision FP values in the
       source operand to four packed signed doublewords in the destination
       operand. If the result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward
       zero).

       The destination operand is an `XMM' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.54 `CVTTPS2PI': Packed Single-Precision FP to Packed Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation

       CVTTPS2PI mm,xmm/mem64         ; 0F 2C /r       [KATMAI,SSE]

       `CVTTPS2PI' converts two packed single-precision FP values in the
       source operand to two packed signed doublewords in the destination
       operand. If the result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward
       zero). If the source is a register, the input values are in the low
       quadword.

       The destination operand is an `MMX' register. The source can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 64-bit memory location. If the source
       is a register, the input value is in the low quadword.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.55 `CVTTSD2SI': Scalar Double-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation

       CVTTSD2SI reg32,xmm/mem64      ; F2 0F 2C /r    [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `CVTTSD2SI' converts a double-precision FP value in the source
       operand to a signed doubleword in the destination operand. If the
       result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero).

       The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source
       can be either an `XMM' register or a 64-bit memory location. If the
       source is a register, the input value is in the low quadword.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.56 `CVTTSS2SI': Scalar Single-Precision FP to Signed INT32 Conversion with Truncation

       CVTTSD2SI reg32,xmm/mem32      ; F3 0F 2C /r    [KATMAI,SSE]

       `CVTTSS2SI' converts a single-precision FP value in the source
       operand to a signed doubleword in the destination operand. If the
       result is inexact, it is truncated (rounded toward zero).

       The destination operand is a general purpose register. The source
       can be either an `XMM' register or a 32-bit memory location. If the
       source is a register, the input value is in the low doubleword.

       For more details of this instruction, see the Intel Processor
       manuals.

B.4.57 `DAA', `DAS': Decimal Adjustments

       DAA                           ; 27                   [8086] 
       DAS                           ; 2F                   [8086]

       These instructions are used in conjunction with the add and subtract
       instructions to perform binary-coded decimal arithmetic in _packed_
       (one BCD digit per nibble) form. For the unpacked equivalents, see
       section B.4.1.

       `DAA' should be used after a one-byte `ADD' instruction whose
       destination was the `AL' register: by means of examining the value
       in the `AL' and also the auxiliary carry flag `AF', it determines
       whether either digit of the addition has overflowed, and adjusts it
       (and sets the carry and auxiliary-carry flags) if so. You can add
       long BCD strings together by doing `ADD'/`DAA' on the low two
       digits, then doing `ADC'/`DAA' on each subsequent pair of digits.

       `DAS' works similarly to `DAA', but is for use after `SUB'
       instructions rather than `ADD'.

B.4.58 `DEC': Decrement Integer

       DEC reg16                     ; o16 48+r             [8086] 
       DEC reg32                     ; o32 48+r             [386] 
       DEC r/m8                      ; FE /1                [8086] 
       DEC r/m16                     ; o16 FF /1            [8086] 
       DEC r/m32                     ; o32 FF /1            [386]

       `DEC' subtracts 1 from its operand. It does _not_ affect the carry
       flag: to affect the carry flag, use `SUB something,1' (see section
       B.4.305). `DEC' affects all the other flags according to the result.

       This instruction can be used with a `LOCK' prefix to allow atomic
       execution.

       See also `INC' (section B.4.120).

B.4.59 `DIV': Unsigned Integer Divide

       DIV r/m8                      ; F6 /6                [8086] 
       DIV r/m16                     ; o16 F7 /6            [8086] 
       DIV r/m32                     ; o32 F7 /6            [386]

       `DIV' performs unsigned integer division. The explicit operand
       provided is the divisor; the dividend and destination operands are
       implicit, in the following way:

       (*) For `DIV r/m8', `AX' is divided by the given operand; the
           quotient is stored in `AL' and the remainder in `AH'.

       (*) For `DIV r/m16', `DX:AX' is divided by the given operand; the
           quotient is stored in `AX' and the remainder in `DX'.

       (*) For `DIV r/m32', `EDX:EAX' is divided by the given operand; the
           quotient is stored in `EAX' and the remainder in `EDX'.

       Signed integer division is performed by the `IDIV' instruction: see
       section B.4.117.

B.4.60 `DIVPD': Packed Double-Precision FP Divide

       DIVPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128        ; 66 0F 5E /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `DIVPD' divides the two packed double-precision FP values in the
       destination operand by the two packed double-precision FP values in
       the source operand, and stores the packed double-precision results
       in the destination register.

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

          dst[0-63]   := dst[0-63]   / src[0-63], 
          dst[64-127] := dst[64-127] / src[64-127].

B.4.61 `DIVPS': Packed Single-Precision FP Divide

       DIVPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128        ; 0F 5E /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `DIVPS' divides the four packed single-precision FP values in the
       destination operand by the four packed single-precision FP values in
       the source operand, and stores the packed single-precision results
       in the destination register.

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 128-bit memory location.

          dst[0-31]   := dst[0-31]   / src[0-31], 
          dst[32-63]  := dst[32-63]  / src[32-63], 
          dst[64-95]  := dst[64-95]  / src[64-95], 
          dst[96-127] := dst[96-127] / src[96-127].

B.4.62 `DIVSD': Scalar Double-Precision FP Divide

       DIVSD xmm1,xmm2/mem64         ; F2 0F 5E /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `DIVSD' divides the low-order double-precision FP value in the
       destination operand by the low-order double-precision FP value in
       the source operand, and stores the double-precision result in the
       destination register.

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 64-bit memory location.

          dst[0-63]   := dst[0-63] / src[0-63], 
          dst[64-127] remains unchanged.

B.4.63 `DIVSS': Scalar Single-Precision FP Divide

       DIVSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32         ; F3 0F 5E /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `DIVSS' divides the low-order single-precision FP value in the
       destination operand by the low-order single-precision FP value in
       the source operand, and stores the single-precision result in the
       destination register.

       The destination is an `XMM' register. The source operand can be
       either an `XMM' register or a 32-bit memory location.

          dst[0-31]   := dst[0-31] / src[0-31], 
          dst[32-127] remains unchanged.

B.4.64 `EMMS': Empty MMX State

       EMMS                          ; 0F 77                [PENT,MMX]

       `EMMS' sets the FPU tag word (marking which floating-point registers
       are available) to all ones, meaning all registers are available for
       the FPU to use. It should be used after executing `MMX' instructions
       and before executing any subsequent floating-point operations.

B.4.65 `ENTER': Create Stack Frame

       ENTER imm,imm                 ; C8 iw ib             [186]

       `ENTER' constructs a `stack frame' for a high-level language
       procedure call. The first operand (the `iw' in the opcode definition
       above refers to the first operand) gives the amount of stack space
       to allocate for local variables; the second (the `ib' above) gives
       the nesting level of the procedure (for languages like Pascal, with
       nested procedures).

       The function of `ENTER', with a nesting level of zero, is equivalent
       to

                 PUSH EBP            ; or PUSH BP         in 16 bits 
                 MOV EBP,ESP         ; or MOV BP,SP       in 16 bits 
                 SUB ESP,operand1    ; or SUB SP,operand1 in 16 bits

       This creates a stack frame with the procedure parameters accessible
       upwards from `EBP', and local variables accessible downwards from
       `EBP'.

       With a nesting level of one, the stack frame created is 4 (or 2)
       bytes bigger, and the value of the final frame pointer `EBP' is
       accessible in memory at `[EBP-4]'.

       This allows `ENTER', when called with a nesting level of two, to
       look at the stack frame described by the _previous_ value of `EBP',
       find the frame pointer at offset -4 from that, and push it along
       with its new frame pointer, so that when a level-two procedure is
       called from within a level-one procedure, `[EBP-4]' holds the frame
       pointer of the most recent level-one procedure call and `[EBP-8]'
       holds that of the most recent level-two call. And so on, for nesting
       levels up to 31.

       Stack frames created by `ENTER' can be destroyed by the `LEAVE'
       instruction: see section B.4.136.

B.4.66 `F2XM1': Calculate 2**X-1

       F2XM1                         ; D9 F0                [8086,FPU]

       `F2XM1' raises 2 to the power of `ST0', subtracts one, and stores
       the result back into `ST0'. The initial contents of `ST0' must be a
       number in the range -1.0 to +1.0.

B.4.67 `FABS': Floating-Point Absolute Value

       FABS                          ; D9 E1                [8086,FPU]

       `FABS' computes the absolute value of `ST0',by clearing the sign
       bit, and stores the result back in `ST0'.

B.4.68 `FADD', `FADDP': Floating-Point Addition

       FADD mem32                    ; D8 /0                [8086,FPU] 
       FADD mem64                    ; DC /0                [8086,FPU]

       FADD fpureg                   ; D8 C0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FADD ST0,fpureg               ; D8 C0+r              [8086,FPU]

       FADD TO fpureg                ; DC C0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FADD fpureg,ST0               ; DC C0+r              [8086,FPU]

       FADDP fpureg                  ; DE C0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FADDP fpureg,ST0              ; DE C0+r              [8086,FPU]

       (*) `FADD', given one operand, adds the operand to `ST0' and stores
           the result back in `ST0'. If the operand has the `TO' modifier,
           the result is stored in the register given rather than in `ST0'.

       (*) `FADDP' performs the same function as `FADD TO', but pops the
           register stack after storing the result.

       The given two-operand forms are synonyms for the one-operand forms.

       To add an integer value to `ST0', use the c{FIADD} instruction
       (section B.4.80)

B.4.69 `FBLD', `FBSTP': BCD Floating-Point Load and Store

       FBLD mem80                    ; DF /4                [8086,FPU] 
       FBSTP mem80                   ; DF /6                [8086,FPU]

       `FBLD' loads an 80-bit (ten-byte) packed binary-coded decimal number
       from the given memory address, converts it to a real, and pushes it
       on the register stack. `FBSTP' stores the value of `ST0', in packed
       BCD, at the given address and then pops the register stack.

B.4.70 `FCHS': Floating-Point Change Sign

       FCHS                          ; D9 E0                [8086,FPU]

       `FCHS' negates the number in `ST0', by inverting the sign bit:
       negative numbers become positive, and vice versa.

B.4.71 `FCLEX', `FNCLEX': Clear Floating-Point Exceptions

       FCLEX                         ; 9B DB E2             [8086,FPU] 
       FNCLEX                        ; DB E2                [8086,FPU]

       `FCLEX' clears any floating-point exceptions which may be pending.
       `FNCLEX' does the same thing but doesn't wait for previous floating-
       point operations (including the _handling_ of pending exceptions) to
       finish first.

B.4.72 `FCMOVcc': Floating-Point Conditional Move

       FCMOVB fpureg                 ; DA C0+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FCMOVB ST0,fpureg             ; DA C0+r              [P6,FPU]

       FCMOVE fpureg                 ; DA C8+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FCMOVE ST0,fpureg             ; DA C8+r              [P6,FPU]

       FCMOVBE fpureg                ; DA D0+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FCMOVBE ST0,fpureg            ; DA D0+r              [P6,FPU]

       FCMOVU fpureg                 ; DA D8+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FCMOVU ST0,fpureg             ; DA D8+r              [P6,FPU]

       FCMOVNB fpureg                ; DB C0+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FCMOVNB ST0,fpureg            ; DB C0+r              [P6,FPU]

       FCMOVNE fpureg                ; DB C8+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FCMOVNE ST0,fpureg            ; DB C8+r              [P6,FPU]

       FCMOVNBE fpureg               ; DB D0+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FCMOVNBE ST0,fpureg           ; DB D0+r              [P6,FPU]

       FCMOVNU fpureg                ; DB D8+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FCMOVNU ST0,fpureg            ; DB D8+r              [P6,FPU]

       The `FCMOV' instructions perform conditional move operations: each
       of them moves the contents of the given register into `ST0' if its
       condition is satisfied, and does nothing if not.

       The conditions are not the same as the standard condition codes used
       with conditional jump instructions. The conditions `B', `BE', `NB',
       `NBE', `E' and `NE' are exactly as normal, but none of the other
       standard ones are supported. Instead, the condition `U' and its
       counterpart `NU' are provided; the `U' condition is satisfied if the
       last two floating-point numbers compared were _unordered_, i.e. they
       were not equal but neither one could be said to be greater than the
       other, for example if they were NaNs. (The flag state which signals
       this is the setting of the parity flag: so the `U' condition is
       notionally equivalent to `PE', and `NU' is equivalent to `PO'.)

       The `FCMOV' conditions test the main processor's status flags, not
       the FPU status flags, so using `FCMOV' directly after `FCOM' will
       not work. Instead, you should either use `FCOMI' which writes
       directly to the main CPU flags word, or use `FSTSW' to extract the
       FPU flags.

       Although the `FCMOV' instructions are flagged `P6' above, they may
       not be supported by all Pentium Pro processors; the `CPUID'
       instruction (section B.4.34) will return a bit which indicates
       whether conditional moves are supported.

B.4.73 `FCOM', `FCOMP', `FCOMPP', `FCOMI', `FCOMIP': Floating-Point Compare

       FCOM mem32                    ; D8 /2                [8086,FPU] 
       FCOM mem64                    ; DC /2                [8086,FPU] 
       FCOM fpureg                   ; D8 D0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FCOM ST0,fpureg               ; D8 D0+r              [8086,FPU]

       FCOMP mem32                   ; D8 /3                [8086,FPU] 
       FCOMP mem64                   ; DC /3                [8086,FPU] 
       FCOMP fpureg                  ; D8 D8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FCOMP ST0,fpureg              ; D8 D8+r              [8086,FPU]

       FCOMPP                        ; DE D9                [8086,FPU]

       FCOMI fpureg                  ; DB F0+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FCOMI ST0,fpureg              ; DB F0+r              [P6,FPU]

       FCOMIP fpureg                 ; DF F0+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FCOMIP ST0,fpureg             ; DF F0+r              [P6,FPU]

       `FCOM' compares `ST0' with the given operand, and sets the FPU flags
       accordingly. `ST0' is treated as the left-hand side of the
       comparison, so that the carry flag is set (for a `less-than' result)
       if `ST0' is less than the given operand.

       `FCOMP' does the same as `FCOM', but pops the register stack
       afterwards. `FCOMPP' compares `ST0' with `ST1' and then pops the
       register stack twice.

       `FCOMI' and `FCOMIP' work like the corresponding forms of `FCOM' and
       `FCOMP', but write their results directly to the CPU flags register
       rather than the FPU status word, so they can be immediately followed
       by conditional jump or conditional move instructions.

       The `FCOM' instructions differ from the `FUCOM' instructions
       (section B.4.108) only in the way they handle quiet NaNs: `FUCOM'
       will handle them silently and set the condition code flags to an
       `unordered' result, whereas `FCOM' will generate an exception.

B.4.74 `FCOS': Cosine

       FCOS                          ; D9 FF                [386,FPU]

       `FCOS' computes the cosine of `ST0' (in radians), and stores the
       result in `ST0'. The absolute value of `ST0' must be less than
       2**63.

       See also `FSINCOS' (section B.4.100).

B.4.75 `FDECSTP': Decrement Floating-Point Stack Pointer

       FDECSTP                       ; D9 F6                [8086,FPU]

       `FDECSTP' decrements the `top' field in the floating-point status
       word. This has the effect of rotating the FPU register stack by one,
       as if the contents of `ST7' had been pushed on the stack. See also
       `FINCSTP' (section B.4.85).

B.4.76 `FxDISI', `FxENI': Disable and Enable Floating-Point Interrupts

       FDISI                         ; 9B DB E1             [8086,FPU] 
       FNDISI                        ; DB E1                [8086,FPU]

       FENI                          ; 9B DB E0             [8086,FPU] 
       FNENI                         ; DB E0                [8086,FPU]

       `FDISI' and `FENI' disable and enable floating-point interrupts.
       These instructions are only meaningful on original 8087 processors:
       the 287 and above treat them as no-operation instructions.

       `FNDISI' and `FNENI' do the same thing as `FDISI' and `FENI'
       respectively, but without waiting for the floating-point processor
       to finish what it was doing first.

B.4.77 `FDIV', `FDIVP', `FDIVR', `FDIVRP': Floating-Point Division

       FDIV mem32                    ; D8 /6                [8086,FPU] 
       FDIV mem64                    ; DC /6                [8086,FPU]

       FDIV fpureg                   ; D8 F0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FDIV ST0,fpureg               ; D8 F0+r              [8086,FPU]

       FDIV TO fpureg                ; DC F8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FDIV fpureg,ST0               ; DC F8+r              [8086,FPU]

       FDIVR mem32                   ; D8 /7                [8086,FPU] 
       FDIVR mem64                   ; DC /7                [8086,FPU]

       FDIVR fpureg                  ; D8 F8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FDIVR ST0,fpureg              ; D8 F8+r              [8086,FPU]

       FDIVR TO fpureg               ; DC F0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FDIVR fpureg,ST0              ; DC F0+r              [8086,FPU]

       FDIVP fpureg                  ; DE F8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FDIVP fpureg,ST0              ; DE F8+r              [8086,FPU]

       FDIVRP fpureg                 ; DE F0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FDIVRP fpureg,ST0             ; DE F0+r              [8086,FPU]

       (*) `FDIV' divides `ST0' by the given operand and stores the result
           back in `ST0', unless the `TO' qualifier is given, in which case
           it divides the given operand by `ST0' and stores the result in
           the operand.

       (*) `FDIVR' does the same thing, but does the division the other way
           up: so if `TO' is not given, it divides the given operand by
           `ST0' and stores the result in `ST0', whereas if `TO' is given
           it divides `ST0' by its operand and stores the result in the
           operand.

       (*) `FDIVP' operates like `FDIV TO', but pops the register stack
           once it has finished.

       (*) `FDIVRP' operates like `FDIVR TO', but pops the register stack
           once it has finished.

       For FP/Integer divisions, see `FIDIV' (section B.4.82).

B.4.78 `FEMMS': Faster Enter/Exit of the MMX or floating-point state

       FEMMS                         ; 0F 0E           [PENT,3DNOW]

       `FEMMS' can be used in place of the `EMMS' instruction on processors
       which support the 3DNow! instruction set. Following execution of
       `FEMMS', the state of the `MMX/FP' registers is undefined, and this
       allows a faster context switch between `FP' and `MMX' instructions.
       The `FEMMS' instruction can also be used _before_ executing `MMX'
       instructions

B.4.79 `FFREE': Flag Floating-Point Register as Unused

       FFREE fpureg                  ; DD C0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FFREEP fpureg                 ; DF C0+r              [286,FPU,UNDOC]

       `FFREE' marks the given register as being empty.

       `FFREEP' marks the given register as being empty, and then pops the
       register stack.

B.4.80 `FIADD': Floating-Point/Integer Addition

       FIADD mem16                   ; DE /0                [8086,FPU] 
       FIADD mem32                   ; DA /0                [8086,FPU]

       `FIADD' adds the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in the given memory
       location to `ST0', storing the result in `ST0'.

B.4.81 `FICOM', `FICOMP': Floating-Point/Integer Compare

       FICOM mem16                   ; DE /2                [8086,FPU] 
       FICOM mem32                   ; DA /2                [8086,FPU]

       FICOMP mem16                  ; DE /3                [8086,FPU] 
       FICOMP mem32                  ; DA /3                [8086,FPU]

       `FICOM' compares `ST0' with the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in
       the given memory location, and sets the FPU flags accordingly.
       `FICOMP' does the same, but pops the register stack afterwards.

B.4.82 `FIDIV', `FIDIVR': Floating-Point/Integer Division

       FIDIV mem16                   ; DE /6                [8086,FPU] 
       FIDIV mem32                   ; DA /6                [8086,FPU]

       FIDIVR mem16                  ; DE /7                [8086,FPU] 
       FIDIVR mem32                  ; DA /7                [8086,FPU]

       `FIDIV' divides `ST0' by the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in the
       given memory location, and stores the result in `ST0'. `FIDIVR' does
       the division the other way up: it divides the integer by `ST0', but
       still stores the result in `ST0'.

B.4.83 `FILD', `FIST', `FISTP': Floating-Point/Integer Conversion

       FILD mem16                    ; DF /0                [8086,FPU] 
       FILD mem32                    ; DB /0                [8086,FPU] 
       FILD mem64                    ; DF /5                [8086,FPU]

       FIST mem16                    ; DF /2                [8086,FPU] 
       FIST mem32                    ; DB /2                [8086,FPU]

       FISTP mem16                   ; DF /3                [8086,FPU] 
       FISTP mem32                   ; DB /3                [8086,FPU] 
       FISTP mem64                   ; DF /7                [8086,FPU]

       `FILD' loads an integer out of a memory location, converts it to a
       real, and pushes it on the FPU register stack. `FIST' converts `ST0'
       to an integer and stores that in memory; `FISTP' does the same as
       `FIST', but pops the register stack afterwards.

B.4.84 `FIMUL': Floating-Point/Integer Multiplication

       FIMUL mem16                   ; DE /1                [8086,FPU] 
       FIMUL mem32                   ; DA /1                [8086,FPU]

       `FIMUL' multiplies `ST0' by the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in
       the given memory location, and stores the result in `ST0'.

B.4.85 `FINCSTP': Increment Floating-Point Stack Pointer

       FINCSTP                       ; D9 F7                [8086,FPU]

       `FINCSTP' increments the `top' field in the floating-point status
       word. This has the effect of rotating the FPU register stack by one,
       as if the register stack had been popped; however, unlike the
       popping of the stack performed by many FPU instructions, it does not
       flag the new `ST7' (previously `ST0') as empty. See also `FDECSTP'
       (section B.4.75).

B.4.86 `FINIT', `FNINIT': Initialise Floating-Point Unit

       FINIT                         ; 9B DB E3             [8086,FPU] 
       FNINIT                        ; DB E3                [8086,FPU]

       `FINIT' initialises the FPU to its default state. It flags all
       registers as empty, without actually change their values, clears the
       top of stack pointer. `FNINIT' does the same, without first waiting
       for pending exceptions to clear.

B.4.87 `FISUB': Floating-Point/Integer Subtraction

       FISUB mem16                   ; DE /4                [8086,FPU] 
       FISUB mem32                   ; DA /4                [8086,FPU]

       FISUBR mem16                  ; DE /5                [8086,FPU] 
       FISUBR mem32                  ; DA /5                [8086,FPU]

       `FISUB' subtracts the 16-bit or 32-bit integer stored in the given
       memory location from `ST0', and stores the result in `ST0'. `FISUBR'
       does the subtraction the other way round, i.e. it subtracts `ST0'
       from the given integer, but still stores the result in `ST0'.

B.4.88 `FLD': Floating-Point Load

       FLD mem32                     ; D9 /0                [8086,FPU] 
       FLD mem64                     ; DD /0                [8086,FPU] 
       FLD mem80                     ; DB /5                [8086,FPU] 
       FLD fpureg                    ; D9 C0+r              [8086,FPU]

       `FLD' loads a floating-point value out of the given register or
       memory location, and pushes it on the FPU register stack.

B.4.89 `FLDxx': Floating-Point Load Constants

       FLD1                          ; D9 E8                [8086,FPU] 
       FLDL2E                        ; D9 EA                [8086,FPU] 
       FLDL2T                        ; D9 E9                [8086,FPU] 
       FLDLG2                        ; D9 EC                [8086,FPU] 
       FLDLN2                        ; D9 ED                [8086,FPU] 
       FLDPI                         ; D9 EB                [8086,FPU] 
       FLDZ                          ; D9 EE                [8086,FPU]

       These instructions push specific standard constants on the FPU
       register stack.

        Instruction    Constant pushed

        FLD1           1 
        FLDL2E         base-2 logarithm of e 
        FLDL2T         base-2 log of 10 
        FLDLG2         base-10 log of 2 
        FLDLN2         base-e log of 2 
        FLDPI          pi 
        FLDZ           zero

B.4.90 `FLDCW': Load Floating-Point Control Word

       FLDCW mem16                   ; D9 /5                [8086,FPU]

       `FLDCW' loads a 16-bit value out of memory and stores it into the
       FPU control word (governing things like the rounding mode, the
       precision, and the exception masks). See also `FSTCW' (section
       B.4.103). If exceptions are enabled and you don't want to generate
       one, use `FCLEX' or `FNCLEX' (section B.4.71) before loading the new
       control word.

B.4.91 `FLDENV': Load Floating-Point Environment

       FLDENV mem                    ; D9 /4                [8086,FPU]

       `FLDENV' loads the FPU operating environment (control word, status
       word, tag word, instruction pointer, data pointer and last opcode)
       from memory. The memory area is 14 or 28 bytes long, depending on
       the CPU mode at the time. See also `FSTENV' (section B.4.104).

B.4.92 `FMUL', `FMULP': Floating-Point Multiply

       FMUL mem32                    ; D8 /1                [8086,FPU] 
       FMUL mem64                    ; DC /1                [8086,FPU]

       FMUL fpureg                   ; D8 C8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FMUL ST0,fpureg               ; D8 C8+r              [8086,FPU]

       FMUL TO fpureg                ; DC C8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FMUL fpureg,ST0               ; DC C8+r              [8086,FPU]

       FMULP fpureg                  ; DE C8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FMULP fpureg,ST0              ; DE C8+r              [8086,FPU]

       `FMUL' multiplies `ST0' by the given operand, and stores the result
       in `ST0', unless the `TO' qualifier is used in which case it stores
       the result in the operand. `FMULP' performs the same operation as
       `FMUL TO', and then pops the register stack.

B.4.93 `FNOP': Floating-Point No Operation

       FNOP                          ; D9 D0                [8086,FPU]

       `FNOP' does nothing.

B.4.94 `FPATAN', `FPTAN': Arctangent and Tangent

       FPATAN                        ; D9 F3                [8086,FPU] 
       FPTAN                         ; D9 F2                [8086,FPU]

       `FPATAN' computes the arctangent, in radians, of the result of
       dividing `ST1' by `ST0', stores the result in `ST1', and pops the
       register stack. It works like the C `atan2' function, in that
       changing the sign of both `ST0' and `ST1' changes the output value
       by pi (so it performs true rectangular-to-polar coordinate
       conversion, with `ST1' being the Y coordinate and `ST0' being the X
       coordinate, not merely an arctangent).

       `FPTAN' computes the tangent of the value in `ST0' (in radians), and
       stores the result back into `ST0'.

       The absolute value of `ST0' must be less than 2**63.

B.4.95 `FPREM', `FPREM1': Floating-Point Partial Remainder

       FPREM                         ; D9 F8                [8086,FPU] 
       FPREM1                        ; D9 F5                [386,FPU]

       These instructions both produce the remainder obtained by dividing
       `ST0' by `ST1'. This is calculated, notionally, by dividing `ST0' by
       `ST1', rounding the result to an integer, multiplying by `ST1'
       again, and computing the value which would need to be added back on
       to the result to get back to the original value in `ST0'.

       The two instructions differ in the way the notional round-to-integer
       operation is performed. `FPREM' does it by rounding towards zero, so
       that the remainder it returns always has the same sign as the
       original value in `ST0'; `FPREM1' does it by rounding to the nearest
       integer, so that the remainder always has at most half the magnitude
       of `ST1'.

       Both instructions calculate _partial_ remainders, meaning that they
       may not manage to provide the final result, but might leave
       intermediate results in `ST0' instead. If this happens, they will
       set the C2 flag in the FPU status word; therefore, to calculate a
       remainder, you should repeatedly execute `FPREM' or `FPREM1' until
       C2 becomes clear.

B.4.96 `FRNDINT': Floating-Point Round to Integer

       FRNDINT                       ; D9 FC                [8086,FPU]

       `FRNDINT' rounds the contents of `ST0' to an integer, according to
       the current rounding mode set in the FPU control word, and stores
       the result back in `ST0'.

B.4.97 `FSAVE', `FRSTOR': Save/Restore Floating-Point State

       FSAVE mem                     ; 9B DD /6             [8086,FPU] 
       FNSAVE mem                    ; DD /6                [8086,FPU]

       FRSTOR mem                    ; DD /4                [8086,FPU]

       `FSAVE' saves the entire floating-point unit state, including all
       the information saved by `FSTENV' (section B.4.104) plus the
       contents of all the registers, to a 94 or 108 byte area of memory
       (depending on the CPU mode). `FRSTOR' restores the floating-point
       state from the same area of memory.

       `FNSAVE' does the same as `FSAVE', without first waiting for pending
       floating-point exceptions to clear.

B.4.98 `FSCALE': Scale Floating-Point Value by Power of Two

       FSCALE                        ; D9 FD                [8086,FPU]

       `FSCALE' scales a number by a power of two: it rounds `ST1' towards
       zero to obtain an integer, then multiplies `ST0' by two to the power
       of that integer, and stores the result in `ST0'.

B.4.99 `FSETPM': Set Protected Mode

       FSETPM                        ; DB E4                [286,FPU]

       This instruction initialises protected mode on the 287 floating-
       point coprocessor. It is only meaningful on that processor: the 387
       and above treat the instruction as a no-operation.

B.4.100 `FSIN', `FSINCOS': Sine and Cosine

       FSIN                          ; D9 FE                [386,FPU] 
       FSINCOS                       ; D9 FB                [386,FPU]

       `FSIN' calculates the sine of `ST0' (in radians) and stores the
       result in `ST0'. `FSINCOS' does the same, but then pushes the cosine
       of the same value on the register stack, so that the sine ends up in
       `ST1' and the cosine in `ST0'. `FSINCOS' is faster than executing
       `FSIN' and `FCOS' (see section B.4.74) in succession.

       The absolute value of `ST0' must be less than 2**63.

B.4.101 `FSQRT': Floating-Point Square Root

       FSQRT                         ; D9 FA                [8086,FPU]

       `FSQRT' calculates the square root of `ST0' and stores the result in
       `ST0'.

B.4.102 `FST', `FSTP': Floating-Point Store

       FST mem32                     ; D9 /2                [8086,FPU] 
       FST mem64                     ; DD /2                [8086,FPU] 
       FST fpureg                    ; DD D0+r              [8086,FPU]

       FSTP mem32                    ; D9 /3                [8086,FPU] 
       FSTP mem64                    ; DD /3                [8086,FPU] 
       FSTP mem80                    ; DB /7                [8086,FPU] 
       FSTP fpureg                   ; DD D8+r              [8086,FPU]

       `FST' stores the value in `ST0' into the given memory location or
       other FPU register. `FSTP' does the same, but then pops the register
       stack.

B.4.103 `FSTCW': Store Floating-Point Control Word

       FSTCW mem16                   ; 9B D9 /7             [8086,FPU] 
       FNSTCW mem16                  ; D9 /7                [8086,FPU]

       `FSTCW' stores the `FPU' control word (governing things like the
       rounding mode, the precision, and the exception masks) into a 2-byte
       memory area. See also `FLDCW' (section B.4.90).

       `FNSTCW' does the same thing as `FSTCW', without first waiting for
       pending floating-point exceptions to clear.

B.4.104 `FSTENV': Store Floating-Point Environment

       FSTENV mem                    ; 9B D9 /6             [8086,FPU] 
       FNSTENV mem                   ; D9 /6                [8086,FPU]

       `FSTENV' stores the `FPU' operating environment (control word,
       status word, tag word, instruction pointer, data pointer and last
       opcode) into memory. The memory area is 14 or 28 bytes long,
       depending on the CPU mode at the time. See also `FLDENV' (section
       B.4.91).

       `FNSTENV' does the same thing as `FSTENV', without first waiting for
       pending floating-point exceptions to clear.

B.4.105 `FSTSW': Store Floating-Point Status Word

       FSTSW mem16                   ; 9B DD /7             [8086,FPU] 
       FSTSW AX                      ; 9B DF E0             [286,FPU]

       FNSTSW mem16                  ; DD /7                [8086,FPU] 
       FNSTSW AX                     ; DF E0                [286,FPU]

       `FSTSW' stores the `FPU' status word into `AX' or into a 2-byte
       memory area.

       `FNSTSW' does the same thing as `FSTSW', without first waiting for
       pending floating-point exceptions to clear.

B.4.106 `FSUB', `FSUBP', `FSUBR', `FSUBRP': Floating-Point Subtract

       FSUB mem32                    ; D8 /4                [8086,FPU] 
       FSUB mem64                    ; DC /4                [8086,FPU]

       FSUB fpureg                   ; D8 E0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FSUB ST0,fpureg               ; D8 E0+r              [8086,FPU]

       FSUB TO fpureg                ; DC E8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FSUB fpureg,ST0               ; DC E8+r              [8086,FPU]

       FSUBR mem32                   ; D8 /5                [8086,FPU] 
       FSUBR mem64                   ; DC /5                [8086,FPU]

       FSUBR fpureg                  ; D8 E8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FSUBR ST0,fpureg              ; D8 E8+r              [8086,FPU]

       FSUBR TO fpureg               ; DC E0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FSUBR fpureg,ST0              ; DC E0+r              [8086,FPU]

       FSUBP fpureg                  ; DE E8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FSUBP fpureg,ST0              ; DE E8+r              [8086,FPU]

       FSUBRP fpureg                 ; DE E0+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FSUBRP fpureg,ST0             ; DE E0+r              [8086,FPU]

       (*) `FSUB' subtracts the given operand from `ST0' and stores the
           result back in `ST0', unless the `TO' qualifier is given, in
           which case it subtracts `ST0' from the given operand and stores
           the result in the operand.

       (*) `FSUBR' does the same thing, but does the subtraction the other
           way up: so if `TO' is not given, it subtracts `ST0' from the
           given operand and stores the result in `ST0', whereas if `TO' is
           given it subtracts its operand from `ST0' and stores the result
           in the operand.

       (*) `FSUBP' operates like `FSUB TO', but pops the register stack
           once it has finished.

       (*) `FSUBRP' operates like `FSUBR TO', but pops the register stack
           once it has finished.

B.4.107 `FTST': Test `ST0' Against Zero

       FTST                          ; D9 E4                [8086,FPU]

       `FTST' compares `ST0' with zero and sets the FPU flags accordingly.
       `ST0' is treated as the left-hand side of the comparison, so that a
       `less-than' result is generated if `ST0' is negative.

B.4.108 `FUCOMxx': Floating-Point Unordered Compare

       FUCOM fpureg                  ; DD E0+r              [386,FPU] 
       FUCOM ST0,fpureg              ; DD E0+r              [386,FPU]

       FUCOMP fpureg                 ; DD E8+r              [386,FPU] 
       FUCOMP ST0,fpureg             ; DD E8+r              [386,FPU]

       FUCOMPP                       ; DA E9                [386,FPU]

       FUCOMI fpureg                 ; DB E8+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FUCOMI ST0,fpureg             ; DB E8+r              [P6,FPU]

       FUCOMIP fpureg                ; DF E8+r              [P6,FPU] 
       FUCOMIP ST0,fpureg            ; DF E8+r              [P6,FPU]

       (*) `FUCOM' compares `ST0' with the given operand, and sets the FPU
           flags accordingly. `ST0' is treated as the left-hand side of the
           comparison, so that the carry flag is set (for a `less-than'
           result) if `ST0' is less than the given operand.

       (*) `FUCOMP' does the same as `FUCOM', but pops the register stack
           afterwards. `FUCOMPP' compares `ST0' with `ST1' and then pops
           the register stack twice.

       (*) `FUCOMI' and `FUCOMIP' work like the corresponding forms of
           `FUCOM' and `FUCOMP', but write their results directly to the
           CPU flags register rather than the FPU status word, so they can
           be immediately followed by conditional jump or conditional move
           instructions.

       The `FUCOM' instructions differ from the `FCOM' instructions
       (section B.4.73) only in the way they handle quiet NaNs: `FUCOM'
       will handle them silently and set the condition code flags to an
       `unordered' result, whereas `FCOM' will generate an exception.

B.4.109 `FXAM': Examine Class of Value in `ST0'

       FXAM                          ; D9 E5                [8086,FPU]

       `FXAM' sets the FPU flags `C3', `C2' and `C0' depending on the type
       of value stored in `ST0':

        Register contents     Flags

        Unsupported format    000 
        NaN                   001 
        Finite number         010 
        Infinity              011 
        Zero                  100 
        Empty register        101 
        Denormal              110

       Additionally, the `C1' flag is set to the sign of the number.

B.4.110 `FXCH': Floating-Point Exchange

       FXCH                          ; D9 C9                [8086,FPU] 
       FXCH fpureg                   ; D9 C8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FXCH fpureg,ST0               ; D9 C8+r              [8086,FPU] 
       FXCH ST0,fpureg               ; D9 C8+r              [8086,FPU]

       `FXCH' exchanges `ST0' with a given FPU register. The no-operand
       form exchanges `ST0' with `ST1'.

B.4.111 `FXRSTOR': Restore `FP', `MMX' and `SSE' State

       FXRSTOR memory                ; 0F AE /1               [P6,SSE,FPU]

       The `FXRSTOR' instruction reloads the `FPU', `MMX' and `SSE' state
       (environment and registers), from the 512 byte memory area defined
       by the source operand. This data should have been written by a
       previous `FXSAVE'.

B.4.112 `FXSAVE': Store `FP', `MMX' and `SSE' State

       FXSAVE memory                 ; 0F AE /0         [P6,SSE,FPU]

       `FXSAVE'The FXSAVE instruction writes the current `FPU', `MMX' and
       `SSE' technology states (environment and registers), to the 512 byte
       memory area defined by the destination operand. It does this without
       checking for pending unmasked floating-point exceptions (similar to
       the operation of `FNSAVE').

       Unlike the `FSAVE/FNSAVE' instructions, the processor retains the
       contents of the `FPU', `MMX' and `SSE' state in the processor after
       the state has been saved. This instruction has been optimised to
       maximize floating-point save performance.

B.4.113 `FXTRACT': Extract Exponent and Significand

       FXTRACT                       ; D9 F4                [8086,FPU]

       `FXTRACT' separates the number in `ST0' into its exponent and
       significand (mantissa), stores the exponent back into `ST0', and
       then pushes the significand on the register stack (so that the
       significand ends up in `ST0', and the exponent in `ST1').

B.4.114 `FYL2X', `FYL2XP1': Compute Y times Log2(X) or Log2(X+1)

       FYL2X                         ; D9 F1                [8086,FPU] 
       FYL2XP1                       ; D9 F9                [8086,FPU]

       `FYL2X' multiplies `ST1' by the base-2 logarithm of `ST0', stores
       the result in `ST1', and pops the register stack (so that the result
       ends up in `ST0'). `ST0' must be non-zero and positive.

       `FYL2XP1' works the same way, but replacing the base-2 log of `ST0'
       with that of `ST0' plus one. This time, `ST0' must have magnitude no
       greater than 1 minus half the square root of two.

B.4.115 `HLT': Halt Processor

       HLT                           ; F4                   [8086,PRIV]

       `HLT' puts the processor into a halted state, where it will perform
       no more operations until restarted by an interrupt or a reset.

       On the 286 and later processors, this is a privileged instruction.

B.4.116 `IBTS': Insert Bit String

       IBTS r/m16,reg16              ; o16 0F A7 /r         [386,UNDOC] 
       IBTS r/m32,reg32              ; o32 0F A7 /r         [386,UNDOC]

       The implied operation of this instruction is:

       IBTS r/m16,AX,CL,reg16 
       IBTS r/m32,EAX,CL,reg32

       Writes a bit string from the source operand to the destination. `CL'
       indicates the number of bits to be copied, from the low bits of the
       source. `(E)AX' indicates the low order bit offset in the
       destination that is written to. For example, if `CL' is set to 4 and
       `AX' (for 16-bit code) is set to 5, bits 0-3 of `src' will be copied
       to bits 5-8 of `dst'. This instruction is very poorly documented,
       and I have been unable to find any official source of documentation
       on it.

       `IBTS' is supported only on the early Intel 386s, and conflicts with
       the opcodes for `CMPXCHG486' (on early Intel 486s). NASM supports it
       only for completeness. Its counterpart is `XBTS' (see section
       B.4.332).

B.4.117 `IDIV': Signed Integer Divide

       IDIV r/m8                     ; F6 /7                [8086] 
       IDIV r/m16                    ; o16 F7 /7            [8086] 
       IDIV r/m32                    ; o32 F7 /7            [386]

       `IDIV' performs signed integer division. The explicit operand
       provided is the divisor; the dividend and destination operands are
       implicit, in the following way:

       (*) For `IDIV r/m8', `AX' is divided by the given operand; the
           quotient is stored in `AL' and the remainder in `AH'.

       (*) For `IDIV r/m16', `DX:AX' is divided by the given operand; the
           quotient is stored in `AX' and the remainder in `DX'.

       (*) For `IDIV r/m32', `EDX:EAX' is divided by the given operand; the
           quotient is stored in `EAX' and the remainder in `EDX'.

       Unsigned integer division is performed by the `DIV' instruction: see
       section B.4.59.

B.4.118 `IMUL': Signed Integer Multiply

       IMUL r/m8                     ; F6 /5                [8086] 
       IMUL r/m16                    ; o16 F7 /5            [8086] 
       IMUL r/m32                    ; o32 F7 /5            [386]

       IMUL reg16,r/m16              ; o16 0F AF /r         [386] 
       IMUL reg32,r/m32              ; o32 0F AF /r         [386]

       IMUL reg16,imm8               ; o16 6B /r ib         [186] 
       IMUL reg16,imm16              ; o16 69 /r iw         [186] 
       IMUL reg32,imm8               ; o32 6B /r ib         [386] 
       IMUL reg32,imm32              ; o32 69 /r id         [386]

       IMUL reg16,r/m16,imm8         ; o16 6B /r ib         [186] 
       IMUL reg16,r/m16,imm16        ; o16 69 /r iw         [186] 
       IMUL reg32,r/m32,imm8         ; o32 6B /r ib         [386] 
       IMUL reg32,r/m32,imm32        ; o32 69 /r id         [386]

       `IMUL' performs signed integer multiplication. For the single-
       operand form, the other operand and destination are implicit, in the
       following way:

       (*) For `IMUL r/m8', `AL' is multiplied by the given operand; the
           product is stored in `AX'.

       (*) For `IMUL r/m16', `AX' is multiplied by the given operand; the
           product is stored in `DX:AX'.

       (*) For `IMUL r/m32', `EAX' is multiplied by the given operand; the
           product is stored in `EDX:EAX'.

       The two-operand form multiplies its two operands and stores the
       result in the destination (first) operand. The three-operand form
       multiplies its last two operands and stores the result in the first
       operand.

       The two-operand form with an immediate second operand is in fact a
       shorthand for the three-operand form, as can be seen by examining
       the opcode descriptions: in the two-operand form, the code `/r'
       takes both its register and `r/m' parts from the same operand (the
       first one).

       In the forms with an 8-bit immediate operand and another longer
       source operand, the immediate operand is considered to be signed,
       and is sign-extended to the length of the other source operand. In
       these cases, the `BYTE' qualifier is necessary to force NASM to
       generate this form of the instruction.

       Unsigned integer multiplication is performed by the `MUL'
       instruction: see section B.4.184.

B.4.119 `IN': Input from I/O Port

       IN AL,imm8                    ; E4 ib                [8086] 
       IN AX,imm8                    ; o16 E5 ib            [8086] 
       IN EAX,imm8                   ; o32 E5 ib            [386] 
       IN AL,DX                      ; EC                   [8086] 
       IN AX,DX                      ; o16 ED               [8086] 
       IN EAX,DX                     ; o32 ED               [386]

       `IN' reads a byte, word or doubleword from the specified I/O port,
       and stores it in the given destination register. The port number may
       be specified as an immediate value if it is between 0 and 255, and
       otherwise must be stored in `DX'. See also `OUT' (section B.4.194).

B.4.120 `INC': Increment Integer

       INC reg16                     ; o16 40+r             [8086] 
       INC reg32                     ; o32 40+r             [386] 
       INC r/m8                      ; FE /0                [8086] 
       INC r/m16                     ; o16 FF /0            [8086] 
       INC r/m32                     ; o32 FF /0            [386]

       `INC' adds 1 to its operand. It does _not_ affect the carry flag: to
       affect the carry flag, use `ADD something,1' (see section B.4.3).
       `INC' affects all the other flags according to the result.

       This instruction can be used with a `LOCK' prefix to allow atomic
       execution.

       See also `DEC' (section B.4.58).

B.4.121 `INSB', `INSW', `INSD': Input String from I/O Port

       INSB                          ; 6C                   [186] 
       INSW                          ; o16 6D               [186] 
       INSD                          ; o32 6D               [386]

       `INSB' inputs a byte from the I/O port specified in `DX' and stores
       it at `[ES:DI]' or `[ES:EDI]'. It then increments or decrements
       (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag is clear,
       decrements if it is set) `DI' or `EDI'.

       The register used is `DI' if the address size is 16 bits, and `EDI'
       if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not equal to
       the current `BITS' setting, you can use an explicit `a16' or `a32'
       prefix.

       Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
       use of `ES' for the load from `[DI]' or `[EDI]' cannot be
       overridden.

       `INSW' and `INSD' work in the same way, but they input a word or a
       doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
       addressing register by 2 or 4 instead of 1.

       The `REP' prefix may be used to repeat the instruction `CX' (or
       `ECX' - again, the address size chooses which) times.

       See also `OUTSB', `OUTSW' and `OUTSD' (section B.4.195).

B.4.122 `INT': Software Interrupt

       INT imm8                      ; CD ib                [8086]

       `INT' causes a software interrupt through a specified vector number
       from 0 to 255.

       The code generated by the `INT' instruction is always two bytes
       long: although there are short forms for some `INT' instructions,
       NASM does not generate them when it sees the `INT' mnemonic. In
       order to generate single-byte breakpoint instructions, use the
       `INT3' or `INT1' instructions (see section B.4.123) instead.

B.4.123 `INT3', `INT1', `ICEBP', `INT01': Breakpoints

       INT1                          ; F1                   [P6] 
       ICEBP                         ; F1                   [P6] 
       INT01                         ; F1                   [P6]

       INT3                          ; CC                   [8086] 
       INT03                         ; CC                   [8086]

       `INT1' and `INT3' are short one-byte forms of the instructions
       `INT 1' and `INT 3' (see section B.4.122). They perform a similar
       function to their longer counterparts, but take up less code space.
       They are used as breakpoints by debuggers.

       (*) `INT1', and its alternative synonyms `INT01' and `ICEBP', is an
           instruction used by in-circuit emulators (ICEs). It is present,
           though not documented, on some processors down to the 286, but
           is only documented for the Pentium Pro. `INT3' is the
           instruction normally used as a breakpoint by debuggers.

       (*) `INT3', and its synonym `INT03', is not precisely equivalent to
           `INT 3': the short form, since it is designed to be used as a
           breakpoint, bypasses the normal `IOPL' checks in virtual-8086
           mode, and also does not go through interrupt redirection.

B.4.124 `INTO': Interrupt if Overflow

       INTO                          ; CE                   [8086]

       `INTO' performs an `INT 4' software interrupt (see section B.4.122)
       if and only if the overflow flag is set.

B.4.125 `INVD': Invalidate Internal Caches

       INVD                          ; 0F 08                [486]

       `INVD' invalidates and empties the processor's internal caches, and
       causes the processor to instruct external caches to do the same. It
       does not write the contents of the caches back to memory first: any
       modified data held in the caches will be lost. To write the data
       back first, use `WBINVD' (section B.4.328).

B.4.126 `INVLPG': Invalidate TLB Entry

       INVLPG mem                    ; 0F 01 /7             [486]

       `INVLPG' invalidates the translation lookahead buffer (TLB) entry
       associated with the supplied memory address.

B.4.127 `IRET', `IRETW', `IRETD': Return from Interrupt

       IRET                          ; CF                   [8086] 
       IRETW                         ; o16 CF               [8086] 
       IRETD                         ; o32 CF               [386]

       `IRET' returns from an interrupt (hardware or software) by means of
       popping `IP' (or `EIP'), `CS' and the flags off the stack and then
       continuing execution from the new `CS:IP'.

       `IRETW' pops `IP', `CS' and the flags as 2 bytes each, taking 6
       bytes off the stack in total. `IRETD' pops `EIP' as 4 bytes, pops a
       further 4 bytes of which the top two are discarded and the bottom
       two go into `CS', and pops the flags as 4 bytes as well, taking 12
       bytes off the stack.

       `IRET' is a shorthand for either `IRETW' or `IRETD', depending on
       the default `BITS' setting at the time.

B.4.128 `Jcc': Conditional Branch

       Jcc imm                       ; 70+cc rb             [8086] 
       Jcc NEAR imm                  ; 0F 80+cc rw/rd       [386]

       The conditional jump instructions execute a near (same segment) jump
       if and only if their conditions are satisfied. For example, `JNZ'
       jumps only if the zero flag is not set.

       The ordinary form of the instructions has only a 128-byte range; the
       `NEAR' form is a 386 extension to the instruction set, and can span
       the full size of a segment. NASM will not override your choice of
       jump instruction: if you want `Jcc NEAR', you have to use the `NEAR'
       keyword.

       The `SHORT' keyword is allowed on the first form of the instruction,
       for clarity, but is not necessary.

       For details of the condition codes, see section B.2.2.

B.4.129 `JCXZ', `JECXZ': Jump if CX/ECX Zero

       JCXZ imm                      ; a16 E3 rb            [8086] 
       JECXZ imm                     ; a32 E3 rb            [386]

       `JCXZ' performs a short jump (with maximum range 128 bytes) if and
       only if the contents of the `CX' register is 0. `JECXZ' does the
       same thing, but with `ECX'.

B.4.130 `JMP': Jump

       JMP imm                       ; E9 rw/rd             [8086] 
       JMP SHORT imm                 ; EB rb                [8086] 
       JMP imm:imm16                 ; o16 EA iw iw         [8086] 
       JMP imm:imm32                 ; o32 EA id iw         [386] 
       JMP FAR mem                   ; o16 FF /5            [8086] 
       JMP FAR mem32                 ; o32 FF /5            [386] 
       JMP r/m16                     ; o16 FF /4            [8086] 
       JMP r/m32                     ; o32 FF /4            [386]

       `JMP' jumps to a given address. The address may be specified as an
       absolute segment and offset, or as a relative jump within the
       current segment.

       `JMP SHORT imm' has a maximum range of 128 bytes, since the
       displacement is specified as only 8 bits, but takes up less code
       space. NASM does not choose when to generate `JMP SHORT' for you:
       you must explicitly code `SHORT' every time you want a short jump.

       You can choose between the two immediate far jump forms
       (`JMP imm:imm') by the use of the `WORD' and `DWORD' keywords:
       `JMP WORD 0x1234:0x5678') or `JMP DWORD 0x1234:0x56789abc'.

       The `JMP FAR mem' forms execute a far jump by loading the
       destination address out of memory. The address loaded consists of 16
       or 32 bits of offset (depending on the operand size), and 16 bits of
       segment. The operand size may be overridden using `JMP WORD FAR mem'
       or `JMP DWORD FAR mem'.

       The `JMP r/m' forms execute a near jump (within the same segment),
       loading the destination address out of memory or out of a register.
       The keyword `NEAR' may be specified, for clarity, in these forms,
       but is not necessary. Again, operand size can be overridden using
       `JMP WORD mem' or `JMP DWORD mem'.

       As a convenience, NASM does not require you to jump to a far symbol
       by coding the cumbersome `JMP SEG routine:routine', but instead
       allows the easier synonym `JMP FAR routine'.

       The `CALL r/m' forms given above are near calls; NASM will accept
       the `NEAR' keyword (e.g. `CALL NEAR [address]'), even though it is
       not strictly necessary.

B.4.131 `LAHF': Load AH from Flags

       LAHF                          ; 9F                   [8086]

       `LAHF' sets the `AH' register according to the contents of the low
       byte of the flags word.

       The operation of `LAHF' is:

        AH <-- SF:ZF:0:AF:0:PF:1:CF

       See also `SAHF' (section B.4.282).

B.4.132 `LAR': Load Access Rights

       LAR reg16,r/m16               ; o16 0F 02 /r         [286,PRIV] 
       LAR reg32,r/m32               ; o32 0F 02 /r         [286,PRIV]

       `LAR' takes the segment selector specified by its source (second)
       operand, finds the corresponding segment descriptor in the GDT or
       LDT, and loads the access-rights byte of the descriptor into its
       destination (first) operand.

B.4.133 `LDMXCSR': Load Streaming SIMD Extension Control/Status

       LDMXCSR mem32                 ; 0F AE /2        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `LDMXCSR' loads 32-bits of data from the specified memory location
       into the `MXCSR' control/status register. `MXCSR' is used to enable
       masked/unmasked exception handling, to set rounding modes, to set
       flush-to-zero mode, and to view exception status flags.

       For details of the `MXCSR' register, see the Intel processor docs.

       See also `STMXCSR' (section B.4.302

B.4.134 `LDS', `LES', `LFS', `LGS', `LSS': Load Far Pointer

       LDS reg16,mem                 ; o16 C5 /r            [8086] 
       LDS reg32,mem                 ; o32 C5 /r            [386]

       LES reg16,mem                 ; o16 C4 /r            [8086] 
       LES reg32,mem                 ; o32 C4 /r            [386]

       LFS reg16,mem                 ; o16 0F B4 /r         [386] 
       LFS reg32,mem                 ; o32 0F B4 /r         [386]

       LGS reg16,mem                 ; o16 0F B5 /r         [386] 
       LGS reg32,mem                 ; o32 0F B5 /r         [386]

       LSS reg16,mem                 ; o16 0F B2 /r         [386] 
       LSS reg32,mem                 ; o32 0F B2 /r         [386]

       These instructions load an entire far pointer (16 or 32 bits of
       offset, plus 16 bits of segment) out of memory in one go. `LDS', for
       example, loads 16 or 32 bits from the given memory address into the
       given register (depending on the size of the register), then loads
       the _next_ 16 bits from memory into `DS'. `LES', `LFS', `LGS' and
       `LSS' work in the same way but use the other segment registers.

B.4.135 `LEA': Load Effective Address

       LEA reg16,mem                 ; o16 8D /r            [8086] 
       LEA reg32,mem                 ; o32 8D /r            [386]

       `LEA', despite its syntax, does not access memory. It calculates the
       effective address specified by its second operand as if it were
       going to load or store data from it, but instead it stores the
       calculated address into the register specified by its first operand.
       This can be used to perform quite complex calculations (e.g.
       `LEA EAX,[EBX+ECX*4+100]') in one instruction.

       `LEA', despite being a purely arithmetic instruction which accesses
       no memory, still requires square brackets around its second operand,
       as if it were a memory reference.

       The size of the calculation is the current _address_ size, and the
       size that the result is stored as is the current _operand_ size. If
       the address and operand size are not the same, then if the
       addressing mode was 32-bits, the low 16-bits are stored, and if the
       address was 16-bits, it is zero-extended to 32-bits before storing.

B.4.136 `LEAVE': Destroy Stack Frame

       LEAVE                         ; C9                   [186]

       `LEAVE' destroys a stack frame of the form created by the `ENTER'
       instruction (see section B.4.65). It is functionally equivalent to
       `MOV ESP,EBP' followed by `POP EBP' (or `MOV SP,BP' followed by
       `POP BP' in 16-bit mode).

B.4.137 `LFENCE': Load Fence

       LFENCE                        ; 0F AE /5        [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `LFENCE' performs a serialising operation on all loads from memory
       that were issued before the `LFENCE' instruction. This guarantees
       that all memory reads before the `LFENCE' instruction are visible
       before any reads after the `LFENCE' instruction.

       `LFENCE' is ordered respective to other `LFENCE' instruction,
       `MFENCE', any memory read and any other serialising instruction
       (such as `CPUID').

       Weakly ordered memory types can be used to achieve higher processor
       performance through such techniques as out-of-order issue and
       speculative reads. The degree to which a consumer of data recognizes
       or knows that the data is weakly ordered varies among applications
       and may be unknown to the producer of this data. The `LFENCE'
       instruction provides a performance-efficient way of ensuring load
       ordering between routines that produce weakly-ordered results and
       routines that consume that data.

       `LFENCE' uses the following ModRM encoding:

                 Mod (7:6)        = 11B 
                 Reg/Opcode (5:3) = 101B 
                 R/M (2:0)        = 000B

       All other ModRM encodings are defined to be reserved, and use of
       these encodings risks incompatibility with future processors.

       See also `SFENCE' (section B.4.288) and `MFENCE' (section B.4.151).

B.4.138 `LGDT', `LIDT', `LLDT': Load Descriptor Tables

       LGDT mem                      ; 0F 01 /2             [286,PRIV] 
       LIDT mem                      ; 0F 01 /3             [286,PRIV] 
       LLDT r/m16                    ; 0F 00 /2             [286,PRIV]

       `LGDT' and `LIDT' both take a 6-byte memory area as an operand: they
       load a 32-bit linear address and a 16-bit size limit from that area
       (in the opposite order) into the `GDTR' (global descriptor table
       register) or `IDTR' (interrupt descriptor table register). These are
       the only instructions which directly use _linear_ addresses, rather
       than segment/offset pairs.

       `LLDT' takes a segment selector as an operand. The processor looks
       up that selector in the GDT and stores the limit and base address
       given there into the `LDTR' (local descriptor table register).

       See also `SGDT', `SIDT' and `SLDT' (section B.4.289).

B.4.139 `LMSW': Load/Store Machine Status Word

       LMSW r/m16                    ; 0F 01 /6             [286,PRIV]

       `LMSW' loads the bottom four bits of the source operand into the
       bottom four bits of the `CR0' control register (or the Machine
       Status Word, on 286 processors). See also `SMSW' (section B.4.296).

B.4.140 `LOADALL', `LOADALL286': Load Processor State

       LOADALL                       ; 0F 07                [386,UNDOC] 
       LOADALL286                    ; 0F 05                [286,UNDOC]

       This instruction, in its two different-opcode forms, is apparently
       supported on most 286 processors, some 386 and possibly some 486.
       The opcode differs between the 286 and the 386.

       The function of the instruction is to load all information relating
       to the state of the processor out of a block of memory: on the 286,
       this block is located implicitly at absolute address `0x800', and on
       the 386 and 486 it is at `[ES:EDI]'.

B.4.141 `LODSB', `LODSW', `LODSD': Load from String

       LODSB                         ; AC                   [8086] 
       LODSW                         ; o16 AD               [8086] 
       LODSD                         ; o32 AD               [386]

       `LODSB' loads a byte from `[DS:SI]' or `[DS:ESI]' into `AL'. It then
       increments or decrements (depending on the direction flag:
       increments if the flag is clear, decrements if it is set) `SI' or
       `ESI'.

       The register used is `SI' if the address size is 16 bits, and `ESI'
       if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not equal to
       the current `BITS' setting, you can use an explicit `a16' or `a32'
       prefix.

       The segment register used to load from `[SI]' or `[ESI]' can be
       overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
       example, `ES LODSB').

       `LODSW' and `LODSD' work in the same way, but they load a word or a
       doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
       addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.

B.4.142 `LOOP', `LOOPE', `LOOPZ', `LOOPNE', `LOOPNZ': Loop with Counter

       LOOP imm                      ; E2 rb                [8086] 
       LOOP imm,CX                   ; a16 E2 rb            [8086] 
       LOOP imm,ECX                  ; a32 E2 rb            [386]

       LOOPE imm                     ; E1 rb                [8086] 
       LOOPE imm,CX                  ; a16 E1 rb            [8086] 
       LOOPE imm,ECX                 ; a32 E1 rb            [386] 
       LOOPZ imm                     ; E1 rb                [8086] 
       LOOPZ imm,CX                  ; a16 E1 rb            [8086] 
       LOOPZ imm,ECX                 ; a32 E1 rb            [386]

       LOOPNE imm                    ; E0 rb                [8086] 
       LOOPNE imm,CX                 ; a16 E0 rb            [8086] 
       LOOPNE imm,ECX                ; a32 E0 rb            [386] 
       LOOPNZ imm                    ; E0 rb                [8086] 
       LOOPNZ imm,CX                 ; a16 E0 rb            [8086] 
       LOOPNZ imm,ECX                ; a32 E0 rb            [386]

       `LOOP' decrements its counter register (either `CX' or `ECX' - if
       one is not specified explicitly, the `BITS' setting dictates which
       is used) by one, and if the counter does not become zero as a result
       of this operation, it jumps to the given label. The jump has a range
       of 128 bytes.

       `LOOPE' (or its synonym `LOOPZ') adds the additional condition that
       it only jumps if the counter is nonzero _and_ the zero flag is set.
       Similarly, `LOOPNE' (and `LOOPNZ') jumps only if the counter is
       nonzero and the zero flag is clear.

B.4.143 `LSL': Load Segment Limit

       LSL reg16,r/m16               ; o16 0F 03 /r         [286,PRIV] 
       LSL reg32,r/m32               ; o32 0F 03 /r         [286,PRIV]

       `LSL' is given a segment selector in its source (second) operand; it
       computes the segment limit value by loading the segment limit field
       from the associated segment descriptor in the `GDT' or `LDT'. (This
       involves shifting left by 12 bits if the segment limit is page-
       granular, and not if it is byte-granular; so you end up with a byte
       limit in either case.) The segment limit obtained is then loaded
       into the destination (first) operand.

B.4.144 `LTR': Load Task Register

       LTR r/m16                     ; 0F 00 /3             [286,PRIV]

       `LTR' looks up the segment base and limit in the GDT or LDT
       descriptor specified by the segment selector given as its operand,
       and loads them into the Task Register.

B.4.145 `MASKMOVDQU': Byte Mask Write

       MASKMOVDQU xmm1,xmm2          ; 66 0F F7 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MASKMOVDQU' stores data from xmm1 to the location specified by
       `ES:(E)DI'. The size of the store depends on the address-size
       attribute. The most significant bit in each byte of the mask
       register xmm2 is used to selectively write the data (0 = no write, 1
       = write) on a per-byte basis.

B.4.146 `MASKMOVQ': Byte Mask Write

       MASKMOVQ mm1,mm2              ; 0F F7 /r        [KATMAI,MMX]

       `MASKMOVQ' stores data from mm1 to the location specified by
       `ES:(E)DI'. The size of the store depends on the address-size
       attribute. The most significant bit in each byte of the mask
       register mm2 is used to selectively write the data (0 = no write, 1
       = write) on a per-byte basis.

B.4.147 `MAXPD': Return Packed Double-Precision FP Maximum

       MAXPD xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F 5F /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MAXPD' performs a SIMD compare of the packed double-precision FP
       numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum values of
       each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are both
       zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
       (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
       destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).

B.4.148 `MAXPS': Return Packed Single-Precision FP Maximum

       MAXPS xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 0F 5F /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MAXPS' performs a SIMD compare of the packed single-precision FP
       numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum values of
       each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are both
       zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
       (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
       destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).

B.4.149 `MAXSD': Return Scalar Double-Precision FP Maximum

       MAXSD xmm1,xmm2/m64           ; F2 0F 5F /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MAXSD' compares the low-order double-precision FP numbers from xmm1
       and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum value in xmm1. If the values
       being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m64) would be
       returned. If source2 (xmm2/m64) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded
       unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is
       not returned). The high quadword of the destination is left
       unchanged.

B.4.150 `MAXSS': Return Scalar Single-Precision FP Maximum

       MAXSS xmm1,xmm2/m32           ; F3 0F 5F /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MAXSS' compares the low-order single-precision FP numbers from xmm1
       and xmm2/mem, and stores the maximum value in xmm1. If the values
       being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m32) would be
       returned. If source2 (xmm2/m32) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded
       unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is
       not returned). The high three doublewords of the destination are
       left unchanged.

B.4.151 `MFENCE': Memory Fence

       MFENCE                        ; 0F AE /6        [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MFENCE' performs a serialising operation on all loads from memory
       and writes to memory that were issued before the `MFENCE'
       instruction. This guarantees that all memory reads and writes before
       the `MFENCE' instruction are completed before any reads and writes
       after the `MFENCE' instruction.

       `MFENCE' is ordered respective to other `MFENCE' instructions,
       `LFENCE', `SFENCE', any memory read and any other serialising
       instruction (such as `CPUID').

       Weakly ordered memory types can be used to achieve higher processor
       performance through such techniques as out-of-order issue,
       speculative reads, write-combining, and write-collapsing. The degree
       to which a consumer of data recognizes or knows that the data is
       weakly ordered varies among applications and may be unknown to the
       producer of this data. The `MFENCE' instruction provides a
       performance-efficient way of ensuring load and store ordering
       between routines that produce weakly-ordered results and routines
       that consume that data.

       `MFENCE' uses the following ModRM encoding:

                 Mod (7:6)        = 11B 
                 Reg/Opcode (5:3) = 110B 
                 R/M (2:0)        = 000B

       All other ModRM encodings are defined to be reserved, and use of
       these encodings risks incompatibility with future processors.

       See also `LFENCE' (section B.4.137) and `SFENCE' (section B.4.288).

B.4.152 `MINPD': Return Packed Double-Precision FP Minimum

       MINPD xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F 5D /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MINPD' performs a SIMD compare of the packed double-precision FP
       numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum values of
       each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are both
       zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
       (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
       destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).

B.4.153 `MINPS': Return Packed Single-Precision FP Minimum

       MINPS xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 0F 5D /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MINPS' performs a SIMD compare of the packed single-precision FP
       numbers from xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum values of
       each pair of values in xmm1. If the values being compared are both
       zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m128) would be returned. If source2
       (xmm2/m128) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded unchanged to the
       destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is not returned).

B.4.154 `MINSD': Return Scalar Double-Precision FP Minimum

       MINSD xmm1,xmm2/m64           ; F2 0F 5D /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MINSD' compares the low-order double-precision FP numbers from xmm1
       and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum value in xmm1. If the values
       being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m64) would be
       returned. If source2 (xmm2/m64) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded
       unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is
       not returned). The high quadword of the destination is left
       unchanged.

B.4.155 `MINSS': Return Scalar Single-Precision FP Minimum

       MINSS xmm1,xmm2/m32           ; F3 0F 5D /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MINSS' compares the low-order single-precision FP numbers from xmm1
       and xmm2/mem, and stores the minimum value in xmm1. If the values
       being compared are both zeroes, source2 (xmm2/m32) would be
       returned. If source2 (xmm2/m32) is an SNaN, this SNaN is forwarded
       unchanged to the destination (i.e., a QNaN version of the SNaN is
       not returned). The high three doublewords of the destination are
       left unchanged.

B.4.156 `MOV': Move Data

       MOV r/m8,reg8                 ; 88 /r                [8086] 
       MOV r/m16,reg16               ; o16 89 /r            [8086] 
       MOV r/m32,reg32               ; o32 89 /r            [386] 
       MOV reg8,r/m8                 ; 8A /r                [8086] 
       MOV reg16,r/m16               ; o16 8B /r            [8086] 
       MOV reg32,r/m32               ; o32 8B /r            [386]

       MOV reg8,imm8                 ; B0+r ib              [8086] 
       MOV reg16,imm16               ; o16 B8+r iw          [8086] 
       MOV reg32,imm32               ; o32 B8+r id          [386] 
       MOV r/m8,imm8                 ; C6 /0 ib             [8086] 
       MOV r/m16,imm16               ; o16 C7 /0 iw         [8086] 
       MOV r/m32,imm32               ; o32 C7 /0 id         [386]

       MOV AL,memoffs8               ; A0 ow/od             [8086] 
       MOV AX,memoffs16              ; o16 A1 ow/od         [8086] 
       MOV EAX,memoffs32             ; o32 A1 ow/od         [386] 
       MOV memoffs8,AL               ; A2 ow/od             [8086] 
       MOV memoffs16,AX              ; o16 A3 ow/od         [8086] 
       MOV memoffs32,EAX             ; o32 A3 ow/od         [386]

       MOV r/m16,segreg              ; o16 8C /r            [8086] 
       MOV r/m32,segreg              ; o32 8C /r            [386] 
       MOV segreg,r/m16              ; o16 8E /r            [8086] 
       MOV segreg,r/m32              ; o32 8E /r            [386]

       MOV reg32,CR0/2/3/4           ; 0F 20 /r             [386] 
       MOV reg32,DR0/1/2/3/6/7       ; 0F 21 /r             [386] 
       MOV reg32,TR3/4/5/6/7         ; 0F 24 /r             [386] 
       MOV CR0/2/3/4,reg32           ; 0F 22 /r             [386] 
       MOV DR0/1/2/3/6/7,reg32       ; 0F 23 /r             [386] 
       MOV TR3/4/5/6/7,reg32         ; 0F 26 /r             [386]

       `MOV' copies the contents of its source (second) operand into its
       destination (first) operand.

       In all forms of the `MOV' instruction, the two operands are the same
       size, except for moving between a segment register and an `r/m32'
       operand. These instructions are treated exactly like the
       corresponding 16-bit equivalent (so that, for example, `MOV DS,EAX'
       functions identically to `MOV DS,AX' but saves a prefix when in 32-
       bit mode), except that when a segment register is moved into a 32-
       bit destination, the top two bytes of the result are undefined.

       `MOV' may not use `CS' as a destination.

       `CR4' is only a supported register on the Pentium and above.

       Test registers are supported on 386/486 processors and on some non-
       Intel Pentium class processors.

B.4.157 `MOVAPD': Move Aligned Packed Double-Precision FP Values

       MOVAPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128       ; 66 0F 28 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       MOVAPD xmm1/mem128,xmm2       ; 66 0F 29 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVAPD' moves a double quadword containing 2 packed double-
       precision FP values from the source operand to the destination. When
       the source or destination operand is a memory location, it must be
       aligned on a 16-byte boundary.

       To move data in and out of memory locations that are not known to be
       on 16-byte boundaries, use the `MOVUPD' instruction (section
       B.4.182).

B.4.158 `MOVAPS': Move Aligned Packed Single-Precision FP Values

       MOVAPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128       ; 0F 28 /r        [KATMAI,SSE] 
       MOVAPS xmm1/mem128,xmm2       ; 0F 29 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MOVAPS' moves a double quadword containing 4 packed single-
       precision FP values from the source operand to the destination. When
       the source or destination operand is a memory location, it must be
       aligned on a 16-byte boundary.

       To move data in and out of memory locations that are not known to be
       on 16-byte boundaries, use the `MOVUPS' instruction (section
       B.4.183).

B.4.159 `MOVD': Move Doubleword to/from MMX Register

       MOVD mm,r/m32                 ; 0F 6E /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       MOVD r/m32,mm                 ; 0F 7E /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       MOVD xmm,r/m32                ; 66 0F 6E /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       MOVD r/m32,xmm                ; 66 0F 7E /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVD' copies 32 bits from its source (second) operand into its
       destination (first) operand. When the destination is a 64-bit `MMX'
       register or a 128-bit `XMM' register, the input value is zero-
       extended to fill the destination register.

B.4.160 `MOVDQ2Q': Move Quadword from XMM to MMX register.

       MOVDQ2Q mm,xmm                ; F2 OF D6 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVDQ2Q' moves the low quadword from the source operand to the
       destination operand.

B.4.161 `MOVDQA': Move Aligned Double Quadword

       MOVDQA xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 OF 6F /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       MOVDQA xmm1/m128,xmm2         ; 66 OF 7F /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVDQA' moves a double quadword from the source operand to the
       destination operand. When the source or destination operand is a
       memory location, it must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.

       To move a double quadword to or from unaligned memory locations, use
       the `MOVDQU' instruction (section B.4.162).

B.4.162 `MOVDQU': Move Unaligned Double Quadword

       MOVDQU xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; F3 OF 6F /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       MOVDQU xmm1/m128,xmm2         ; F3 OF 7F /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVDQU' moves a double quadword from the source operand to the
       destination operand. When the source or destination operand is a
       memory location, the memory may be unaligned.

       To move a double quadword to or from known aligned memory locations,
       use the `MOVDQA' instruction (section B.4.161).

B.4.163 `MOVHLPS': Move Packed Single-Precision FP High to Low

       MOVHLPS xmm1,xmm2             ; OF 12 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MOVHLPS' moves the two packed single-precision FP values from the
       high quadword of the source register xmm2 to the low quadword of the
       destination register, xmm2. The upper quadword of xmm1 is left
       unchanged.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          dst[0-63]   := src[64-127], 
          dst[64-127] remains unchanged.

B.4.164 `MOVHPD': Move High Packed Double-Precision FP

       MOVHPD xmm,m64               ; 66 OF 16 /r      [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       MOVHPD m64,xmm               ; 66 OF 17 /r      [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVHPD' moves a double-precision FP value between the source and
       destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit memory
       location, the other is the high quadword of an `XMM' register.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          mem[0-63]   := xmm[64-127];

       or

          xmm[0-63]   remains unchanged; 
          xmm[64-127] := mem[0-63].

B.4.165 `MOVHPS': Move High Packed Single-Precision FP

       MOVHPS xmm,m64               ; 0F 16 /r         [KATMAI,SSE] 
       MOVHPS m64,xmm               ; 0F 17 /r         [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MOVHPS' moves two packed single-precision FP values between the
       source and destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit
       memory location, the other is the high quadword of an `XMM'
       register.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          mem[0-63]   := xmm[64-127];

       or

          xmm[0-63]   remains unchanged; 
          xmm[64-127] := mem[0-63].

B.4.166 `MOVLHPS': Move Packed Single-Precision FP Low to High

       MOVLHPS xmm1,xmm2             ; OF 16 /r         [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MOVLHPS' moves the two packed single-precision FP values from the
       low quadword of the source register xmm2 to the high quadword of the
       destination register, xmm2. The low quadword of xmm1 is left
       unchanged.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          dst[0-63]   remains unchanged; 
          dst[64-127] := src[0-63].

B.4.167 `MOVLPD': Move Low Packed Double-Precision FP

       MOVLPD xmm,m64                ; 66 OF 12 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       MOVLPD m64,xmm                ; 66 OF 13 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVLPD' moves a double-precision FP value between the source and
       destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit memory
       location, the other is the low quadword of an `XMM' register.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          mem(0-63)   := xmm(0-63);

       or

          xmm(0-63)   := mem(0-63); 
          xmm(64-127) remains unchanged.

B.4.168 `MOVLPS': Move Low Packed Single-Precision FP

       MOVLPS xmm,m64                ; OF 12 /r        [KATMAI,SSE] 
       MOVLPS m64,xmm                ; OF 13 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MOVLPS' moves two packed single-precision FP values between the
       source and destination operands. One of the operands is a 64-bit
       memory location, the other is the low quadword of an `XMM' register.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          mem(0-63)   := xmm(0-63);

       or

          xmm(0-63)   := mem(0-63); 
          xmm(64-127) remains unchanged.

B.4.169 `MOVMSKPD': Extract Packed Double-Precision FP Sign Mask

       MOVMSKPD reg32,xmm              ; 66 0F 50 /r   [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVMSKPD' inserts a 2-bit mask in r32, formed of the most
       significant bits of each double-precision FP number of the source
       operand.

B.4.170 `MOVMSKPS': Extract Packed Single-Precision FP Sign Mask

       MOVMSKPS reg32,xmm              ; 0F 50 /r      [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MOVMSKPS' inserts a 4-bit mask in r32, formed of the most
       significant bits of each single-precision FP number of the source
       operand.

B.4.171 `MOVNTDQ': Move Double Quadword Non Temporal

       MOVNTDQ m128,xmm              ; 66 0F E7 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVNTDQ' moves the double quadword from the `XMM' source register
       to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal hint. This
       store instruction minimizes cache pollution.

B.4.172 `MOVNTI': Move Doubleword Non Temporal

       MOVNTI m32,reg32              ; 0F C3 /r        [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVNTI' moves the doubleword in the source register to the
       destination memory location, using a non-temporal hint. This store
       instruction minimizes cache pollution.

B.4.173 `MOVNTPD': Move Aligned Four Packed Single-Precision FP Values Non Temporal

       MOVNTPD m128,xmm              ; 66 0F 2B /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVNTPD' moves the double quadword from the `XMM' source register
       to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal hint. This
       store instruction minimizes cache pollution. The memory location
       must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.

B.4.174 `MOVNTPS': Move Aligned Four Packed Single-Precision FP Values Non Temporal

       MOVNTPS m128,xmm              ; 0F 2B /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MOVNTPS' moves the double quadword from the `XMM' source register
       to the destination memory location, using a non-temporal hint. This
       store instruction minimizes cache pollution. The memory location
       must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.

B.4.175 `MOVNTQ': Move Quadword Non Temporal

       MOVNTQ m64,mm                 ; 0F E7 /r        [KATMAI,MMX]

       `MOVNTQ' moves the quadword in the `MMX' source register to the
       destination memory location, using a non-temporal hint. This store
       instruction minimizes cache pollution.

B.4.176 `MOVQ': Move Quadword to/from MMX Register

       MOVQ mm1,mm2/m64               ; 0F 6F /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       MOVQ mm1/m64,mm2               ; 0F 7F /r             [PENT,MMX]

       MOVQ xmm1,xmm2/m64             ; F3 0F 7E /r    [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       MOVQ xmm1/m64,xmm2             ; 66 0F D6 /r    [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVQ' copies 64 bits from its source (second) operand into its
       destination (first) operand. When the source is an `XMM' register,
       the low quadword is moved. When the destination is an `XMM'
       register, the destination is the low quadword, and the high quadword
       is cleared.

B.4.177 `MOVQ2DQ': Move Quadword from MMX to XMM register.

       MOVQ2DQ xmm,mm                ; F3 OF D6 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVQ2DQ' moves the quadword from the source operand to the low
       quadword of the destination operand, and clears the high quadword.

B.4.178 `MOVSB', `MOVSW', `MOVSD': Move String

       MOVSB                         ; A4                   [8086] 
       MOVSW                         ; o16 A5               [8086] 
       MOVSD                         ; o32 A5               [386]

       `MOVSB' copies the byte at `[DS:SI]' or `[DS:ESI]' to `[ES:DI]' or
       `[ES:EDI]'. It then increments or decrements (depending on the
       direction flag: increments if the flag is clear, decrements if it is
       set) `SI' and `DI' (or `ESI' and `EDI').

       The registers used are `SI' and `DI' if the address size is 16 bits,
       and `ESI' and `EDI' if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address
       size not equal to the current `BITS' setting, you can use an
       explicit `a16' or `a32' prefix.

       The segment register used to load from `[SI]' or `[ESI]' can be
       overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
       example, `es movsb'). The use of `ES' for the store to `[DI]' or
       `[EDI]' cannot be overridden.

       `MOVSW' and `MOVSD' work in the same way, but they copy a word or a
       doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
       addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.

       The `REP' prefix may be used to repeat the instruction `CX' (or
       `ECX' - again, the address size chooses which) times.

B.4.179 `MOVSD': Move Scalar Double-Precision FP Value

       MOVSD xmm1,xmm2/m64           ; F2 0F 10 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       MOVSD xmm1/m64,xmm2           ; F2 0F 11 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVSD' moves a double-precision FP value from the source operand to
       the destination operand. When the source or destination is a
       register, the low-order FP value is read or written.

B.4.180 `MOVSS': Move Scalar Single-Precision FP Value

       MOVSS xmm1,xmm2/m32           ; F3 0F 10 /r     [KATMAI,SSE] 
       MOVSS xmm1/m32,xmm2           ; F3 0F 11 /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MOVSS' moves a single-precision FP value from the source operand to
       the destination operand. When the source or destination is a
       register, the low-order FP value is read or written.

B.4.181 `MOVSX', `MOVZX': Move Data with Sign or Zero Extend

       MOVSX reg16,r/m8              ; o16 0F BE /r         [386] 
       MOVSX reg32,r/m8              ; o32 0F BE /r         [386] 
       MOVSX reg32,r/m16             ; o32 0F BF /r         [386]

       MOVZX reg16,r/m8              ; o16 0F B6 /r         [386] 
       MOVZX reg32,r/m8              ; o32 0F B6 /r         [386] 
       MOVZX reg32,r/m16             ; o32 0F B7 /r         [386]

       `MOVSX' sign-extends its source (second) operand to the length of
       its destination (first) operand, and copies the result into the
       destination operand. `MOVZX' does the same, but zero-extends rather
       than sign-extending.

B.4.182 `MOVUPD': Move Unaligned Packed Double-Precision FP Values

       MOVUPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128       ; 66 0F 10 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       MOVUPD xmm1/mem128,xmm2       ; 66 0F 11 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MOVUPD' moves a double quadword containing 2 packed double-
       precision FP values from the source operand to the destination. This
       instruction makes no assumptions about alignment of memory operands.

       To move data in and out of memory locations that are known to be on
       16-byte boundaries, use the `MOVAPD' instruction (section B.4.157).

B.4.183 `MOVUPS': Move Unaligned Packed Single-Precision FP Values

       MOVUPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128       ; 0F 10 /r        [KATMAI,SSE] 
       MOVUPS xmm1/mem128,xmm2       ; 0F 11 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MOVUPS' moves a double quadword containing 4 packed single-
       precision FP values from the source operand to the destination. This
       instruction makes no assumptions about alignment of memory operands.

       To move data in and out of memory locations that are known to be on
       16-byte boundaries, use the `MOVAPS' instruction (section B.4.158).

B.4.184 `MUL': Unsigned Integer Multiply

       MUL r/m8                      ; F6 /4                [8086] 
       MUL r/m16                     ; o16 F7 /4            [8086] 
       MUL r/m32                     ; o32 F7 /4            [386]

       `MUL' performs unsigned integer multiplication. The other operand to
       the multiplication, and the destination operand, are implicit, in
       the following way:

       (*) For `MUL r/m8', `AL' is multiplied by the given operand; the
           product is stored in `AX'.

       (*) For `MUL r/m16', `AX' is multiplied by the given operand; the
           product is stored in `DX:AX'.

       (*) For `MUL r/m32', `EAX' is multiplied by the given operand; the
           product is stored in `EDX:EAX'.

       Signed integer multiplication is performed by the `IMUL'
       instruction: see section B.4.118.

B.4.185 `MULPD': Packed Single-FP Multiply

       MULPD xmm1,xmm2/mem128        ; 66 0F 59 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MULPD' performs a SIMD multiply of the packed double-precision FP
       values in both operands, and stores the results in the destination
       register.

B.4.186 `MULPS': Packed Single-FP Multiply

       MULPS xmm1,xmm2/mem128        ; 0F 59 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MULPS' performs a SIMD multiply of the packed single-precision FP
       values in both operands, and stores the results in the destination
       register.

B.4.187 `MULSD': Scalar Single-FP Multiply

       MULSD xmm1,xmm2/mem32         ; F2 0F 59 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `MULSD' multiplies the lowest double-precision FP values of both
       operands, and stores the result in the low quadword of xmm1.

B.4.188 `MULSS': Scalar Single-FP Multiply

       MULSS xmm1,xmm2/mem32         ; F3 0F 59 /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `MULSS' multiplies the lowest single-precision FP values of both
       operands, and stores the result in the low doubleword of xmm1.

B.4.189 `NEG', `NOT': Two's and One's Complement

       NEG r/m8                      ; F6 /3                [8086] 
       NEG r/m16                     ; o16 F7 /3            [8086] 
       NEG r/m32                     ; o32 F7 /3            [386]

       NOT r/m8                      ; F6 /2                [8086] 
       NOT r/m16                     ; o16 F7 /2            [8086] 
       NOT r/m32                     ; o32 F7 /2            [386]

       `NEG' replaces the contents of its operand by the two's complement
       negation (invert all the bits and then add one) of the original
       value. `NOT', similarly, performs one's complement (inverts all the
       bits).

B.4.190 `NOP': No Operation

       NOP                           ; 90                   [8086]

       `NOP' performs no operation. Its opcode is the same as that
       generated by `XCHG AX,AX' or `XCHG EAX,EAX' (depending on the
       processor mode; see section B.4.333).

B.4.191 `OR': Bitwise OR

       OR r/m8,reg8                  ; 08 /r                [8086] 
       OR r/m16,reg16                ; o16 09 /r            [8086] 
       OR r/m32,reg32                ; o32 09 /r            [386]

       OR reg8,r/m8                  ; 0A /r                [8086] 
       OR reg16,r/m16                ; o16 0B /r            [8086] 
       OR reg32,r/m32                ; o32 0B /r            [386]

       OR r/m8,imm8                  ; 80 /1 ib             [8086] 
       OR r/m16,imm16                ; o16 81 /1 iw         [8086] 
       OR r/m32,imm32                ; o32 81 /1 id         [386]

       OR r/m16,imm8                 ; o16 83 /1 ib         [8086] 
       OR r/m32,imm8                 ; o32 83 /1 ib         [386]

       OR AL,imm8                    ; 0C ib                [8086] 
       OR AX,imm16                   ; o16 0D iw            [8086] 
       OR EAX,imm32                  ; o32 0D id            [386]

       `OR' performs a bitwise OR operation between its two operands (i.e.
       each bit of the result is 1 if and only if at least one of the
       corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
       in the destination (first) operand.

       In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
       first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
       sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
       the `BYTE' qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
       form of the instruction.

       The MMX instruction `POR' (see section B.4.247) performs the same
       operation on the 64-bit MMX registers.

B.4.192 `ORPD': Bit-wise Logical OR of Double-Precision FP Data

       ORPD xmm1,xmm2/m128           ; 66 0F 56 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `ORPD' return a bit-wise logical OR between xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and
       stores the result in xmm1. If the source operand is a memory
       location, it must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.

B.4.193 `ORPS': Bit-wise Logical OR of Single-Precision FP Data

       ORPS xmm1,xmm2/m128           ; 0F 56 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `ORPS' return a bit-wise logical OR between xmm1 and xmm2/mem, and
       stores the result in xmm1. If the source operand is a memory
       location, it must be aligned to a 16-byte boundary.

B.4.194 `OUT': Output Data to I/O Port

       OUT imm8,AL                   ; E6 ib                [8086] 
       OUT imm8,AX                   ; o16 E7 ib            [8086] 
       OUT imm8,EAX                  ; o32 E7 ib            [386] 
       OUT DX,AL                     ; EE                   [8086] 
       OUT DX,AX                     ; o16 EF               [8086] 
       OUT DX,EAX                    ; o32 EF               [386]

       `OUT' writes the contents of the given source register to the
       specified I/O port. The port number may be specified as an immediate
       value if it is between 0 and 255, and otherwise must be stored in
       `DX'. See also `IN' (section B.4.119).

B.4.195 `OUTSB', `OUTSW', `OUTSD': Output String to I/O Port

       OUTSB                         ; 6E                   [186] 
       OUTSW                         ; o16 6F               [186] 
       OUTSD                         ; o32 6F               [386]

       `OUTSB' loads a byte from `[DS:SI]' or `[DS:ESI]' and writes it to
       the I/O port specified in `DX'. It then increments or decrements
       (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag is clear,
       decrements if it is set) `SI' or `ESI'.

       The register used is `SI' if the address size is 16 bits, and `ESI'
       if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not equal to
       the current `BITS' setting, you can use an explicit `a16' or `a32'
       prefix.

       The segment register used to load from `[SI]' or `[ESI]' can be
       overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
       example, `es outsb').

       `OUTSW' and `OUTSD' work in the same way, but they output a word or
       a doubleword instead of a byte, and increment or decrement the
       addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of 1.

       The `REP' prefix may be used to repeat the instruction `CX' (or
       `ECX' - again, the address size chooses which) times.

B.4.196 `PACKSSDW', `PACKSSWB', `PACKUSWB': Pack Data

       PACKSSDW mm1,mm2/m64          ; 0F 6B /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PACKSSWB mm1,mm2/m64          ; 0F 63 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PACKUSWB mm1,mm2/m64          ; 0F 67 /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PACKSSDW xmm1,xmm2/m128       ; 66 0F 6B /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PACKSSWB xmm1,xmm2/m128       ; 66 0F 63 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PACKUSWB xmm1,xmm2/m128       ; 66 0F 67 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       All these instructions start by combining the source and destination
       operands, and then splitting the result in smaller sections which it
       then packs into the destination register. The `MMX' versions pack
       two 64-bit operands into one 64-bit register, while the `SSE'
       versions pack two 128-bit operands into one 128-bit register.

       (*) `PACKSSWB' splits the combined value into words, and then
           reduces the words to bytes, using signed saturation. It then
           packs the bytes into the destination register in the same order
           the words were in.

       (*) `PACKSSDW' performs the same operation as `PACKSSWB', except
           that it reduces doublewords to words, then packs them into the
           destination register.

       (*) `PACKUSWB' performs the same operation as `PACKSSWB', except
           that it uses unsigned saturation when reducing the size of the
           elements.

       To perform signed saturation on a number, it is replaced by the
       largest signed number (`7FFFh' or `7Fh') that _will_ fit, and if it
       is too small it is replaced by the smallest signed number (`8000h'
       or `80h') that will fit. To perform unsigned saturation, the input
       is treated as unsigned, and the input is replaced by the largest
       unsigned number that will fit.

B.4.197 `PADDB', `PADDW', `PADDD': Add Packed Integers

       PADDB mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F FC /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PADDW mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F FD /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PADDD mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F FE /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PADDB xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F FC /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PADDW xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F FD /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PADDD xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F FE /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PADDx' performs packed addition of the two operands, storing the
       result in the destination (first) operand.

       (*) `PADDB' treats the operands as packed bytes, and adds each byte
           individually;

       (*) `PADDW' treats the operands as packed words;

       (*) `PADDD' treats its operands as packed doublewords.

       When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, it
       is wrapped around and the low bits are stored, with the carry bit
       discarded.

B.4.198 `PADDQ': Add Packed Quadword Integers

       PADDQ mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F D4 /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PADDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F D4 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PADDQ' adds the quadwords in the source and destination operands,
       and stores the result in the destination register.

       When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, it
       is wrapped around and the low bits are stored, with the carry bit
       discarded.

B.4.199 `PADDSB', `PADDSW': Add Packed Signed Integers With Saturation

       PADDSB mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F EC /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PADDSW mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F ED /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PADDSB xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F EC /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PADDSW xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F ED /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PADDSx' performs packed addition of the two operands, storing the
       result in the destination (first) operand. `PADDSB' treats the
       operands as packed bytes, and adds each byte individually; and
       `PADDSW' treats the operands as packed words.

       When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, a
       saturated value is stored. The resulting value is the value with the
       largest magnitude of the same sign as the result which will fit in
       the available space.

B.4.200 `PADDSIW': MMX Packed Addition to Implicit Destination

       PADDSIW mmxreg,r/m64          ; 0F 51 /r             [CYRIX,MMX]

       `PADDSIW', specific to the Cyrix extensions to the MMX instruction
       set, performs the same function as `PADDSW', except that the result
       is placed in an implied register.

       To work out the implied register, invert the lowest bit in the
       register number. So `PADDSIW MM0,MM2' would put the result in `MM1',
       but `PADDSIW MM1,MM2' would put the result in `MM0'.

B.4.201 `PADDUSB', `PADDUSW': Add Packed Unsigned Integers With Saturation

       PADDUSB mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F DC /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PADDUSW mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F DD /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PADDUSB xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F DC /r    [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PADDUSW xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F DD /r    [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PADDUSx' performs packed addition of the two operands, storing the
       result in the destination (first) operand. `PADDUSB' treats the
       operands as packed bytes, and adds each byte individually; and
       `PADDUSW' treats the operands as packed words.

       When an individual result is too large to fit in its destination, a
       saturated value is stored. The resulting value is the maximum value
       that will fit in the available space.

B.4.202 `PAND', `PANDN': MMX Bitwise AND and AND-NOT

       PAND mm1,mm2/m64              ; 0F DB /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PANDN mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F DF /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PAND xmm1,xmm2/m128           ; 66 0F DB /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PANDN xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F DF /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PAND' performs a bitwise AND operation between its two operands
       (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if the corresponding
       bits of the two inputs were both 1), and stores the result in the
       destination (first) operand.

       `PANDN' performs the same operation, but performs a one's complement
       operation on the destination (first) operand first.

B.4.203 `PAUSE': Spin Loop Hint

       PAUSE                         ; F3 90           [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PAUSE' provides a hint to the processor that the following code is
       a spin loop. This improves processor performance by bypassing
       possible memory order violations. On older processors, this
       instruction operates as a `NOP'.

B.4.204 `PAVEB': MMX Packed Average

       PAVEB mmxreg,r/m64            ; 0F 50 /r             [CYRIX,MMX]

       `PAVEB', specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats its two
       operands as vectors of eight unsigned bytes, and calculates the
       average of the corresponding bytes in the operands. The resulting
       vector of eight averages is stored in the first operand.

       This opcode maps to `MOVMSKPS r32, xmm' on processors that support
       the SSE instruction set.

B.4.205 `PAVGB' `PAVGW': Average Packed Integers

       PAVGB mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F E0 /r        [KATMAI,MMX] 
       PAVGW mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F E3 /r        [KATMAI,MMX,SM]

       PAVGB xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F E0 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PAVGW xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F E3 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PAVGB' and `PAVGW' add the unsigned data elements of the source
       operand to the unsigned data elements of the destination register,
       then adds 1 to the temporary results. The results of the add are
       then each independently right-shifted by one bit position. The high
       order bits of each element are filled with the carry bits of the
       corresponding sum.

       (*) `PAVGB' operates on packed unsigned bytes, and

       (*) `PAVGW' operates on packed unsigned words.

B.4.206 `PAVGUSB': Average of unsigned packed 8-bit values

       PAVGUSB mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 0F /r BF          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PAVGUSB' adds the unsigned data elements of the source operand to
       the unsigned data elements of the destination register, then adds 1
       to the temporary results. The results of the add are then each
       independently right-shifted by one bit position. The high order bits
       of each element are filled with the carry bits of the corresponding
       sum.

       This instruction performs exactly the same operations as the `PAVGB'
       `MMX' instruction (section B.4.205).

B.4.207 `PCMPxx': Compare Packed Integers.

       PCMPEQB mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 74 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PCMPEQW mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 75 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PCMPEQD mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 76 /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PCMPGTB mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 64 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PCMPGTW mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 65 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PCMPGTD mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 66 /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PCMPEQB xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F 74 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PCMPEQW xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F 75 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PCMPEQD xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F 76 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PCMPGTB xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F 64 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PCMPGTW xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F 65 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PCMPGTD xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F 66 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       The `PCMPxx' instructions all treat their operands as vectors of
       bytes, words, or doublewords; corresponding elements of the source
       and destination are compared, and the corresponding element of the
       destination (first) operand is set to all zeros or all ones
       depending on the result of the comparison.

       (*) `PCMPxxB' treats the operands as vectors of bytes;

       (*) `PCMPxxW' treats the operands as vectors of words;

       (*) `PCMPxxD' treats the operands as vectors of doublewords;

       (*) `PCMPEQx' sets the corresponding element of the destination
           operand to all ones if the two elements compared are equal;

       (*) `PCMPGTx' sets the destination element to all ones if the
           element of the first (destination) operand is greater (treated
           as a signed integer) than that of the second (source) operand.

B.4.208 `PDISTIB': MMX Packed Distance and Accumulate with Implied Register

       PDISTIB mm,m64                ; 0F 54 /r             [CYRIX,MMX]

       `PDISTIB', specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats its two
       input operands as vectors of eight unsigned bytes. For each byte
       position, it finds the absolute difference between the bytes in that
       position in the two input operands, and adds that value to the byte
       in the same position in the implied output register. The addition is
       saturated to an unsigned byte in the same way as `PADDUSB'.

       To work out the implied register, invert the lowest bit in the
       register number. So `PDISTIB MM0,M64' would put the result in `MM1',
       but `PDISTIB MM1,M64' would put the result in `MM0'.

       Note that `PDISTIB' cannot take a register as its second source
       operand.

       Operation:

          dstI[0-7]     := dstI[0-7]   + ABS(src0[0-7] - src1[0-7]), 
          dstI[8-15]    := dstI[8-15]  + ABS(src0[8-15] - src1[8-15]), 
          ....... 
          ....... 
          dstI[56-63]   := dstI[56-63] + ABS(src0[56-63] - src1[56-63]).

B.4.209 `PEXTRW': Extract Word

       PEXTRW reg32,mm,imm8          ; 0F C5 /r ib     [KATMAI,MMX] 
       PEXTRW reg32,xmm,imm8         ; 66 0F C5 /r ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PEXTRW' moves the word in the source register (second operand) that
       is pointed to by the count operand (third operand), into the lower
       half of a 32-bit general purpose register. The upper half of the
       register is cleared to all 0s.

       When the source operand is an `MMX' register, the two least
       significant bits of the count specify the source word. When it is an
       `SSE' register, the three least significant bits specify the word
       location.

B.4.210 `PF2ID': Packed Single-Precision FP to Integer Convert

       PF2ID mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r 1D          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PF2ID' converts two single-precision FP values in the source
       operand to signed 32-bit integers, using truncation, and stores them
       in the destination operand. Source values that are outside the range
       supported by the destination are saturated to the largest absolute
       value of the same sign.

B.4.211 `PF2IW': Packed Single-Precision FP to Integer Word Convert

       PF2IW mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r 1C          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PF2IW' converts two single-precision FP values in the source
       operand to signed 16-bit integers, using truncation, and stores them
       in the destination operand. Source values that are outside the range
       supported by the destination are saturated to the largest absolute
       value of the same sign.

       (*) In the K6-2 and K6-III, the 16-bit value is zero-extended to 32-
           bits before storing.

       (*) In the K6-2+, K6-III+ and Athlon processors, the value is sign-
           extended to 32-bits before storing.

B.4.212 `PFACC': Packed Single-Precision FP Accumulate

       PFACC mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r AE          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFACC' adds the two single-precision FP values from the destination
       operand together, then adds the two single-precision FP values from
       the source operand, and places the results in the low and high
       doublewords of the destination operand.

       The operation is:

          dst[0-31]   := dst[0-31] + dst[32-63], 
          dst[32-63]  := src[0-31] + src[32-63].

B.4.213 `PFADD': Packed Single-Precision FP Addition

       PFADD mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r 9E          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFADD' performs addition on each of two packed single-precision FP
       value pairs.

          dst[0-31]   := dst[0-31]  + src[0-31], 
          dst[32-63]  := dst[32-63] + src[32-63].

B.4.214 `PFCMPxx': Packed Single-Precision FP Compare   

       PFCMPEQ mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 0F /r B0          [PENT,3DNOW] 
       PFCMPGE mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 0F /r 90          [PENT,3DNOW] 
       PFCMPGT mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 0F /r A0          [PENT,3DNOW]

       The `PFCMPxx' instructions compare the packed single-point FP values
       in the source and destination operands, and set the destination
       according to the result. If the condition is true, the destination
       is set to all 1s, otherwise it's set to all 0s.

       (*) `PFCMPEQ' tests whether dst == src;

       (*) `PFCMPGE' tests whether dst >= src;

       (*) `PFCMPGT' tests whether dst > src.

B.4.215 `PFMAX': Packed Single-Precision FP Maximum

       PFMAX mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r A4          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFMAX' returns the higher of each pair of single-precision FP
       values. If the higher value is zero, it is returned as positive
       zero.

B.4.216 `PFMIN': Packed Single-Precision FP Minimum

       PFMIN mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r 94          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFMIN' returns the lower of each pair of single-precision FP
       values. If the lower value is zero, it is returned as positive zero.

B.4.217 `PFMUL': Packed Single-Precision FP Multiply

       PFMUL mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r B4          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFMUL' returns the product of each pair of single-precision FP
       values.

          dst[0-31]  := dst[0-31]  * src[0-31], 
          dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] * src[32-63].

B.4.218 `PFNACC': Packed Single-Precision FP Negative Accumulate

       PFNACC mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F 0F /r 8A          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFNACC' performs a negative accumulate of the two single-precision
       FP values in the source and destination registers. The result of the
       accumulate from the destination register is stored in the low
       doubleword of the destination, and the result of the source
       accumulate is stored in the high doubleword of the destination
       register.

       The operation is:

          dst[0-31]  := dst[0-31] - dst[32-63], 
          dst[32-63] := src[0-31] - src[32-63].

B.4.219 `PFPNACC': Packed Single-Precision FP Mixed Accumulate

       PFPNACC mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 0F /r 8E          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFPNACC' performs a positive accumulate of the two single-precision
       FP values in the source register and a negative accumulate of the
       destination register. The result of the accumulate from the
       destination register is stored in the low doubleword of the
       destination, and the result of the source accumulate is stored in
       the high doubleword of the destination register.

       The operation is:

          dst[0-31]  := dst[0-31] - dst[32-63], 
          dst[32-63] := src[0-31] + src[32-63].

B.4.220 `PFRCP': Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal Approximation

       PFRCP mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r 96          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFRCP' performs a low precision estimate of the reciprocal of the
       low-order single-precision FP value in the source operand, storing
       the result in both halves of the destination register. The result is
       accurate to 14 bits.

       For higher precision reciprocals, this instruction should be
       followed by two more instructions: `PFRCPIT1' (section B.4.221) and
       `PFRCPIT2' (section B.4.221). This will result in a 24-bit accuracy.
       For more details, see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.

B.4.221 `PFRCPIT1': Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal, First Iteration Step

       PFRCPIT1 mm1,mm2/m64          ; 0F 0F /r A6          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFRCPIT1' performs the first intermediate step in the calculation
       of the reciprocal of a single-precision FP value. The first source
       value (`mm1' is the original value, and the second source value
       (`mm2/m64' is the result of a `PFRCP' instruction.

       For the final step in a reciprocal, returning the full 24-bit
       accuracy of a single-precision FP value, see `PFRCPIT2' (section
       B.4.222). For more details, see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.

B.4.222 `PFRCPIT2': Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal/ Reciprocal Square Root, Second Iteration Step

       PFRCPIT2 mm1,mm2/m64          ; 0F 0F /r B6          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFRCPIT2' performs the second and final intermediate step in the
       calculation of a reciprocal or reciprocal square root, refining the
       values returned by the `PFRCP' and `PFRSQRT' instructions,
       respectively.

       The first source value (`mm1') is the output of either a `PFRCPIT1'
       or a `PFRSQIT1' instruction, and the second source is the output of
       either the `PFRCP' or the `PFRSQRT' instruction. For more details,
       see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.

B.4.223 `PFRSQIT1': Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal Square Root, First Iteration Step

       PFRSQIT1 mm1,mm2/m64          ; 0F 0F /r A7          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFRSQIT1' performs the first intermediate step in the calculation
       of the reciprocal square root of a single-precision FP value. The
       first source value (`mm1' is the square of the result of a `PFRSQRT'
       instruction, and the second source value (`mm2/m64' is the original
       value.

       For the final step in a calculation, returning the full 24-bit
       accuracy of a single-precision FP value, see `PFRCPIT2' (section
       B.4.222). For more details, see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.

B.4.224 `PFRSQRT': Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal Square Root Approximation

       PFRSQRT mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 0F /r 97          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFRSQRT' performs a low precision estimate of the reciprocal square
       root of the low-order single-precision FP value in the source
       operand, storing the result in both halves of the destination
       register. The result is accurate to 15 bits.

       For higher precision reciprocals, this instruction should be
       followed by two more instructions: `PFRSQIT1' (section B.4.223) and
       `PFRCPIT2' (section B.4.221). This will result in a 24-bit accuracy.
       For more details, see the AMD 3DNow! technology manual.

B.4.225 `PFSUB': Packed Single-Precision FP Subtract

       PFSUB mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r 9A          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFSUB' subtracts the single-precision FP values in the source from
       those in the destination, and stores the result in the destination
       operand.

          dst[0-31]  := dst[0-31]  - src[0-31], 
          dst[32-63] := dst[32-63] - src[32-63].

B.4.226 `PFSUBR': Packed Single-Precision FP Reverse Subtract

       PFSUBR mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F 0F /r AA          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PFSUBR' subtracts the single-precision FP values in the destination
       from those in the source, and stores the result in the destination
       operand.

          dst[0-31]  := src[0-31]  - dst[0-31], 
          dst[32-63] := src[32-63] - dst[32-63].

B.4.227 `PI2FD': Packed Doubleword Integer to Single-Precision FP Convert

       PI2FD mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r 0D          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PF2ID' converts two signed 32-bit integers in the source operand to
       single-precision FP values, using truncation of significant digits,
       and stores them in the destination operand.

B.4.228 `PF2IW': Packed Word Integer to Single-Precision FP Convert

       PI2FW mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 0F /r 0C          [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PF2IW' converts two signed 16-bit integers in the source operand to
       single-precision FP values, and stores them in the destination
       operand. The input values are in the low word of each doubleword.

B.4.229 `PINSRW': Insert Word

       PINSRW mm,r16/r32/m16,imm8    ;0F C4 /r ib      [KATMAI,MMX] 
       PINSRW xmm,r16/r32/m16,imm8   ;66 0F C4 /r ib   [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PINSRW' loads a word from a 16-bit register (or the low half of a
       32-bit register), or from memory, and loads it to the word position
       in the destination register, pointed at by the count operand (third
       operand). If the destination is an `MMX' register, the low two bits
       of the count byte are used, if it is an `XMM' register the low 3
       bits are used. The insertion is done in such a way that the other
       words from the destination register are left untouched.

B.4.230 `PMACHRIW': Packed Multiply and Accumulate with Rounding

       PMACHRIW mm,m64               ; 0F 5E /r             [CYRIX,MMX]

       `PMACHRIW' takes two packed 16-bit integer inputs, multiplies the
       values in the inputs, rounds on bit 15 of each result, then adds
       bits 15-30 of each result to the corresponding position of the
       _implied_ destination register.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          dstI[0-15]  := dstI[0-15]  + (mm[0-15] *m64[0-15] 
                                                 + 0x00004000)[15-30], 
          dstI[16-31] := dstI[16-31] + (mm[16-31]*m64[16-31] 
                                                 + 0x00004000)[15-30], 
          dstI[32-47] := dstI[32-47] + (mm[32-47]*m64[32-47] 
                                                 + 0x00004000)[15-30], 
          dstI[48-63] := dstI[48-63] + (mm[48-63]*m64[48-63] 
                                                 + 0x00004000)[15-30].

       Note that `PMACHRIW' cannot take a register as its second source
       operand.

B.4.231 `PMADDWD': MMX Packed Multiply and Add

       PMADDWD mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F F5 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PMADDWD xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F F5 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PMADDWD' treats its two inputs as vectors of signed words. It
       multiplies corresponding elements of the two operands, giving
       doubleword results. These are then added together in pairs and
       stored in the destination operand.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          dst[0-31]   := (dst[0-15] * src[0-15]) 
                                      + (dst[16-31] * src[16-31]); 
          dst[32-63]  := (dst[32-47] * src[32-47]) 
                                      + (dst[48-63] * src[48-63]);

       The following apply to the `SSE' version of the instruction:

          dst[64-95]  := (dst[64-79] * src[64-79]) 
                                      + (dst[80-95] * src[80-95]); 
          dst[96-127] := (dst[96-111] * src[96-111]) 
                                      + (dst[112-127] * src[112-127]).

B.4.232 `PMAGW': MMX Packed Magnitude

       PMAGW mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F 52 /r             [CYRIX,MMX]

       `PMAGW', specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, treats both its
       operands as vectors of four signed words. It compares the absolute
       values of the words in corresponding positions, and sets each word
       of the destination (first) operand to whichever of the two words in
       that position had the larger absolute value.

B.4.233 `PMAXSW': Packed Signed Integer Word Maximum

       PMAXSW mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F EE /r        [KATMAI,MMX] 
       PMAXSW xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F EE /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PMAXSW' compares each pair of words in the two source operands, and
       for each pair it stores the maximum value in the destination
       register.

B.4.234 `PMAXUB': Packed Unsigned Integer Byte Maximum

       PMAXUB mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F DE /r        [KATMAI,MMX] 
       PMAXUB xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F DE /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PMAXUB' compares each pair of bytes in the two source operands, and
       for each pair it stores the maximum value in the destination
       register.

B.4.235 `PMINSW': Packed Signed Integer Word Minimum

       PMINSW mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F EA /r        [KATMAI,MMX] 
       PMINSW xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F EA /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PMINSW' compares each pair of words in the two source operands, and
       for each pair it stores the minimum value in the destination
       register.

B.4.236 `PMINUB': Packed Unsigned Integer Byte Minimum

       PMINUB mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F DA /r        [KATMAI,MMX] 
       PMINUB xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F DA /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PMINUB' compares each pair of bytes in the two source operands, and
       for each pair it stores the minimum value in the destination
       register.

B.4.237 `PMOVMSKB': Move Byte Mask To Integer

       PMOVMSKB reg32,mm             ; 0F D7 /r        [KATMAI,MMX] 
       PMOVMSKB reg32,xmm            ; 66 0F D7 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PMOVMSKB' returns an 8-bit or 16-bit mask formed of the most
       significant bits of each byte of source operand (8-bits for an `MMX'
       register, 16-bits for an `XMM' register).

B.4.238 `PMULHRWC', `PMULHRIW': Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers With Rounding, and Store High Word

       PMULHRWC mm1,mm2/m64         ; 0F 59 /r              [CYRIX,MMX] 
       PMULHRIW mm1,mm2/m64         ; 0F 5D /r              [CYRIX,MMX]

       These instructions take two packed 16-bit integer inputs, multiply
       the values in the inputs, round on bit 15 of each result, then store
       bits 15-30 of each result to the corresponding position of the
       destination register.

       (*) For `PMULHRWC', the destination is the first source operand.

       (*) For `PMULHRIW', the destination is an implied register (worked
           out as described for `PADDSIW' (section B.4.200)).

       The operation of this instruction is:

          dst[0-15]  := (src1[0-15] *src2[0-15]  + 0x00004000)[15-30] 
          dst[16-31] := (src1[16-31]*src2[16-31] + 0x00004000)[15-30] 
          dst[32-47] := (src1[32-47]*src2[32-47] + 0x00004000)[15-30] 
          dst[48-63] := (src1[48-63]*src2[48-63] + 0x00004000)[15-30]

       See also `PMULHRWA' (section B.4.239) for a 3DNow! version of this
       instruction.

B.4.239 `PMULHRWA': Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers With Rounding, and Store High Word

       PMULHRWA mm1,mm2/m64          ; 0F 0F /r B7     [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PMULHRWA' takes two packed 16-bit integer inputs, multiplies the
       values in the inputs, rounds on bit 16 of each result, then stores
       bits 16-31 of each result to the corresponding position of the
       destination register.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          dst[0-15]  := (src1[0-15] *src2[0-15]  + 0x00008000)[16-31]; 
          dst[16-31] := (src1[16-31]*src2[16-31] + 0x00008000)[16-31]; 
          dst[32-47] := (src1[32-47]*src2[32-47] + 0x00008000)[16-31]; 
          dst[48-63] := (src1[48-63]*src2[48-63] + 0x00008000)[16-31].

       See also `PMULHRWC' (section B.4.238) for a Cyrix version of this
       instruction.

B.4.240 `PMULHUW': Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers, and Store High Word

       PMULHUW mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F E4 /r        [KATMAI,MMX] 
       PMULHUW xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F E4 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PMULHUW' takes two packed unsigned 16-bit integer inputs,
       multiplies the values in the inputs, then stores bits 16-31 of each
       result to the corresponding position of the destination register.

B.4.241 `PMULHW', `PMULLW': Multiply Packed 16-bit Integers, and Store

       PMULHW mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F E5 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PMULLW mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F D5 /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PMULHW xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F E5 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PMULLW xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F D5 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PMULxW' takes two packed unsigned 16-bit integer inputs, and
       multiplies the values in the inputs, forming doubleword results.

       (*) `PMULHW' then stores the top 16 bits of each doubleword in the
           destination (first) operand;

       (*) `PMULLW' stores the bottom 16 bits of each doubleword in the
           destination operand.

B.4.242 `PMULUDQ': Multiply Packed Unsigned 32-bit Integers, and Store.

       PMULUDQ mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F F4 /r        [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PMULUDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F F4 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PMULUDQ' takes two packed unsigned 32-bit integer inputs, and
       multiplies the values in the inputs, forming quadword results. The
       source is either an unsigned doubleword in the low doubleword of a
       64-bit operand, or it's two unsigned doublewords in the first and
       third doublewords of a 128-bit operand. This produces either one or
       two 64-bit results, which are stored in the respective quadword
       locations of the destination register.

       The operation is:

          dst[0-63]   := dst[0-31]  * src[0-31]; 
          dst[64-127] := dst[64-95] * src[64-95].

B.4.243 `PMVccZB': MMX Packed Conditional Move

       PMVZB mmxreg,mem64            ; 0F 58 /r             [CYRIX,MMX] 
       PMVNZB mmxreg,mem64           ; 0F 5A /r             [CYRIX,MMX] 
       PMVLZB mmxreg,mem64           ; 0F 5B /r             [CYRIX,MMX] 
       PMVGEZB mmxreg,mem64          ; 0F 5C /r             [CYRIX,MMX]

       These instructions, specific to the Cyrix MMX extensions, perform
       parallel conditional moves. The two input operands are treated as
       vectors of eight bytes. Each byte of the destination (first) operand
       is either written from the corresponding byte of the source (second)
       operand, or left alone, depending on the value of the byte in the
       _implied_ operand (specified in the same way as `PADDSIW', in
       section B.4.200).

       (*) `PMVZB' performs each move if the corresponding byte in the
           implied operand is zero;

       (*) `PMVNZB' moves if the byte is non-zero;

       (*) `PMVLZB' moves if the byte is less than zero;

       (*) `PMVGEZB' moves if the byte is greater than or equal to zero.

       Note that these instructions cannot take a register as their second
       source operand.

B.4.244 `POP': Pop Data from Stack

       POP reg16                     ; o16 58+r             [8086] 
       POP reg32                     ; o32 58+r             [386]

       POP r/m16                     ; o16 8F /0            [8086] 
       POP r/m32                     ; o32 8F /0            [386]

       POP CS                        ; 0F                   [8086,UNDOC] 
       POP DS                        ; 1F                   [8086] 
       POP ES                        ; 07                   [8086] 
       POP SS                        ; 17                   [8086] 
       POP FS                        ; 0F A1                [386] 
       POP GS                        ; 0F A9                [386]

       `POP' loads a value from the stack (from `[SS:SP]' or `[SS:ESP]')
       and then increments the stack pointer.

       The address-size attribute of the instruction determines whether
       `SP' or `ESP' is used as the stack pointer: to deliberately override
       the default given by the `BITS' setting, you can use an `a16' or
       `a32' prefix.

       The operand-size attribute of the instruction determines whether the
       stack pointer is incremented by 2 or 4: this means that segment
       register pops in `BITS 32' mode will pop 4 bytes off the stack and
       discard the upper two of them. If you need to override that, you can
       use an `o16' or `o32' prefix.

       The above opcode listings give two forms for general-purpose
       register pop instructions: for example, `POP BX' has the two forms
       `5B' and `8F C3'. NASM will always generate the shorter form when
       given `POP BX'. NDISASM will disassemble both.

       `POP CS' is not a documented instruction, and is not supported on
       any processor above the 8086 (since they use `0Fh' as an opcode
       prefix for instruction set extensions). However, at least some 8086
       processors do support it, and so NASM generates it for completeness.

B.4.245 `POPAx': Pop All General-Purpose Registers

       POPA                          ; 61                   [186] 
       POPAW                         ; o16 61               [186] 
       POPAD                         ; o32 61               [386]

       (*) `POPAW' pops a word from the stack into each of, successively,
           `DI', `SI', `BP', nothing (it discards a word from the stack
           which was a placeholder for `SP'), `BX', `DX', `CX' and `AX'. It
           is intended to reverse the operation of `PUSHAW' (see section
           B.4.264), but it ignores the value for `SP' that was pushed on
           the stack by `PUSHAW'.

       (*) `POPAD' pops twice as much data, and places the results in
           `EDI', `ESI', `EBP', nothing (placeholder for `ESP'), `EBX',
           `EDX', `ECX' and `EAX'. It reverses the operation of `PUSHAD'.

       `POPA' is an alias mnemonic for either `POPAW' or `POPAD', depending
       on the current `BITS' setting.

       Note that the registers are popped in reverse order of their numeric
       values in opcodes (see section B.2.1).

B.4.246 `POPFx': Pop Flags Register

       POPF                          ; 9D                   [8086] 
       POPFW                         ; o16 9D               [8086] 
       POPFD                         ; o32 9D               [386]

       (*) `POPFW' pops a word from the stack and stores it in the bottom
           16 bits of the flags register (or the whole flags register, on
           processors below a 386).

       (*) `POPFD' pops a doubleword and stores it in the entire flags
           register.

       `POPF' is an alias mnemonic for either `POPFW' or `POPFD', depending
       on the current `BITS' setting.

       See also `PUSHF' (section B.4.265).

B.4.247 `POR': MMX Bitwise OR

       POR mm1,mm2/m64               ; 0F EB /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       POR xmm1,xmm2/m128            ; 66 0F EB /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `POR' performs a bitwise OR operation between its two operands (i.e.
       each bit of the result is 1 if and only if at least one of the
       corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
       in the destination (first) operand.

B.4.248 `PREFETCH': Prefetch Data Into Caches

       PREFETCH mem8                 ; 0F 0D /0             [PENT,3DNOW] 
       PREFETCHW mem8                ; 0F 0D /1             [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PREFETCH' and `PREFETCHW' fetch the line of data from memory that
       contains the specified byte. `PREFETCHW' performs differently on the
       Athlon to earlier processors.

       For more details, see the 3DNow! Technology Manual.

B.4.249 `PREFETCHh': Prefetch Data Into Caches    

       PREFETCHNTA m8                ; 0F 18 /0        [KATMAI] 
       PREFETCHT0 m8                 ; 0F 18 /1        [KATMAI] 
       PREFETCHT1 m8                 ; 0F 18 /2        [KATMAI] 
       PREFETCHT2 m8                 ; 0F 18 /3        [KATMAI]

       The `PREFETCHh' instructions fetch the line of data from memory that
       contains the specified byte. It is placed in the cache according to
       rules specified by locality hints `h':

       The hints are:

       (*) `T0' (temporal data) - prefetch data into all levels of the
           cache hierarchy.

       (*) `T1' (temporal data with respect to first level cache) -
           prefetch data into level 2 cache and higher.

       (*) `T2' (temporal data with respect to second level cache) -
           prefetch data into level 2 cache and higher.

       (*) `NTA' (non-temporal data with respect to all cache levels) -
           prefetch data into non-temporal cache structure and into a
           location close to the processor, minimizing cache pollution.

       Note that this group of instructions doesn't provide a guarantee
       that the data will be in the cache when it is needed. For more
       details, see the Intel IA32 Software Developer Manual, Volume 2.

B.4.250 `PSADBW': Packed Sum of Absolute Differences

       PSADBW mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F F6 /r        [KATMAI,MMX] 
       PSADBW xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F F6 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PSADBW' The PSADBW instruction computes the absolute value of the
       difference of the packed unsigned bytes in the two source operands.
       These differences are then summed to produce a word result in the
       lower 16-bit field of the destination register; the rest of the
       register is cleared. The destination operand is an `MMX' or an `XMM'
       register. The source operand can either be a register or a memory
       operand.

B.4.251 `PSHUFD': Shuffle Packed Doublewords

       PSHUFD xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8    ; 66 0F 70 /r ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PSHUFD' shuffles the doublewords in the source (second) operand
       according to the encoding specified by imm8, and stores the result
       in the destination (first) operand.

       Bits 0 and 1 of imm8 encode the source position of the doubleword to
       be copied to position 0 in the destination operand. Bits 2 and 3
       encode for position 1, bits 4 and 5 encode for position 2, and bits
       6 and 7 encode for position 3. For example, an encoding of 10 in
       bits 0 and 1 of imm8 indicates that the doubleword at bits 64-95 of
       the source operand will be copied to bits 0-31 of the destination.

B.4.252 `PSHUFHW': Shuffle Packed High Words

       PSHUFHW xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8   ; F3 0F 70 /r ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PSHUFW' shuffles the words in the high quadword of the source
       (second) operand according to the encoding specified by imm8, and
       stores the result in the high quadword of the destination (first)
       operand.

       The operation of this instruction is similar to the `PSHUFW'
       instruction, except that the source and destination are the top
       quadword of a 128-bit operand, instead of being 64-bit operands. The
       low quadword is copied from the source to the destination without
       any changes.

B.4.253 `PSHUFLW': Shuffle Packed Low Words

       PSHUFLW xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8   ; F2 0F 70 /r ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PSHUFLW' shuffles the words in the low quadword of the source
       (second) operand according to the encoding specified by imm8, and
       stores the result in the low quadword of the destination (first)
       operand.

       The operation of this instruction is similar to the `PSHUFW'
       instruction, except that the source and destination are the low
       quadword of a 128-bit operand, instead of being 64-bit operands. The
       high quadword is copied from the source to the destination without
       any changes.

B.4.254 `PSHUFW': Shuffle Packed Words

       PSHUFW mm1,mm2/m64,imm8       ; 0F 70 /r ib     [KATMAI,MMX]

       `PSHUFW' shuffles the words in the source (second) operand according
       to the encoding specified by imm8, and stores the result in the
       destination (first) operand.

       Bits 0 and 1 of imm8 encode the source position of the word to be
       copied to position 0 in the destination operand. Bits 2 and 3 encode
       for position 1, bits 4 and 5 encode for position 2, and bits 6 and 7
       encode for position 3. For example, an encoding of 10 in bits 0 and
       1 of imm8 indicates that the word at bits 32-47 of the source
       operand will be copied to bits 0-15 of the destination.

B.4.255 `PSLLx': Packed Data Bit Shift Left Logical

       PSLLW mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F F1 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSLLW mm,imm8                 ; 0F 71 /6 ib          [PENT,MMX]

       PSLLW xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F F1 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSLLW xmm,imm8                ; 66 0F 71 /6 ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PSLLD mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F F2 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSLLD mm,imm8                 ; 0F 72 /6 ib          [PENT,MMX]

       PSLLD xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F F2 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSLLD xmm,imm8                ; 66 0F 72 /6 ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PSLLQ mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F F3 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSLLQ mm,imm8                 ; 0F 73 /6 ib          [PENT,MMX]

       PSLLQ xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F F3 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSLLQ xmm,imm8                ; 66 0F 73 /6 ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PSLLDQ xmm1,imm8              ; 66 0F 73 /7 ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PSLLx' performs logical left shifts of the data elements in the
       destination (first) operand, moving each bit in the separate
       elements left by the number of bits specified in the source (second)
       operand, clearing the low-order bits as they are vacated. `PSLLDQ'
       shifts bytes, not bits.

       (*) `PSLLW' shifts word sized elements.

       (*) `PSLLD' shifts doubleword sized elements.

       (*) `PSLLQ' shifts quadword sized elements.

       (*) `PSLLDQ' shifts double quadword sized elements.

B.4.256 `PSRAx': Packed Data Bit Shift Right Arithmetic

       PSRAW mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F E1 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSRAW mm,imm8                 ; 0F 71 /4 ib          [PENT,MMX]

       PSRAW xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F E1 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSRAW xmm,imm8                ; 66 0F 71 /4 ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PSRAD mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F E2 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSRAD mm,imm8                 ; 0F 72 /4 ib          [PENT,MMX]

       PSRAD xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F E2 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSRAD xmm,imm8                ; 66 0F 72 /4 ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PSRAx' performs arithmetic right shifts of the data elements in the
       destination (first) operand, moving each bit in the separate
       elements right by the number of bits specified in the source
       (second) operand, setting the high-order bits to the value of the
       original sign bit.

       (*) `PSRAW' shifts word sized elements.

       (*) `PSRAD' shifts doubleword sized elements.

B.4.257 `PSRLx': Packed Data Bit Shift Right Logical

       PSRLW mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F D1 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSRLW mm,imm8                 ; 0F 71 /2 ib          [PENT,MMX]

       PSRLW xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F D1 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSRLW xmm,imm8                ; 66 0F 71 /2 ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PSRLD mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F D2 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSRLD mm,imm8                 ; 0F 72 /2 ib          [PENT,MMX]

       PSRLD xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F D2 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSRLD xmm,imm8                ; 66 0F 72 /2 ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PSRLQ mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F D3 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSRLQ mm,imm8                 ; 0F 73 /2 ib          [PENT,MMX]

       PSRLQ xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F D3 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSRLQ xmm,imm8                ; 66 0F 73 /2 ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PSRLDQ xmm1,imm8              ; 66 0F 73 /3 ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PSRLx' performs logical right shifts of the data elements in the
       destination (first) operand, moving each bit in the separate
       elements right by the number of bits specified in the source
       (second) operand, clearing the high-order bits as they are vacated.
       `PSRLDQ' shifts bytes, not bits.

       (*) `PSRLW' shifts word sized elements.

       (*) `PSRLD' shifts doubleword sized elements.

       (*) `PSRLQ' shifts quadword sized elements.

       (*) `PSRLDQ' shifts double quadword sized elements.

B.4.258 `PSUBx': Subtract Packed Integers

       PSUBB mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F F8 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSUBW mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F F9 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSUBD mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F FA /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSUBQ mm1,mm2/m64             ; 0F FB /r        [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PSUBB xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F F8 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSUBW xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F F9 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSUBD xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F FA /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSUBQ xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F FB /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PSUBx' subtracts packed integers in the source operand from those
       in the destination operand. It doesn't differentiate between signed
       and unsigned integers, and doesn't set any of the flags.

       (*) `PSUBB' operates on byte sized elements.

       (*) `PSUBW' operates on word sized elements.

       (*) `PSUBD' operates on doubleword sized elements.

       (*) `PSUBQ' operates on quadword sized elements.

B.4.259 `PSUBSxx', `PSUBUSx': Subtract Packed Integers With Saturation

       PSUBSB mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F E8 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSUBSW mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F E9 /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PSUBSB xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F E8 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSUBSW xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F E9 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PSUBUSB mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F D8 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PSUBUSW mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F D9 /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PSUBUSB xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F D8 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PSUBUSW xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F D9 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PSUBSx' and `PSUBUSx' subtracts packed integers in the source
       operand from those in the destination operand, and use saturation
       for results that are outside the range supported by the destination
       operand.

       (*) `PSUBSB' operates on signed bytes, and uses signed saturation on
           the results.

       (*) `PSUBSW' operates on signed words, and uses signed saturation on
           the results.

       (*) `PSUBUSB' operates on unsigned bytes, and uses signed saturation
           on the results.

       (*) `PSUBUSW' operates on unsigned words, and uses signed saturation
           on the results.

B.4.260 `PSUBSIW': MMX Packed Subtract with Saturation to Implied Destination

       PSUBSIW mm1,mm2/m64           ; 0F 55 /r             [CYRIX,MMX]

       `PSUBSIW', specific to the Cyrix extensions to the MMX instruction
       set, performs the same function as `PSUBSW', except that the result
       is not placed in the register specified by the first operand, but
       instead in the implied destination register, specified as for
       `PADDSIW' (section B.4.200).

B.4.261 `PSWAPD': Swap Packed Data 

       PSWAPD mm1,mm2/m64            ; 0F 0F /r BB     [PENT,3DNOW]

       `PSWAPD' swaps the packed doublewords in the source operand, and
       stores the result in the destination operand.

       In the `K6-2' and `K6-III' processors, this opcode uses the mnemonic
       `PSWAPW', and it swaps the order of words when copying from the
       source to the destination.

       The operation in the `K6-2' and `K6-III' processors is

          dst[0-15]  = src[48-63]; 
          dst[16-31] = src[32-47]; 
          dst[32-47] = src[16-31]; 
          dst[48-63] = src[0-15].

       The operation in the `K6-x+', `ATHLON' and later processors is:

          dst[0-31]  = src[32-63]; 
          dst[32-63] = src[0-31].

B.4.262 `PUNPCKxxx': Unpack and Interleave Data

       PUNPCKHBW mm1,mm2/m64         ; 0F 68 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PUNPCKHWD mm1,mm2/m64         ; 0F 69 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PUNPCKHDQ mm1,mm2/m64         ; 0F 6A /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PUNPCKHBW xmm1,xmm2/m128      ; 66 0F 68 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PUNPCKHWD xmm1,xmm2/m128      ; 66 0F 69 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PUNPCKHDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128      ; 66 0F 6A /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PUNPCKHQDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128     ; 66 0F 6D /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       PUNPCKLBW mm1,mm2/m32         ; 0F 60 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PUNPCKLWD mm1,mm2/m32         ; 0F 61 /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PUNPCKLDQ mm1,mm2/m32         ; 0F 62 /r             [PENT,MMX]

       PUNPCKLBW xmm1,xmm2/m128      ; 66 0F 60 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PUNPCKLWD xmm1,xmm2/m128      ; 66 0F 61 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PUNPCKLDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128      ; 66 0F 62 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2] 
       PUNPCKLQDQ xmm1,xmm2/m128     ; 66 0F 6C /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PUNPCKxx' all treat their operands as vectors, and produce a new
       vector generated by interleaving elements from the two inputs. The
       `PUNPCKHxx' instructions start by throwing away the bottom half of
       each input operand, and the `PUNPCKLxx' instructions throw away the
       top half.

       The remaining elements, are then interleaved into the destination,
       alternating elements from the second (source) operand and the first
       (destination) operand: so the leftmost part of each element in the
       result always comes from the second operand, and the rightmost from
       the destination.

       (*) `PUNPCKxBW' works a byte at a time, producing word sized output
           elements.

       (*) `PUNPCKxWD' works a word at a time, producing doubleword sized
           output elements.

       (*) `PUNPCKxDQ' works a doubleword at a time, producing quadword
           sized output elements.

       (*) `PUNPCKxQDQ' works a quadword at a time, producing double
           quadword sized output elements.

       So, for example, for `MMX' operands, if the first operand held
       `0x7A6A5A4A3A2A1A0A' and the second held `0x7B6B5B4B3B2B1B0B', then:

       (*) `PUNPCKHBW' would return `0x7B7A6B6A5B5A4B4A'.

       (*) `PUNPCKHWD' would return `0x7B6B7A6A5B4B5A4A'.

       (*) `PUNPCKHDQ' would return `0x7B6B5B4B7A6A5A4A'.

       (*) `PUNPCKLBW' would return `0x3B3A2B2A1B1A0B0A'.

       (*) `PUNPCKLWD' would return `0x3B2B3A2A1B0B1A0A'.

       (*) `PUNPCKLDQ' would return `0x3B2B1B0B3A2A1A0A'.

B.4.263 `PUSH': Push Data on Stack

       PUSH reg16                    ; o16 50+r             [8086] 
       PUSH reg32                    ; o32 50+r             [386]

       PUSH r/m16                    ; o16 FF /6            [8086] 
       PUSH r/m32                    ; o32 FF /6            [386]

       PUSH CS                       ; 0E                   [8086] 
       PUSH DS                       ; 1E                   [8086] 
       PUSH ES                       ; 06                   [8086] 
       PUSH SS                       ; 16                   [8086] 
       PUSH FS                       ; 0F A0                [386] 
       PUSH GS                       ; 0F A8                [386]

       PUSH imm8                     ; 6A ib                [186] 
       PUSH imm16                    ; o16 68 iw            [186] 
       PUSH imm32                    ; o32 68 id            [386]

       `PUSH' decrements the stack pointer (`SP' or `ESP') by 2 or 4, and
       then stores the given value at `[SS:SP]' or `[SS:ESP]'.

       The address-size attribute of the instruction determines whether
       `SP' or `ESP' is used as the stack pointer: to deliberately override
       the default given by the `BITS' setting, you can use an `a16' or
       `a32' prefix.

       The operand-size attribute of the instruction determines whether the
       stack pointer is decremented by 2 or 4: this means that segment
       register pushes in `BITS 32' mode will push 4 bytes on the stack, of
       which the upper two are undefined. If you need to override that, you
       can use an `o16' or `o32' prefix.

       The above opcode listings give two forms for general-purpose
       register push instructions: for example, `PUSH BX' has the two forms
       `53' and `FF F3'. NASM will always generate the shorter form when
       given `PUSH BX'. NDISASM will disassemble both.

       Unlike the undocumented and barely supported `POP CS', `PUSH CS' is
       a perfectly valid and sensible instruction, supported on all
       processors.

       The instruction `PUSH SP' may be used to distinguish an 8086 from
       later processors: on an 8086, the value of `SP' stored is the value
       it has _after_ the push instruction, whereas on later processors it
       is the value _before_ the push instruction.

B.4.264 `PUSHAx': Push All General-Purpose Registers

       PUSHA                         ; 60                   [186] 
       PUSHAD                        ; o32 60               [386] 
       PUSHAW                        ; o16 60               [186]

       `PUSHAW' pushes, in succession, `AX', `CX', `DX', `BX', `SP', `BP',
       `SI' and `DI' on the stack, decrementing the stack pointer by a
       total of 16.

       `PUSHAD' pushes, in succession, `EAX', `ECX', `EDX', `EBX', `ESP',
       `EBP', `ESI' and `EDI' on the stack, decrementing the stack pointer
       by a total of 32.

       In both cases, the value of `SP' or `ESP' pushed is its _original_
       value, as it had before the instruction was executed.

       `PUSHA' is an alias mnemonic for either `PUSHAW' or `PUSHAD',
       depending on the current `BITS' setting.

       Note that the registers are pushed in order of their numeric values
       in opcodes (see section B.2.1).

       See also `POPA' (section B.4.245).

B.4.265 `PUSHFx': Push Flags Register

       PUSHF                         ; 9C                   [8086] 
       PUSHFD                        ; o32 9C               [386] 
       PUSHFW                        ; o16 9C               [8086]

       (*) `PUSHFW' pushes the bottom 16 bits of the flags register (or the
           whole flags register, on processors below a 386) onto the stack.

       (*) `PUSHFD' pushes the entire flags register onto the stack.

       `PUSHF' is an alias mnemonic for either `PUSHFW' or `PUSHFD',
       depending on the current `BITS' setting.

       See also `POPF' (section B.4.246).

B.4.266 `PXOR': MMX Bitwise XOR

       PXOR mm1,mm2/m64              ; 0F EF /r             [PENT,MMX] 
       PXOR xmm1,xmm2/m128           ; 66 0F EF /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `PXOR' performs a bitwise XOR operation between its two operands
       (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if exactly one of the
       corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
       in the destination (first) operand.

B.4.267 `RCL', `RCR': Bitwise Rotate through Carry Bit

       RCL r/m8,1                    ; D0 /2                [8086] 
       RCL r/m8,CL                   ; D2 /2                [8086] 
       RCL r/m8,imm8                 ; C0 /2 ib             [186] 
       RCL r/m16,1                   ; o16 D1 /2            [8086] 
       RCL r/m16,CL                  ; o16 D3 /2            [8086] 
       RCL r/m16,imm8                ; o16 C1 /2 ib         [186] 
       RCL r/m32,1                   ; o32 D1 /2            [386] 
       RCL r/m32,CL                  ; o32 D3 /2            [386] 
       RCL r/m32,imm8                ; o32 C1 /2 ib         [386]

       RCR r/m8,1                    ; D0 /3                [8086] 
       RCR r/m8,CL                   ; D2 /3                [8086] 
       RCR r/m8,imm8                 ; C0 /3 ib             [186] 
       RCR r/m16,1                   ; o16 D1 /3            [8086] 
       RCR r/m16,CL                  ; o16 D3 /3            [8086] 
       RCR r/m16,imm8                ; o16 C1 /3 ib         [186] 
       RCR r/m32,1                   ; o32 D1 /3            [386] 
       RCR r/m32,CL                  ; o32 D3 /3            [386] 
       RCR r/m32,imm8                ; o32 C1 /3 ib         [386]

       `RCL' and `RCR' perform a 9-bit, 17-bit or 33-bit bitwise rotation
       operation, involving the given source/destination (first) operand
       and the carry bit. Thus, for example, in the operation `RCL AL,1', a
       9-bit rotation is performed in which `AL' is shifted left by 1, the
       top bit of `AL' moves into the carry flag, and the original value of
       the carry flag is placed in the low bit of `AL'.

       The number of bits to rotate by is given by the second operand. Only
       the bottom five bits of the rotation count are considered by
       processors above the 8086.

       You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a `C1'
       byte) form of `RCL foo,1' by using a `BYTE' prefix:
       `RCL foo,BYTE 1'. Similarly with `RCR'.

B.4.268 `RCPPS': Packed Single-Precision FP Reciprocal

       RCPPS xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 0F 53 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `RCPPS' returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the packed
       single-precision FP values from xmm2/m128. The maximum error for
       this approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12

B.4.269 `RCPSS': Scalar Single-Precision FP Reciprocal

       RCPSS xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; F3 0F 53 /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `RCPSS' returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the lower
       single-precision FP value from xmm2/m32; the upper three fields are
       passed through from xmm1. The maximum error for this approximation
       is: |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12

B.4.270 `RDMSR': Read Model-Specific Registers

       RDMSR                         ; 0F 32                [PENT,PRIV]

       `RDMSR' reads the processor Model-Specific Register (MSR) whose
       index is stored in `ECX', and stores the result in `EDX:EAX'. See
       also `WRMSR' (section B.4.329).

B.4.271 `RDPMC': Read Performance-Monitoring Counters

       RDPMC                         ; 0F 33                [P6]

       `RDPMC' reads the processor performance-monitoring counter whose
       index is stored in `ECX', and stores the result in `EDX:EAX'.

       This instruction is available on P6 and later processors and on MMX
       class processors.

B.4.272 `RDSHR': Read SMM Header Pointer Register

       RDSHR r/m32                   ; 0F 36 /0        [386,CYRIX,SMM]

       `RDSHR' reads the contents of the SMM header pointer register and
       saves it to the destination operand, which can be either a 32 bit
       memory location or a 32 bit register.

       See also `WRSHR' (section B.4.330).

B.4.273 `RDTSC': Read Time-Stamp Counter

       RDTSC                         ; 0F 31                [PENT]

       `RDTSC' reads the processor's time-stamp counter into `EDX:EAX'.

B.4.274 `RET', `RETF', `RETN': Return from Procedure Call

       RET                           ; C3                   [8086] 
       RET imm16                     ; C2 iw                [8086]

       RETF                          ; CB                   [8086] 
       RETF imm16                    ; CA iw                [8086]

       RETN                          ; C3                   [8086] 
       RETN imm16                    ; C2 iw                [8086]

       (*) `RET', and its exact synonym `RETN', pop `IP' or `EIP' from the
           stack and transfer control to the new address. Optionally, if a
           numeric second operand is provided, they increment the stack
           pointer by a further `imm16' bytes after popping the return
           address.

       (*) `RETF' executes a far return: after popping `IP'/`EIP', it then
           pops `CS', and _then_ increments the stack pointer by the
           optional argument if present.

B.4.275 `ROL', `ROR': Bitwise Rotate

       ROL r/m8,1                    ; D0 /0                [8086] 
       ROL r/m8,CL                   ; D2 /0                [8086] 
       ROL r/m8,imm8                 ; C0 /0 ib             [186] 
       ROL r/m16,1                   ; o16 D1 /0            [8086] 
       ROL r/m16,CL                  ; o16 D3 /0            [8086] 
       ROL r/m16,imm8                ; o16 C1 /0 ib         [186] 
       ROL r/m32,1                   ; o32 D1 /0            [386] 
       ROL r/m32,CL                  ; o32 D3 /0            [386] 
       ROL r/m32,imm8                ; o32 C1 /0 ib         [386]

       ROR r/m8,1                    ; D0 /1                [8086] 
       ROR r/m8,CL                   ; D2 /1                [8086] 
       ROR r/m8,imm8                 ; C0 /1 ib             [186] 
       ROR r/m16,1                   ; o16 D1 /1            [8086] 
       ROR r/m16,CL                  ; o16 D3 /1            [8086] 
       ROR r/m16,imm8                ; o16 C1 /1 ib         [186] 
       ROR r/m32,1                   ; o32 D1 /1            [386] 
       ROR r/m32,CL                  ; o32 D3 /1            [386] 
       ROR r/m32,imm8                ; o32 C1 /1 ib         [386]

       `ROL' and `ROR' perform a bitwise rotation operation on the given
       source/destination (first) operand. Thus, for example, in the
       operation `ROL AL,1', an 8-bit rotation is performed in which `AL'
       is shifted left by 1 and the original top bit of `AL' moves round
       into the low bit.

       The number of bits to rotate by is given by the second operand. Only
       the bottom five bits of the rotation count are considered by
       processors above the 8086.

       You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a `C1'
       byte) form of `ROL foo,1' by using a `BYTE' prefix:
       `ROL foo,BYTE 1'. Similarly with `ROR'.

B.4.276 `RSDC': Restore Segment Register and Descriptor

       RSDC segreg,m80               ; 0F 79 /r        [486,CYRIX,SMM]

       `RSDC' restores a segment register (DS, ES, FS, GS, or SS) from
       mem80, and sets up its descriptor.

B.4.277 `RSLDT': Restore Segment Register and Descriptor

       RSLDT m80                     ; 0F 7B /0        [486,CYRIX,SMM]

       `RSLDT' restores the Local Descriptor Table (LDTR) from mem80.

B.4.278 `RSM': Resume from System-Management Mode

       RSM                           ; 0F AA                [PENT]

       `RSM' returns the processor to its normal operating mode when it was
       in System-Management Mode.

B.4.279 `RSQRTPS': Packed Single-Precision FP Square Root Reciprocal

       RSQRTPS xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 0F 52 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `RSQRTPS' computes the approximate reciprocals of the square roots
       of the packed single-precision floating-point values in the source
       and stores the results in xmm1. The maximum error for this
       approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12

B.4.280 `RSQRTSS': Scalar Single-Precision FP Square Root Reciprocal

       RSQRTSS xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; F3 0F 52 /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `RSQRTSS' returns an approximation of the reciprocal of the square
       root of the lowest order single-precision FP value from the source,
       and stores it in the low doubleword of the destination register. The
       upper three fields of xmm1 are preserved. The maximum error for this
       approximation is: |Error| <= 1.5 x 2^-12

B.4.281 `RSTS': Restore TSR and Descriptor

       RSTS m80                      ; 0F 7D /0        [486,CYRIX,SMM]

       `RSTS' restores Task State Register (TSR) from mem80.

B.4.282 `SAHF': Store AH to Flags

       SAHF                          ; 9E                   [8086]

       `SAHF' sets the low byte of the flags word according to the contents
       of the `AH' register.

       The operation of `SAHF' is:

        AH --> SF:ZF:0:AF:0:PF:1:CF

       See also `LAHF' (section B.4.131).

B.4.283 `SAL', `SAR': Bitwise Arithmetic Shifts

       SAL r/m8,1                    ; D0 /4                [8086] 
       SAL r/m8,CL                   ; D2 /4                [8086] 
       SAL r/m8,imm8                 ; C0 /4 ib             [186] 
       SAL r/m16,1                   ; o16 D1 /4            [8086] 
       SAL r/m16,CL                  ; o16 D3 /4            [8086] 
       SAL r/m16,imm8                ; o16 C1 /4 ib         [186] 
       SAL r/m32,1                   ; o32 D1 /4            [386] 
       SAL r/m32,CL                  ; o32 D3 /4            [386] 
       SAL r/m32,imm8                ; o32 C1 /4 ib         [386]

       SAR r/m8,1                    ; D0 /7                [8086] 
       SAR r/m8,CL                   ; D2 /7                [8086] 
       SAR r/m8,imm8                 ; C0 /7 ib             [186] 
       SAR r/m16,1                   ; o16 D1 /7            [8086] 
       SAR r/m16,CL                  ; o16 D3 /7            [8086] 
       SAR r/m16,imm8                ; o16 C1 /7 ib         [186] 
       SAR r/m32,1                   ; o32 D1 /7            [386] 
       SAR r/m32,CL                  ; o32 D3 /7            [386] 
       SAR r/m32,imm8                ; o32 C1 /7 ib         [386]

       `SAL' and `SAR' perform an arithmetic shift operation on the given
       source/destination (first) operand. The vacated bits are filled with
       zero for `SAL', and with copies of the original high bit of the
       source operand for `SAR'.

       `SAL' is a synonym for `SHL' (see section B.4.290). NASM will
       assemble either one to the same code, but NDISASM will always
       disassemble that code as `SHL'.

       The number of bits to shift by is given by the second operand. Only
       the bottom five bits of the shift count are considered by processors
       above the 8086.

       You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a `C1'
       byte) form of `SAL foo,1' by using a `BYTE' prefix:
       `SAL foo,BYTE 1'. Similarly with `SAR'.

B.4.284 `SALC': Set AL from Carry Flag

       SALC                          ; D6                  [8086,UNDOC]

       `SALC' is an early undocumented instruction similar in concept to
       `SETcc' (section B.4.287). Its function is to set `AL' to zero if
       the carry flag is clear, or to `0xFF' if it is set.

B.4.285 `SBB': Subtract with Borrow

       SBB r/m8,reg8                 ; 18 /r                [8086] 
       SBB r/m16,reg16               ; o16 19 /r            [8086] 
       SBB r/m32,reg32               ; o32 19 /r            [386]

       SBB reg8,r/m8                 ; 1A /r                [8086] 
       SBB reg16,r/m16               ; o16 1B /r            [8086] 
       SBB reg32,r/m32               ; o32 1B /r            [386]

       SBB r/m8,imm8                 ; 80 /3 ib             [8086] 
       SBB r/m16,imm16               ; o16 81 /3 iw         [8086] 
       SBB r/m32,imm32               ; o32 81 /3 id         [386]

       SBB r/m16,imm8                ; o16 83 /3 ib         [8086] 
       SBB r/m32,imm8                ; o32 83 /3 ib         [386]

       SBB AL,imm8                   ; 1C ib                [8086] 
       SBB AX,imm16                  ; o16 1D iw            [8086] 
       SBB EAX,imm32                 ; o32 1D id            [386]

       `SBB' performs integer subtraction: it subtracts its second operand,
       plus the value of the carry flag, from its first, and leaves the
       result in its destination (first) operand. The flags are set
       according to the result of the operation: in particular, the carry
       flag is affected and can be used by a subsequent `SBB' instruction.

       In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
       first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
       sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
       the `BYTE' qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
       form of the instruction.

       To subtract one number from another without also subtracting the
       contents of the carry flag, use `SUB' (section B.4.305).

B.4.286 `SCASB', `SCASW', `SCASD': Scan String

       SCASB                         ; AE                   [8086] 
       SCASW                         ; o16 AF               [8086] 
       SCASD                         ; o32 AF               [386]

       `SCASB' compares the byte in `AL' with the byte at `[ES:DI]' or
       `[ES:EDI]', and sets the flags accordingly. It then increments or
       decrements (depending on the direction flag: increments if the flag
       is clear, decrements if it is set) `DI' (or `EDI').

       The register used is `DI' if the address size is 16 bits, and `EDI'
       if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not equal to
       the current `BITS' setting, you can use an explicit `a16' or `a32'
       prefix.

       Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
       use of `ES' for the load from `[DI]' or `[EDI]' cannot be
       overridden.

       `SCASW' and `SCASD' work in the same way, but they compare a word to
       `AX' or a doubleword to `EAX' instead of a byte to `AL', and
       increment or decrement the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of
       1.

       The `REPE' and `REPNE' prefixes (equivalently, `REPZ' and `REPNZ')
       may be used to repeat the instruction up to `CX' (or `ECX' - again,
       the address size chooses which) times until the first unequal or
       equal byte is found.

B.4.287 `SETcc': Set Register from Condition

       SETcc r/m8                    ; 0F 90+cc /2          [386]

       `SETcc' sets the given 8-bit operand to zero if its condition is not
       satisfied, and to 1 if it is.

B.4.288 `SFENCE': Store Fence

       SFENCE                 ; 0F AE /7               [KATMAI]

       `SFENCE' performs a serialising operation on all writes to memory
       that were issued before the `SFENCE' instruction. This guarantees
       that all memory writes before the `SFENCE' instruction are visible
       before any writes after the `SFENCE' instruction.

       `SFENCE' is ordered respective to other `SFENCE' instruction,
       `MFENCE', any memory write and any other serialising instruction
       (such as `CPUID').

       Weakly ordered memory types can be used to achieve higher processor
       performance through such techniques as out-of-order issue, write-
       combining, and write-collapsing. The degree to which a consumer of
       data recognizes or knows that the data is weakly ordered varies
       among applications and may be unknown to the producer of this data.
       The `SFENCE' instruction provides a performance-efficient way of
       insuring store ordering between routines that produce weakly-ordered
       results and routines that consume this data.

       `SFENCE' uses the following ModRM encoding:

                 Mod (7:6)        = 11B 
                 Reg/Opcode (5:3) = 111B 
                 R/M (2:0)        = 000B

       All other ModRM encodings are defined to be reserved, and use of
       these encodings risks incompatibility with future processors.

       See also `LFENCE' (section B.4.137) and `MFENCE' (section B.4.151).

B.4.289 `SGDT', `SIDT', `SLDT': Store Descriptor Table Pointers

       SGDT mem                      ; 0F 01 /0             [286,PRIV] 
       SIDT mem                      ; 0F 01 /1             [286,PRIV] 
       SLDT r/m16                    ; 0F 00 /0             [286,PRIV]

       `SGDT' and `SIDT' both take a 6-byte memory area as an operand: they
       store the contents of the GDTR (global descriptor table register) or
       IDTR (interrupt descriptor table register) into that area as a 32-
       bit linear address and a 16-bit size limit from that area (in that
       order). These are the only instructions which directly use _linear_
       addresses, rather than segment/offset pairs.

       `SLDT' stores the segment selector corresponding to the LDT (local
       descriptor table) into the given operand.

       See also `LGDT', `LIDT' and `LLDT' (section B.4.138).

B.4.290 `SHL', `SHR': Bitwise Logical Shifts

       SHL r/m8,1                    ; D0 /4                [8086] 
       SHL r/m8,CL                   ; D2 /4                [8086] 
       SHL r/m8,imm8                 ; C0 /4 ib             [186] 
       SHL r/m16,1                   ; o16 D1 /4            [8086] 
       SHL r/m16,CL                  ; o16 D3 /4            [8086] 
       SHL r/m16,imm8                ; o16 C1 /4 ib         [186] 
       SHL r/m32,1                   ; o32 D1 /4            [386] 
       SHL r/m32,CL                  ; o32 D3 /4            [386] 
       SHL r/m32,imm8                ; o32 C1 /4 ib         [386]

       SHR r/m8,1                    ; D0 /5                [8086] 
       SHR r/m8,CL                   ; D2 /5                [8086] 
       SHR r/m8,imm8                 ; C0 /5 ib             [186] 
       SHR r/m16,1                   ; o16 D1 /5            [8086] 
       SHR r/m16,CL                  ; o16 D3 /5            [8086] 
       SHR r/m16,imm8                ; o16 C1 /5 ib         [186] 
       SHR r/m32,1                   ; o32 D1 /5            [386] 
       SHR r/m32,CL                  ; o32 D3 /5            [386] 
       SHR r/m32,imm8                ; o32 C1 /5 ib         [386]

       `SHL' and `SHR' perform a logical shift operation on the given
       source/destination (first) operand. The vacated bits are filled with
       zero.

       A synonym for `SHL' is `SAL' (see section B.4.283). NASM will
       assemble either one to the same code, but NDISASM will always
       disassemble that code as `SHL'.

       The number of bits to shift by is given by the second operand. Only
       the bottom five bits of the shift count are considered by processors
       above the 8086.

       You can force the longer (286 and upwards, beginning with a `C1'
       byte) form of `SHL foo,1' by using a `BYTE' prefix:
       `SHL foo,BYTE 1'. Similarly with `SHR'.

B.4.291 `SHLD', `SHRD': Bitwise Double-Precision Shifts

       SHLD r/m16,reg16,imm8         ; o16 0F A4 /r ib      [386] 
       SHLD r/m16,reg32,imm8         ; o32 0F A4 /r ib      [386] 
       SHLD r/m16,reg16,CL           ; o16 0F A5 /r         [386] 
       SHLD r/m16,reg32,CL           ; o32 0F A5 /r         [386]

       SHRD r/m16,reg16,imm8         ; o16 0F AC /r ib      [386] 
       SHRD r/m32,reg32,imm8         ; o32 0F AC /r ib      [386] 
       SHRD r/m16,reg16,CL           ; o16 0F AD /r         [386] 
       SHRD r/m32,reg32,CL           ; o32 0F AD /r         [386]

       (*) `SHLD' performs a double-precision left shift. It notionally
           places its second operand to the right of its first, then shifts
           the entire bit string thus generated to the left by a number of
           bits specified in the third operand. It then updates only the
           _first_ operand according to the result of this. The second
           operand is not modified.

       (*) `SHRD' performs the corresponding right shift: it notionally
           places the second operand to the _left_ of the first, shifts the
           whole bit string right, and updates only the first operand.

       For example, if `EAX' holds `0x01234567' and `EBX' holds
       `0x89ABCDEF', then the instruction `SHLD EAX,EBX,4' would update
       `EAX' to hold `0x12345678'. Under the same conditions,
       `SHRD EAX,EBX,4' would update `EAX' to hold `0xF0123456'.

       The number of bits to shift by is given by the third operand. Only
       the bottom five bits of the shift count are considered.

B.4.292 `SHUFPD': Shuffle Packed Double-Precision FP Values

       SHUFPD xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8    ; 66 0F C6 /r ib  [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `SHUFPD' moves one of the packed double-precision FP values from the
       destination operand into the low quadword of the destination
       operand; the upper quadword is generated by moving one of the
       double-precision FP values from the source operand into the
       destination. The select (third) operand selects which of the values
       are moved to the destination register.

       The select operand is an 8-bit immediate: bit 0 selects which value
       is moved from the destination operand to the result (where 0 selects
       the low quadword and 1 selects the high quadword) and bit 1 selects
       which value is moved from the source operand to the result. Bits 2
       through 7 of the shuffle operand are reserved.

B.4.293 `SHUFPS': Shuffle Packed Single-Precision FP Values

       SHUFPS xmm1,xmm2/m128,imm8    ; 0F C6 /r ib     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `SHUFPS' moves two of the packed single-precision FP values from the
       destination operand into the low quadword of the destination
       operand; the upper quadword is generated by moving two of the
       single-precision FP values from the source operand into the
       destination. The select (third) operand selects which of the values
       are moved to the destination register.

       The select operand is an 8-bit immediate: bits 0 and 1 select the
       value to be moved from the destination operand the low doubleword of
       the result, bits 2 and 3 select the value to be moved from the
       destination operand the second doubleword of the result, bits 4 and
       5 select the value to be moved from the source operand the third
       doubleword of the result, and bits 6 and 7 select the value to be
       moved from the source operand to the high doubleword of the result.

B.4.294 `SMI': System Management Interrupt

       SMI                           ; F1                   [386,UNDOC]

       `SMI' puts some AMD processors into SMM mode. It is available on
       some 386 and 486 processors, and is only available when DR7 bit 12
       is set, otherwise it generates an Int 1.

B.4.295 `SMINT', `SMINTOLD': Software SMM Entry (CYRIX)

       SMINT                         ; 0F 38                [PENT,CYRIX] 
       SMINTOLD                      ; 0F 7E                [486,CYRIX]

       `SMINT' puts the processor into SMM mode. The CPU state information
       is saved in the SMM memory header, and then execution begins at the
       SMM base address.

       `SMINTOLD' is the same as `SMINT', but was the opcode used on the
       486.

       This pair of opcodes are specific to the Cyrix and compatible range
       of processors (Cyrix, IBM, Via).

B.4.296 `SMSW': Store Machine Status Word

       SMSW r/m16                    ; 0F 01 /4             [286,PRIV]

       `SMSW' stores the bottom half of the `CR0' control register (or the
       Machine Status Word, on 286 processors) into the destination
       operand. See also `LMSW' (section B.4.139).

       For 32-bit code, this would store all of `CR0' in the specified
       register (or the bottom 16 bits if the destination is a memory
       location), without needing an operand size override byte.

B.4.297 `SQRTPD': Packed Double-Precision FP Square Root

       SQRTPD xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 66 0F 51 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `SQRTPD' calculates the square root of the packed double-precision
       FP value from the source operand, and stores the double-precision
       results in the destination register.

B.4.298 `SQRTPS': Packed Single-Precision FP Square Root

       SQRTPS xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; 0F 51 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `SQRTPS' calculates the square root of the packed single-precision
       FP value from the source operand, and stores the single-precision
       results in the destination register.

B.4.299 `SQRTSD': Scalar Double-Precision FP Square Root

       SQRTSD xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; F2 0F 51 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `SQRTSD' calculates the square root of the low-order double-
       precision FP value from the source operand, and stores the double-
       precision result in the destination register. The high-quadword
       remains unchanged.

B.4.300 `SQRTSS': Scalar Single-Precision FP Square Root

       SQRTSS xmm1,xmm2/m128         ; F3 0F 51 /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `SQRTSS' calculates the square root of the low-order single-
       precision FP value from the source operand, and stores the single-
       precision result in the destination register. The three high
       doublewords remain unchanged.

B.4.301 `STC', `STD', `STI': Set Flags

       STC                           ; F9                   [8086] 
       STD                           ; FD                   [8086] 
       STI                           ; FB                   [8086]

       These instructions set various flags. `STC' sets the carry flag;
       `STD' sets the direction flag; and `STI' sets the interrupt flag
       (thus enabling interrupts).

       To clear the carry, direction, or interrupt flags, use the `CLC',
       `CLD' and `CLI' instructions (section B.4.20). To invert the carry
       flag, use `CMC' (section B.4.22).

B.4.302 `STMXCSR': Store Streaming SIMD Extension Control/Status

       STMXCSR m32                   ; 0F AE /3        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `STMXCSR' stores the contents of the `MXCSR' control/status register
       to the specified memory location. `MXCSR' is used to enable
       masked/unmasked exception handling, to set rounding modes, to set
       flush-to-zero mode, and to view exception status flags. The reserved
       bits in the `MXCSR' register are stored as 0s.

       For details of the `MXCSR' register, see the Intel processor docs.

       See also `LDMXCSR' (section B.4.133).

B.4.303 `STOSB', `STOSW', `STOSD': Store Byte to String

       STOSB                         ; AA                   [8086] 
       STOSW                         ; o16 AB               [8086] 
       STOSD                         ; o32 AB               [386]

       `STOSB' stores the byte in `AL' at `[ES:DI]' or `[ES:EDI]', and sets
       the flags accordingly. It then increments or decrements (depending
       on the direction flag: increments if the flag is clear, decrements
       if it is set) `DI' (or `EDI').

       The register used is `DI' if the address size is 16 bits, and `EDI'
       if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not equal to
       the current `BITS' setting, you can use an explicit `a16' or `a32'
       prefix.

       Segment override prefixes have no effect for this instruction: the
       use of `ES' for the store to `[DI]' or `[EDI]' cannot be overridden.

       `STOSW' and `STOSD' work in the same way, but they store the word in
       `AX' or the doubleword in `EAX' instead of the byte in `AL', and
       increment or decrement the addressing registers by 2 or 4 instead of
       1.

       The `REP' prefix may be used to repeat the instruction `CX' (or
       `ECX' - again, the address size chooses which) times.

B.4.304 `STR': Store Task Register

       STR r/m16                     ; 0F 00 /1             [286,PRIV]

       `STR' stores the segment selector corresponding to the contents of
       the Task Register into its operand. When the operand size is 32 bit
       and the destination is a register, the upper 16-bits are cleared to
       0s. When the destination operand is a memory location, 16 bits are
       written regardless of the operand size.

B.4.305 `SUB': Subtract Integers

       SUB r/m8,reg8                 ; 28 /r                [8086] 
       SUB r/m16,reg16               ; o16 29 /r            [8086] 
       SUB r/m32,reg32               ; o32 29 /r            [386]

       SUB reg8,r/m8                 ; 2A /r                [8086] 
       SUB reg16,r/m16               ; o16 2B /r            [8086] 
       SUB reg32,r/m32               ; o32 2B /r            [386]

       SUB r/m8,imm8                 ; 80 /5 ib             [8086] 
       SUB r/m16,imm16               ; o16 81 /5 iw         [8086] 
       SUB r/m32,imm32               ; o32 81 /5 id         [386]

       SUB r/m16,imm8                ; o16 83 /5 ib         [8086] 
       SUB r/m32,imm8                ; o32 83 /5 ib         [386]

       SUB AL,imm8                   ; 2C ib                [8086] 
       SUB AX,imm16                  ; o16 2D iw            [8086] 
       SUB EAX,imm32                 ; o32 2D id            [386]

       `SUB' performs integer subtraction: it subtracts its second operand
       from its first, and leaves the result in its destination (first)
       operand. The flags are set according to the result of the operation:
       in particular, the carry flag is affected and can be used by a
       subsequent `SBB' instruction (section B.4.285).

       In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
       first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
       sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
       the `BYTE' qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
       form of the instruction.

B.4.306 `SUBPD': Packed Double-Precision FP Subtract

       SUBPD xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F 5C /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `SUBPD' subtracts the packed double-precision FP values of the
       source operand from those of the destination operand, and stores the
       result in the destination operation.

B.4.307 `SUBPS': Packed Single-Precision FP Subtract

       SUBPS xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 0F 5C /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `SUBPS' subtracts the packed single-precision FP values of the
       source operand from those of the destination operand, and stores the
       result in the destination operation.

B.4.308 `SUBSD': Scalar Single-FP Subtract

       SUBSD xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; F2 0F 5C /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `SUBSD' subtracts the low-order double-precision FP value of the
       source operand from that of the destination operand, and stores the
       result in the destination operation. The high quadword is unchanged.

B.4.309 `SUBSS': Scalar Single-FP Subtract

       SUBSS xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; F3 0F 5C /r     [KATMAI,SSE]

       `SUBSS' subtracts the low-order single-precision FP value of the
       source operand from that of the destination operand, and stores the
       result in the destination operation. The three high doublewords are
       unchanged.

B.4.310 `SVDC': Save Segment Register and Descriptor

       SVDC m80,segreg               ; 0F 78 /r        [486,CYRIX,SMM]

       `SVDC' saves a segment register (DS, ES, FS, GS, or SS) and its
       descriptor to mem80.

B.4.311 `SVLDT': Save LDTR and Descriptor

       SVLDT m80                     ; 0F 7A /0        [486,CYRIX,SMM]

       `SVLDT' saves the Local Descriptor Table (LDTR) to mem80.

B.4.312 `SVTS': Save TSR and Descriptor

       SVTS m80                      ; 0F 7C /0        [486,CYRIX,SMM]

       `SVTS' saves the Task State Register (TSR) to mem80.

B.4.313 `SYSCALL': Call Operating System

       SYSCALL                       ; 0F 05                [P6,AMD]

       `SYSCALL' provides a fast method of transferring control to a fixed
       entry point in an operating system.

       (*) The `EIP' register is copied into the `ECX' register.

       (*) Bits [31-0] of the 64-bit SYSCALL/SYSRET Target Address Register
           (`STAR') are copied into the `EIP' register.

       (*) Bits [47-32] of the `STAR' register specify the selector that is
           copied into the `CS' register.

       (*) Bits [47-32]+1000b of the `STAR' register specify the selector
           that is copied into the SS register.

       The `CS' and `SS' registers should not be modified by the operating
       system between the execution of the `SYSCALL' instruction and its
       corresponding `SYSRET' instruction.

       For more information, see the
       `SYSCALL and SYSRET Instruction Specification' (AMD document number
       21086.pdf).

B.4.314 `SYSENTER': Fast System Call

       SYSENTER                      ; 0F 34                [P6]

       `SYSENTER' executes a fast call to a level 0 system procedure or
       routine. Before using this instruction, various MSRs need to be set
       up:

       (*) `SYSENTER_CS_MSR' contains the 32-bit segment selector for the
           privilege level 0 code segment. (This value is also used to
           compute the segment selector of the privilege level 0 stack
           segment.)

       (*) `SYSENTER_EIP_MSR' contains the 32-bit offset into the privilege
           level 0 code segment to the first instruction of the selected
           operating procedure or routine.

       (*) `SYSENTER_ESP_MSR' contains the 32-bit stack pointer for the
           privilege level 0 stack.

       `SYSENTER' performs the following sequence of operations:

       (*) Loads the segment selector from the `SYSENTER_CS_MSR' into the
           `CS' register.

       (*) Loads the instruction pointer from the `SYSENTER_EIP_MSR' into
           the `EIP' register.

       (*) Adds 8 to the value in `SYSENTER_CS_MSR' and loads it into the
           `SS' register.

       (*) Loads the stack pointer from the `SYSENTER_ESP_MSR' into the
           `ESP' register.

       (*) Switches to privilege level 0.

       (*) Clears the `VM' flag in the `EFLAGS' register, if the flag is
           set.

       (*) Begins executing the selected system procedure.

       In particular, note that this instruction des not save the values of
       `CS' or `(E)IP'. If you need to return to the calling code, you need
       to write your code to cater for this.

       For more information, see the Intel Architecture Software
       Developer's Manual, Volume 2.

B.4.315 `SYSEXIT': Fast Return From System Call

       SYSEXIT                       ; 0F 35                [P6,PRIV]

       `SYSEXIT' executes a fast return to privilege level 3 user code.
       This instruction is a companion instruction to the `SYSENTER'
       instruction, and can only be executed by privilege level 0 code.
       Various registers need to be set up before calling this instruction:

       (*) `SYSENTER_CS_MSR' contains the 32-bit segment selector for the
           privilege level 0 code segment in which the processor is
           currently executing. (This value is used to compute the segment
           selectors for the privilege level 3 code and stack segments.)

       (*) `EDX' contains the 32-bit offset into the privilege level 3 code
           segment to the first instruction to be executed in the user
           code.

       (*) `ECX' contains the 32-bit stack pointer for the privilege level
           3 stack.

       `SYSEXIT' performs the following sequence of operations:

       (*) Adds 16 to the value in `SYSENTER_CS_MSR' and loads the sum into
           the `CS' selector register.

       (*) Loads the instruction pointer from the `EDX' register into the
           `EIP' register.

       (*) Adds 24 to the value in `SYSENTER_CS_MSR' and loads the sum into
           the `SS' selector register.

       (*) Loads the stack pointer from the `ECX' register into the `ESP'
           register.

       (*) Switches to privilege level 3.

       (*) Begins executing the user code at the `EIP' address.

       For more information on the use of the `SYSENTER' and `SYSEXIT'
       instructions, see the Intel Architecture Software Developer's
       Manual, Volume 2.

B.4.316 `SYSRET': Return From Operating System

       SYSRET                        ; 0F 07                [P6,AMD,PRIV]

       `SYSRET' is the return instruction used in conjunction with the
       `SYSCALL' instruction to provide fast entry/exit to an operating
       system.

       (*) The `ECX' register, which points to the next sequential
           instruction after the corresponding `SYSCALL' instruction, is
           copied into the `EIP' register.

       (*) Bits [63-48] of the `STAR' register specify the selector that is
           copied into the `CS' register.

       (*) Bits [63-48]+1000b of the `STAR' register specify the selector
           that is copied into the `SS' register.

       (*) Bits [1-0] of the `SS' register are set to 11b (RPL of 3)
           regardless of the value of bits [49-48] of the `STAR' register.

       The `CS' and `SS' registers should not be modified by the operating
       system between the execution of the `SYSCALL' instruction and its
       corresponding `SYSRET' instruction.

       For more information, see the
       `SYSCALL and SYSRET Instruction Specification' (AMD document number
       21086.pdf).

B.4.317 `TEST': Test Bits (notional bitwise AND)

       TEST r/m8,reg8                ; 84 /r                [8086] 
       TEST r/m16,reg16              ; o16 85 /r            [8086] 
       TEST r/m32,reg32              ; o32 85 /r            [386]

       TEST r/m8,imm8                ; F6 /0 ib             [8086] 
       TEST r/m16,imm16              ; o16 F7 /0 iw         [8086] 
       TEST r/m32,imm32              ; o32 F7 /0 id         [386]

       TEST AL,imm8                  ; A8 ib                [8086] 
       TEST AX,imm16                 ; o16 A9 iw            [8086] 
       TEST EAX,imm32                ; o32 A9 id            [386]

       `TEST' performs a `mental' bitwise AND of its two operands, and
       affects the flags as if the operation had taken place, but does not
       store the result of the operation anywhere.

B.4.318 `UCOMISD': Unordered Scalar Double-Precision FP compare and set EFLAGS

       UCOMISD xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 66 0F 2E /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `UCOMISD' compares the low-order double-precision FP numbers in the
       two operands, and sets the `ZF', `PF' and `CF' bits in the `EFLAGS'
       register. In addition, the `OF', `SF' and `AF' bits in the `EFLAGS'
       register are zeroed out. The unordered predicate (`ZF', `PF' and
       `CF' all set) is returned if either source operand is a `NaN'
       (`qNaN' or `sNaN').

B.4.319 `UCOMISS': Unordered Scalar Single-Precision FP compare and set EFLAGS

       UCOMISS xmm1,xmm2/m128        ; 0F 2E /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `UCOMISS' compares the low-order single-precision FP numbers in the
       two operands, and sets the `ZF', `PF' and `CF' bits in the `EFLAGS'
       register. In addition, the `OF', `SF' and `AF' bits in the `EFLAGS'
       register are zeroed out. The unordered predicate (`ZF', `PF' and
       `CF' all set) is returned if either source operand is a `NaN'
       (`qNaN' or `sNaN').

B.4.320 `UD0', `UD1', `UD2': Undefined Instruction

       UD0                           ; 0F FF                [186,UNDOC] 
       UD1                           ; 0F B9                [186,UNDOC] 
       UD2                           ; 0F 0B                [186]

       `UDx' can be used to generate an invalid opcode exception, for
       testing purposes.

       `UD0' is specifically documented by AMD as being reserved for this
       purpose.

       `UD1' is documented by Intel as being available for this purpose.

       `UD2' is specifically documented by Intel as being reserved for this
       purpose. Intel document this as the preferred method of generating
       an invalid opcode exception.

       All these opcodes can be used to generate invalid opcode exceptions
       on all currently available processors.

B.4.321 `UMOV': User Move Data

       UMOV r/m8,reg8                ; 0F 10 /r             [386,UNDOC] 
       UMOV r/m16,reg16              ; o16 0F 11 /r         [386,UNDOC] 
       UMOV r/m32,reg32              ; o32 0F 11 /r         [386,UNDOC]

       UMOV reg8,r/m8                ; 0F 12 /r             [386,UNDOC] 
       UMOV reg16,r/m16              ; o16 0F 13 /r         [386,UNDOC] 
       UMOV reg32,r/m32              ; o32 0F 13 /r         [386,UNDOC]

       This undocumented instruction is used by in-circuit emulators to
       access user memory (as opposed to host memory). It is used just like
       an ordinary memory/register or register/register `MOV' instruction,
       but accesses user space.

       This instruction is only available on some AMD and IBM 386 and 486
       processors.

B.4.322 `UNPCKHPD': Unpack and Interleave High Packed Double-Precision FP Values

       UNPCKHPD xmm1,xmm2/m128       ; 66 0F 15 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `UNPCKHPD' performs an interleaved unpack of the high-order data
       elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
       in `xmm1'. It ignores the lower half of the sources.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          dst[63-0]   := dst[127-64]; 
          dst[127-64] := src[127-64].

B.4.323 `UNPCKHPS': Unpack and Interleave High Packed Single-Precision FP Values

       UNPCKHPS xmm1,xmm2/m128       ; 0F 15 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `UNPCKHPS' performs an interleaved unpack of the high-order data
       elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
       in `xmm1'. It ignores the lower half of the sources.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          dst[31-0]   := dst[95-64]; 
          dst[63-32]  := src[95-64]; 
          dst[95-64]  := dst[127-96]; 
          dst[127-96] := src[127-96].

B.4.324 `UNPCKLPD': Unpack and Interleave Low Packed Double-Precision FP Data

       UNPCKLPD xmm1,xmm2/m128       ; 66 0F 14 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `UNPCKLPD' performs an interleaved unpack of the low-order data
       elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
       in `xmm1'. It ignores the lower half of the sources.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          dst[63-0]   := dst[63-0]; 
          dst[127-64] := src[63-0].

B.4.325 `UNPCKLPS': Unpack and Interleave Low Packed Single-Precision FP Data

       UNPCKLPS xmm1,xmm2/m128       ; 0F 14 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `UNPCKLPS' performs an interleaved unpack of the low-order data
       elements of the source and destination operands, saving the result
       in `xmm1'. It ignores the lower half of the sources.

       The operation of this instruction is:

          dst[31-0]   := dst[31-0]; 
          dst[63-32]  := src[31-0]; 
          dst[95-64]  := dst[63-32]; 
          dst[127-96] := src[63-32].

B.4.326 `VERR', `VERW': Verify Segment Readability/Writability

       VERR r/m16                    ; 0F 00 /4             [286,PRIV]

       VERW r/m16                    ; 0F 00 /5             [286,PRIV]

       (*) `VERR' sets the zero flag if the segment specified by the
           selector in its operand can be read from at the current
           privilege level. Otherwise it is cleared.

       (*) `VERW' sets the zero flag if the segment can be written.

B.4.327 `WAIT': Wait for Floating-Point Processor

       WAIT                          ; 9B                   [8086] 
       FWAIT                         ; 9B                   [8086]

       `WAIT', on 8086 systems with a separate 8087 FPU, waits for the FPU
       to have finished any operation it is engaged in before continuing
       main processor operations, so that (for example) an FPU store to
       main memory can be guaranteed to have completed before the CPU tries
       to read the result back out.

       On higher processors, `WAIT' is unnecessary for this purpose, and it
       has the alternative purpose of ensuring that any pending unmasked
       FPU exceptions have happened before execution continues.

B.4.328 `WBINVD': Write Back and Invalidate Cache

       WBINVD                        ; 0F 09                [486]

       `WBINVD' invalidates and empties the processor's internal caches,
       and causes the processor to instruct external caches to do the same.
       It writes the contents of the caches back to memory first, so no
       data is lost. To flush the caches quickly without bothering to write
       the data back first, use `INVD' (section B.4.125).

B.4.329 `WRMSR': Write Model-Specific Registers

       WRMSR                         ; 0F 30                [PENT]

       `WRMSR' writes the value in `EDX:EAX' to the processor Model-
       Specific Register (MSR) whose index is stored in `ECX'. See also
       `RDMSR' (section B.4.270).

B.4.330 `WRSHR': Write SMM Header Pointer Register

       WRSHR r/m32                   ; 0F 37 /0        [386,CYRIX,SMM]

       `WRSHR' loads the contents of either a 32-bit memory location or a
       32-bit register into the SMM header pointer register.

       See also `RDSHR' (section B.4.272).

B.4.331 `XADD': Exchange and Add

       XADD r/m8,reg8                ; 0F C0 /r             [486] 
       XADD r/m16,reg16              ; o16 0F C1 /r         [486] 
       XADD r/m32,reg32              ; o32 0F C1 /r         [486]

       `XADD' exchanges the values in its two operands, and then adds them
       together and writes the result into the destination (first) operand.
       This instruction can be used with a `LOCK' prefix for multi-
       processor synchronisation purposes.

B.4.332 `XBTS': Extract Bit String

       XBTS reg16,r/m16              ; o16 0F A6 /r         [386,UNDOC] 
       XBTS reg32,r/m32              ; o32 0F A6 /r         [386,UNDOC]

       The implied operation of this instruction is:

       XBTS r/m16,reg16,AX,CL 
       XBTS r/m32,reg32,EAX,CL

       Writes a bit string from the source operand to the destination. `CL'
       indicates the number of bits to be copied, and `(E)AX' indicates the
       low order bit offset in the source. The bits are written to the low
       order bits of the destination register. For example, if `CL' is set
       to 4 and `AX' (for 16-bit code) is set to 5, bits 5-8 of `src' will
       be copied to bits 0-3 of `dst'. This instruction is very poorly
       documented, and I have been unable to find any official source of
       documentation on it.

       `XBTS' is supported only on the early Intel 386s, and conflicts with
       the opcodes for `CMPXCHG486' (on early Intel 486s). NASM supports it
       only for completeness. Its counterpart is `IBTS' (see section
       B.4.116).

B.4.333 `XCHG': Exchange

       XCHG reg8,r/m8                ; 86 /r                [8086] 
       XCHG reg16,r/m8               ; o16 87 /r            [8086] 
       XCHG reg32,r/m32              ; o32 87 /r            [386]

       XCHG r/m8,reg8                ; 86 /r                [8086] 
       XCHG r/m16,reg16              ; o16 87 /r            [8086] 
       XCHG r/m32,reg32              ; o32 87 /r            [386]

       XCHG AX,reg16                 ; o16 90+r             [8086] 
       XCHG EAX,reg32                ; o32 90+r             [386] 
       XCHG reg16,AX                 ; o16 90+r             [8086] 
       XCHG reg32,EAX                ; o32 90+r             [386]

       `XCHG' exchanges the values in its two operands. It can be used with
       a `LOCK' prefix for purposes of multi-processor synchronisation.

       `XCHG AX,AX' or `XCHG EAX,EAX' (depending on the `BITS' setting)
       generates the opcode `90h', and so is a synonym for `NOP' (section
       B.4.190).

B.4.334 `XLATB': Translate Byte in Lookup Table

       XLAT                          ; D7                   [8086] 
       XLATB                         ; D7                   [8086]

       `XLATB' adds the value in `AL', treated as an unsigned byte, to `BX'
       or `EBX', and loads the byte from the resulting address (in the
       segment specified by `DS') back into `AL'.

       The base register used is `BX' if the address size is 16 bits, and
       `EBX' if it is 32 bits. If you need to use an address size not equal
       to the current `BITS' setting, you can use an explicit `a16' or
       `a32' prefix.

       The segment register used to load from `[BX+AL]' or `[EBX+AL]' can
       be overridden by using a segment register name as a prefix (for
       example, `es xlatb').

B.4.335 `XOR': Bitwise Exclusive OR

       XOR r/m8,reg8                 ; 30 /r                [8086] 
       XOR r/m16,reg16               ; o16 31 /r            [8086] 
       XOR r/m32,reg32               ; o32 31 /r            [386]

       XOR reg8,r/m8                 ; 32 /r                [8086] 
       XOR reg16,r/m16               ; o16 33 /r            [8086] 
       XOR reg32,r/m32               ; o32 33 /r            [386]

       XOR r/m8,imm8                 ; 80 /6 ib             [8086] 
       XOR r/m16,imm16               ; o16 81 /6 iw         [8086] 
       XOR r/m32,imm32               ; o32 81 /6 id         [386]

       XOR r/m16,imm8                ; o16 83 /6 ib         [8086] 
       XOR r/m32,imm8                ; o32 83 /6 ib         [386]

       XOR AL,imm8                   ; 34 ib                [8086] 
       XOR AX,imm16                  ; o16 35 iw            [8086] 
       XOR EAX,imm32                 ; o32 35 id            [386]

       `XOR' performs a bitwise XOR operation between its two operands
       (i.e. each bit of the result is 1 if and only if exactly one of the
       corresponding bits of the two inputs was 1), and stores the result
       in the destination (first) operand.

       In the forms with an 8-bit immediate second operand and a longer
       first operand, the second operand is considered to be signed, and is
       sign-extended to the length of the first operand. In these cases,
       the `BYTE' qualifier is necessary to force NASM to generate this
       form of the instruction.

       The `MMX' instruction `PXOR' (see section B.4.266) performs the same
       operation on the 64-bit `MMX' registers.

B.4.336 `XORPD': Bitwise Logical XOR of Double-Precision FP Values

       XORPD xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 66 0F 57 /r     [WILLAMETTE,SSE2]

       `XORPD' returns a bit-wise logical XOR between the source and
       destination operands, storing the result in the destination operand.

B.4.337 `XORPS': Bitwise Logical XOR of Single-Precision FP Values

       XORPS xmm1,xmm2/m128          ; 0F 57 /r        [KATMAI,SSE]

       `XORPS' returns a bit-wise logical XOR between the source and
       destination operands, storing the result in the destination operand.